blob: faa1d7c6c3617bcd3003e3c5928a5b6f10701a4c [file] [log] [blame]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001==============================
2LLVM Language Reference Manual
3==============================
4
5.. contents::
6 :local:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00007 :depth: 4
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009Abstract
10========
11
12This document is a reference manual for the LLVM assembly language. LLVM
13is a Static Single Assignment (SSA) based representation that provides
14type safety, low-level operations, flexibility, and the capability of
15representing 'all' high-level languages cleanly. It is the common code
16representation used throughout all phases of the LLVM compilation
17strategy.
18
19Introduction
20============
21
22The LLVM code representation is designed to be used in three different
23forms: as an in-memory compiler IR, as an on-disk bitcode representation
24(suitable for fast loading by a Just-In-Time compiler), and as a human
25readable assembly language representation. This allows LLVM to provide a
26powerful intermediate representation for efficient compiler
27transformations and analysis, while providing a natural means to debug
28and visualize the transformations. The three different forms of LLVM are
29all equivalent. This document describes the human readable
30representation and notation.
31
32The LLVM representation aims to be light-weight and low-level while
33being expressive, typed, and extensible at the same time. It aims to be
34a "universal IR" of sorts, by being at a low enough level that
35high-level ideas may be cleanly mapped to it (similar to how
36microprocessors are "universal IR's", allowing many source languages to
37be mapped to them). By providing type information, LLVM can be used as
38the target of optimizations: for example, through pointer analysis, it
39can be proven that a C automatic variable is never accessed outside of
40the current function, allowing it to be promoted to a simple SSA value
41instead of a memory location.
42
43.. _wellformed:
44
45Well-Formedness
46---------------
47
48It is important to note that this document describes 'well formed' LLVM
49assembly language. There is a difference between what the parser accepts
50and what is considered 'well formed'. For example, the following
51instruction is syntactically okay, but not well formed:
52
53.. code-block:: llvm
54
55 %x = add i32 1, %x
56
57because the definition of ``%x`` does not dominate all of its uses. The
58LLVM infrastructure provides a verification pass that may be used to
59verify that an LLVM module is well formed. This pass is automatically
60run by the parser after parsing input assembly and by the optimizer
61before it outputs bitcode. The violations pointed out by the verifier
62pass indicate bugs in transformation passes or input to the parser.
63
64.. _identifiers:
65
66Identifiers
67===========
68
69LLVM identifiers come in two basic types: global and local. Global
70identifiers (functions, global variables) begin with the ``'@'``
71character. Local identifiers (register names, types) begin with the
72``'%'`` character. Additionally, there are three different formats for
73identifiers, for different purposes:
74
75#. Named values are represented as a string of characters with their
76 prefix. For example, ``%foo``, ``@DivisionByZero``,
77 ``%a.really.long.identifier``. The actual regular expression used is
Sean Silva9d01a5b2015-01-07 21:35:14 +000078 '``[%@][-a-zA-Z$._][-a-zA-Z$._0-9]*``'. Identifiers that require other
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000079 characters in their names can be surrounded with quotes. Special
80 characters may be escaped using ``"\xx"`` where ``xx`` is the ASCII
81 code for the character in hexadecimal. In this way, any character can
Hans Wennborg85e06532014-07-30 20:02:08 +000082 be used in a name value, even quotes themselves. The ``"\01"`` prefix
83 can be used on global variables to suppress mangling.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000084#. Unnamed values are represented as an unsigned numeric value with
85 their prefix. For example, ``%12``, ``@2``, ``%44``.
86#. Constants, which are described in the section Constants_ below.
87
88LLVM requires that values start with a prefix for two reasons: Compilers
89don't need to worry about name clashes with reserved words, and the set
90of reserved words may be expanded in the future without penalty.
91Additionally, unnamed identifiers allow a compiler to quickly come up
92with a temporary variable without having to avoid symbol table
93conflicts.
94
95Reserved words in LLVM are very similar to reserved words in other
96languages. There are keywords for different opcodes ('``add``',
97'``bitcast``', '``ret``', etc...), for primitive type names ('``void``',
98'``i32``', etc...), and others. These reserved words cannot conflict
99with variable names, because none of them start with a prefix character
100(``'%'`` or ``'@'``).
101
102Here is an example of LLVM code to multiply the integer variable
103'``%X``' by 8:
104
105The easy way:
106
107.. code-block:: llvm
108
109 %result = mul i32 %X, 8
110
111After strength reduction:
112
113.. code-block:: llvm
114
Dmitri Gribenko675911d2013-01-26 13:30:13 +0000115 %result = shl i32 %X, 3
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000116
117And the hard way:
118
119.. code-block:: llvm
120
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +0000121 %0 = add i32 %X, %X ; yields i32:%0
122 %1 = add i32 %0, %0 ; yields i32:%1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000123 %result = add i32 %1, %1
124
125This last way of multiplying ``%X`` by 8 illustrates several important
126lexical features of LLVM:
127
128#. Comments are delimited with a '``;``' and go until the end of line.
129#. Unnamed temporaries are created when the result of a computation is
130 not assigned to a named value.
Sean Silva8ca11782013-05-20 23:31:12 +0000131#. Unnamed temporaries are numbered sequentially (using a per-function
Dan Liew2661dfc2014-08-20 15:06:30 +0000132 incrementing counter, starting with 0). Note that basic blocks and unnamed
133 function parameters are included in this numbering. For example, if the
134 entry basic block is not given a label name and all function parameters are
135 named, then it will get number 0.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000136
137It also shows a convention that we follow in this document. When
138demonstrating instructions, we will follow an instruction with a comment
139that defines the type and name of value produced.
140
141High Level Structure
142====================
143
144Module Structure
145----------------
146
147LLVM programs are composed of ``Module``'s, each of which is a
148translation unit of the input programs. Each module consists of
149functions, global variables, and symbol table entries. Modules may be
150combined together with the LLVM linker, which merges function (and
151global variable) definitions, resolves forward declarations, and merges
152symbol table entries. Here is an example of the "hello world" module:
153
154.. code-block:: llvm
155
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000156 ; Declare the string constant as a global constant.
157 @.str = private unnamed_addr constant [13 x i8] c"hello world\0A\00"
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000158
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000159 ; External declaration of the puts function
160 declare i32 @puts(i8* nocapture) nounwind
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000161
162 ; Definition of main function
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000163 define i32 @main() { ; i32()*
164 ; Convert [13 x i8]* to i8 *...
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +0000165 %cast210 = getelementptr [13 x i8], [13 x i8]* @.str, i64 0, i64 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000166
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000167 ; Call puts function to write out the string to stdout.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000168 call i32 @puts(i8* %cast210)
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000169 ret i32 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000170 }
171
172 ; Named metadata
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +0000173 !0 = !{i32 42, null, !"string"}
Nick Lewyckya0de40a2014-08-13 04:54:05 +0000174 !foo = !{!0}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000175
176This example is made up of a :ref:`global variable <globalvars>` named
177"``.str``", an external declaration of the "``puts``" function, a
178:ref:`function definition <functionstructure>` for "``main``" and
179:ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` "``foo``".
180
181In general, a module is made up of a list of global values (where both
182functions and global variables are global values). Global values are
183represented by a pointer to a memory location (in this case, a pointer
184to an array of char, and a pointer to a function), and have one of the
185following :ref:`linkage types <linkage>`.
186
187.. _linkage:
188
189Linkage Types
190-------------
191
192All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following types of
193linkage:
194
195``private``
196 Global values with "``private``" linkage are only directly
197 accessible by objects in the current module. In particular, linking
198 code into a module with an private global value may cause the
199 private to be renamed as necessary to avoid collisions. Because the
200 symbol is private to the module, all references can be updated. This
201 doesn't show up in any symbol table in the object file.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000202``internal``
203 Similar to private, but the value shows as a local symbol
204 (``STB_LOCAL`` in the case of ELF) in the object file. This
205 corresponds to the notion of the '``static``' keyword in C.
206``available_externally``
207 Globals with "``available_externally``" linkage are never emitted
208 into the object file corresponding to the LLVM module. They exist to
209 allow inlining and other optimizations to take place given knowledge
210 of the definition of the global, which is known to be somewhere
211 outside the module. Globals with ``available_externally`` linkage
212 are allowed to be discarded at will, and are otherwise the same as
213 ``linkonce_odr``. This linkage type is only allowed on definitions,
214 not declarations.
215``linkonce``
216 Globals with "``linkonce``" linkage are merged with other globals of
217 the same name when linkage occurs. This can be used to implement
218 some forms of inline functions, templates, or other code which must
219 be generated in each translation unit that uses it, but where the
220 body may be overridden with a more definitive definition later.
221 Unreferenced ``linkonce`` globals are allowed to be discarded. Note
222 that ``linkonce`` linkage does not actually allow the optimizer to
223 inline the body of this function into callers because it doesn't
224 know if this definition of the function is the definitive definition
225 within the program or whether it will be overridden by a stronger
226 definition. To enable inlining and other optimizations, use
227 "``linkonce_odr``" linkage.
228``weak``
229 "``weak``" linkage has the same merging semantics as ``linkonce``
230 linkage, except that unreferenced globals with ``weak`` linkage may
231 not be discarded. This is used for globals that are declared "weak"
232 in C source code.
233``common``
234 "``common``" linkage is most similar to "``weak``" linkage, but they
235 are used for tentative definitions in C, such as "``int X;``" at
236 global scope. Symbols with "``common``" linkage are merged in the
237 same way as ``weak symbols``, and they may not be deleted if
238 unreferenced. ``common`` symbols may not have an explicit section,
239 must have a zero initializer, and may not be marked
240 ':ref:`constant <globalvars>`'. Functions and aliases may not have
241 common linkage.
242
243.. _linkage_appending:
244
245``appending``
246 "``appending``" linkage may only be applied to global variables of
247 pointer to array type. When two global variables with appending
248 linkage are linked together, the two global arrays are appended
249 together. This is the LLVM, typesafe, equivalent of having the
250 system linker append together "sections" with identical names when
251 .o files are linked.
252``extern_weak``
253 The semantics of this linkage follow the ELF object file model: the
254 symbol is weak until linked, if not linked, the symbol becomes null
255 instead of being an undefined reference.
256``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``
257 Some languages allow differing globals to be merged, such as two
258 functions with different semantics. Other languages, such as
259 ``C++``, ensure that only equivalent globals are ever merged (the
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +0000260 "one definition rule" --- "ODR"). Such languages can use the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000261 ``linkonce_odr`` and ``weak_odr`` linkage types to indicate that the
262 global will only be merged with equivalent globals. These linkage
263 types are otherwise the same as their non-``odr`` versions.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000264``external``
265 If none of the above identifiers are used, the global is externally
266 visible, meaning that it participates in linkage and can be used to
267 resolve external symbol references.
268
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000269It is illegal for a function *declaration* to have any linkage type
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000270other than ``external`` or ``extern_weak``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000271
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000272.. _callingconv:
273
274Calling Conventions
275-------------------
276
277LLVM :ref:`functions <functionstructure>`, :ref:`calls <i_call>` and
278:ref:`invokes <i_invoke>` can all have an optional calling convention
279specified for the call. The calling convention of any pair of dynamic
280caller/callee must match, or the behavior of the program is undefined.
281The following calling conventions are supported by LLVM, and more may be
282added in the future:
283
284"``ccc``" - The C calling convention
285 This calling convention (the default if no other calling convention
286 is specified) matches the target C calling conventions. This calling
287 convention supports varargs function calls and tolerates some
288 mismatch in the declared prototype and implemented declaration of
289 the function (as does normal C).
290"``fastcc``" - The fast calling convention
291 This calling convention attempts to make calls as fast as possible
292 (e.g. by passing things in registers). This calling convention
293 allows the target to use whatever tricks it wants to produce fast
294 code for the target, without having to conform to an externally
295 specified ABI (Application Binary Interface). `Tail calls can only
296 be optimized when this, the GHC or the HiPE convention is
297 used. <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ This calling convention does not
298 support varargs and requires the prototype of all callees to exactly
299 match the prototype of the function definition.
300"``coldcc``" - The cold calling convention
301 This calling convention attempts to make code in the caller as
302 efficient as possible under the assumption that the call is not
303 commonly executed. As such, these calls often preserve all registers
304 so that the call does not break any live ranges in the caller side.
305 This calling convention does not support varargs and requires the
306 prototype of all callees to exactly match the prototype of the
Juergen Ributzka5d05ed12014-01-17 22:24:35 +0000307 function definition. Furthermore the inliner doesn't consider such function
308 calls for inlining.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000309"``cc 10``" - GHC convention
310 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
311 the `Glasgow Haskell Compiler (GHC) <http://www.haskell.org/ghc>`_.
312 It passes everything in registers, going to extremes to achieve this
313 by disabling callee save registers. This calling convention should
314 not be used lightly but only for specific situations such as an
315 alternative to the *register pinning* performance technique often
316 used when implementing functional programming languages. At the
317 moment only X86 supports this convention and it has the following
318 limitations:
319
320 - On *X86-32* only supports up to 4 bit type parameters. No
321 floating point types are supported.
322 - On *X86-64* only supports up to 10 bit type parameters and 6
323 floating point parameters.
324
325 This calling convention supports `tail call
326 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires both the
327 caller and callee are using it.
328"``cc 11``" - The HiPE calling convention
329 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
330 the `High-Performance Erlang
331 (HiPE) <http://www.it.uu.se/research/group/hipe/>`_ compiler, *the*
332 native code compiler of the `Ericsson's Open Source Erlang/OTP
333 system <http://www.erlang.org/download.shtml>`_. It uses more
334 registers for argument passing than the ordinary C calling
335 convention and defines no callee-saved registers. The calling
336 convention properly supports `tail call
337 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires that both the
338 caller and the callee use it. It uses a *register pinning*
339 mechanism, similar to GHC's convention, for keeping frequently
340 accessed runtime components pinned to specific hardware registers.
341 At the moment only X86 supports this convention (both 32 and 64
342 bit).
Andrew Trick5e029ce2013-12-24 02:57:25 +0000343"``webkit_jscc``" - WebKit's JavaScript calling convention
344 This calling convention has been implemented for `WebKit FTL JIT
345 <https://trac.webkit.org/wiki/FTLJIT>`_. It passes arguments on the
346 stack right to left (as cdecl does), and returns a value in the
347 platform's customary return register.
348"``anyregcc``" - Dynamic calling convention for code patching
349 This is a special convention that supports patching an arbitrary code
350 sequence in place of a call site. This convention forces the call
Eli Bendersky45324ce2015-04-02 15:20:04 +0000351 arguments into registers but allows them to be dynamically
Andrew Trick5e029ce2013-12-24 02:57:25 +0000352 allocated. This can currently only be used with calls to
353 llvm.experimental.patchpoint because only this intrinsic records
354 the location of its arguments in a side table. See :doc:`StackMaps`.
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000355"``preserve_mostcc``" - The `PreserveMost` calling convention
Eli Bendersky45324ce2015-04-02 15:20:04 +0000356 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller as
357 unintrusive as possible. This convention behaves identically to the `C`
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000358 calling convention on how arguments and return values are passed, but it
359 uses a different set of caller/callee-saved registers. This alleviates the
360 burden of saving and recovering a large register set before and after the
Juergen Ributzka980f2dc2014-01-30 02:39:00 +0000361 call in the caller. If the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers,
362 then they will be preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't
363 apply for values returned in callee-saved registers.
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000364
365 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
366 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Floating-point registers
367 (XMMs/YMMs) are not preserved and need to be saved by the caller.
368
369 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
370 that have a hot path and a cold path. The hot path is usually a small piece
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000371 of code that doesn't use many registers. The cold path might need to call out to
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000372 another function and therefore only needs to preserve the caller-saved
Juergen Ributzka5d05ed12014-01-17 22:24:35 +0000373 registers, which haven't already been saved by the caller. The
374 `PreserveMost` calling convention is very similar to the `cold` calling
375 convention in terms of caller/callee-saved registers, but they are used for
376 different types of function calls. `coldcc` is for function calls that are
377 rarely executed, whereas `preserve_mostcc` function calls are intended to be
378 on the hot path and definitely executed a lot. Furthermore `preserve_mostcc`
379 doesn't prevent the inliner from inlining the function call.
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000380
381 This calling convention will be used by a future version of the ObjectiveC
382 runtime and should therefore still be considered experimental at this time.
383 Although this convention was created to optimize certain runtime calls to
384 the ObjectiveC runtime, it is not limited to this runtime and might be used
385 by other runtimes in the future too. The current implementation only
386 supports X86-64, but the intention is to support more architectures in the
387 future.
388"``preserve_allcc``" - The `PreserveAll` calling convention
389 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller even less
390 intrusive than the `PreserveMost` calling convention. This calling
391 convention also behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on how
392 arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
393 caller/callee-saved registers. This removes the burden of saving and
Juergen Ributzka980f2dc2014-01-30 02:39:00 +0000394 recovering a large register set before and after the call in the caller. If
395 the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers, then they will be
396 preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't apply for values
397 returned in callee-saved registers.
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000398
399 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
400 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Furthermore it also preserves
401 all floating-point registers (XMMs/YMMs).
402
403 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
404 that don't need to call out to any other functions.
405
406 This calling convention, like the `PreserveMost` calling convention, will be
407 used by a future version of the ObjectiveC runtime and should be considered
408 experimental at this time.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000409"``cc <n>``" - Numbered convention
410 Any calling convention may be specified by number, allowing
411 target-specific calling conventions to be used. Target specific
412 calling conventions start at 64.
413
414More calling conventions can be added/defined on an as-needed basis, to
415support Pascal conventions or any other well-known target-independent
416convention.
417
Eli Benderskyfdc529a2013-06-07 19:40:08 +0000418.. _visibilitystyles:
419
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000420Visibility Styles
421-----------------
422
423All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following visibility
424styles:
425
426"``default``" - Default style
427 On targets that use the ELF object file format, default visibility
428 means that the declaration is visible to other modules and, in
429 shared libraries, means that the declared entity may be overridden.
430 On Darwin, default visibility means that the declaration is visible
431 to other modules. Default visibility corresponds to "external
432 linkage" in the language.
433"``hidden``" - Hidden style
434 Two declarations of an object with hidden visibility refer to the
435 same object if they are in the same shared object. Usually, hidden
436 visibility indicates that the symbol will not be placed into the
437 dynamic symbol table, so no other module (executable or shared
438 library) can reference it directly.
439"``protected``" - Protected style
440 On ELF, protected visibility indicates that the symbol will be
441 placed in the dynamic symbol table, but that references within the
442 defining module will bind to the local symbol. That is, the symbol
443 cannot be overridden by another module.
444
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithb80de102014-05-07 22:57:20 +0000445A symbol with ``internal`` or ``private`` linkage must have ``default``
446visibility.
447
Rafael Espindola3bc64d52014-05-26 21:30:40 +0000448.. _dllstorageclass:
Eli Benderskyfdc529a2013-06-07 19:40:08 +0000449
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000450DLL Storage Classes
451-------------------
452
453All Global Variables, Functions and Aliases can have one of the following
454DLL storage class:
455
456``dllimport``
457 "``dllimport``" causes the compiler to reference a function or variable via
458 a global pointer to a pointer that is set up by the DLL exporting the
459 symbol. On Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by
460 combining ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name.
461``dllexport``
462 "``dllexport``" causes the compiler to provide a global pointer to a pointer
463 in a DLL, so that it can be referenced with the ``dllimport`` attribute. On
464 Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by combining
465 ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name. Since this storage class
466 exists for defining a dll interface, the compiler, assembler and linker know
467 it is externally referenced and must refrain from deleting the symbol.
468
Rafael Espindola59f7eba2014-05-28 18:15:43 +0000469.. _tls_model:
470
471Thread Local Storage Models
472---------------------------
473
474A variable may be defined as ``thread_local``, which means that it will
475not be shared by threads (each thread will have a separated copy of the
476variable). Not all targets support thread-local variables. Optionally, a
477TLS model may be specified:
478
479``localdynamic``
480 For variables that are only used within the current shared library.
481``initialexec``
482 For variables in modules that will not be loaded dynamically.
483``localexec``
484 For variables defined in the executable and only used within it.
485
486If no explicit model is given, the "general dynamic" model is used.
487
488The models correspond to the ELF TLS models; see `ELF Handling For
489Thread-Local Storage <http://people.redhat.com/drepper/tls.pdf>`_ for
490more information on under which circumstances the different models may
491be used. The target may choose a different TLS model if the specified
492model is not supported, or if a better choice of model can be made.
493
494A model can also be specified in a alias, but then it only governs how
495the alias is accessed. It will not have any effect in the aliasee.
496
Rafael Espindola3bc64d52014-05-26 21:30:40 +0000497.. _namedtypes:
498
Reid Kleckner7c84d1d2014-03-05 02:21:50 +0000499Structure Types
500---------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000501
Reid Kleckner7c84d1d2014-03-05 02:21:50 +0000502LLVM IR allows you to specify both "identified" and "literal" :ref:`structure
503types <t_struct>`. Literal types are uniqued structurally, but identified types
504are never uniqued. An :ref:`opaque structural type <t_opaque>` can also be used
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +0000505to forward declare a type that is not yet available.
Reid Kleckner7c84d1d2014-03-05 02:21:50 +0000506
507An example of a identified structure specification is:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000508
509.. code-block:: llvm
510
511 %mytype = type { %mytype*, i32 }
512
Reid Kleckner7c84d1d2014-03-05 02:21:50 +0000513Prior to the LLVM 3.0 release, identified types were structurally uniqued. Only
514literal types are uniqued in recent versions of LLVM.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000515
516.. _globalvars:
517
518Global Variables
519----------------
520
521Global variables define regions of memory allocated at compilation time
Rafael Espindola5d1b7452013-10-29 13:44:11 +0000522instead of run-time.
523
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000524Global variable definitions must be initialized.
Rafael Espindola5d1b7452013-10-29 13:44:11 +0000525
526Global variables in other translation units can also be declared, in which
527case they don't have an initializer.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000528
Bob Wilson85b24f22014-06-12 20:40:33 +0000529Either global variable definitions or declarations may have an explicit section
530to be placed in and may have an optional explicit alignment specified.
531
Michael Gottesman006039c2013-01-31 05:48:48 +0000532A variable may be defined as a global ``constant``, which indicates that
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000533the contents of the variable will **never** be modified (enabling better
534optimization, allowing the global data to be placed in the read-only
535section of an executable, etc). Note that variables that need runtime
Michael Gottesman1cffcf742013-01-31 05:44:04 +0000536initialization cannot be marked ``constant`` as there is a store to the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000537variable.
538
539LLVM explicitly allows *declarations* of global variables to be marked
540constant, even if the final definition of the global is not. This
541capability can be used to enable slightly better optimization of the
542program, but requires the language definition to guarantee that
543optimizations based on the 'constantness' are valid for the translation
544units that do not include the definition.
545
546As SSA values, global variables define pointer values that are in scope
547(i.e. they dominate) all basic blocks in the program. Global variables
548always define a pointer to their "content" type because they describe a
549region of memory, and all memory objects in LLVM are accessed through
550pointers.
551
552Global variables can be marked with ``unnamed_addr`` which indicates
553that the address is not significant, only the content. Constants marked
554like this can be merged with other constants if they have the same
555initializer. Note that a constant with significant address *can* be
556merged with a ``unnamed_addr`` constant, the result being a constant
557whose address is significant.
558
559A global variable may be declared to reside in a target-specific
560numbered address space. For targets that support them, address spaces
561may affect how optimizations are performed and/or what target
562instructions are used to access the variable. The default address space
563is zero. The address space qualifier must precede any other attributes.
564
565LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for globals. If the
566target supports it, it will emit globals to the section specified.
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000567Additionally, the global can placed in a comdat if the target has the necessary
568support.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000569
Michael Gottesmane743a302013-02-04 03:22:00 +0000570By default, global initializers are optimized by assuming that global
Michael Gottesmanef2bc772013-02-03 09:57:15 +0000571variables defined within the module are not modified from their
572initial values before the start of the global initializer. This is
573true even for variables potentially accessible from outside the
574module, including those with external linkage or appearing in
Yunzhong Gaof5b769e2013-12-05 18:37:54 +0000575``@llvm.used`` or dllexported variables. This assumption may be suppressed
576by marking the variable with ``externally_initialized``.
Michael Gottesmanef2bc772013-02-03 09:57:15 +0000577
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000578An explicit alignment may be specified for a global, which must be a
579power of 2. If not present, or if the alignment is set to zero, the
580alignment of the global is set by the target to whatever it feels
581convenient. If an explicit alignment is specified, the global is forced
582to have exactly that alignment. Targets and optimizers are not allowed
583to over-align the global if the global has an assigned section. In this
584case, the extra alignment could be observable: for example, code could
585assume that the globals are densely packed in their section and try to
586iterate over them as an array, alignment padding would break this
Reid Kleckner15fe7a52014-07-15 01:16:09 +0000587iteration. The maximum alignment is ``1 << 29``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000588
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000589Globals can also have a :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`.
590
Peter Collingbourne69ba0162015-02-04 00:42:45 +0000591Variables and aliases can have a
Rafael Espindola59f7eba2014-05-28 18:15:43 +0000592:ref:`Thread Local Storage Model <tls_model>`.
593
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000594Syntax::
595
596 [@<GlobalVarName> =] [Linkage] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal]
Rafael Espindola28f3ca62014-06-09 21:21:33 +0000597 [unnamed_addr] [AddrSpace] [ExternallyInitialized]
Bob Wilson85b24f22014-06-12 20:40:33 +0000598 <global | constant> <Type> [<InitializerConstant>]
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000599 [, section "name"] [, comdat [($name)]]
600 [, align <Alignment>]
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000601
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000602For example, the following defines a global in a numbered address space
603with an initializer, section, and alignment:
604
605.. code-block:: llvm
606
607 @G = addrspace(5) constant float 1.0, section "foo", align 4
608
Rafael Espindola5d1b7452013-10-29 13:44:11 +0000609The following example just declares a global variable
610
611.. code-block:: llvm
612
613 @G = external global i32
614
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000615The following example defines a thread-local global with the
616``initialexec`` TLS model:
617
618.. code-block:: llvm
619
620 @G = thread_local(initialexec) global i32 0, align 4
621
622.. _functionstructure:
623
624Functions
625---------
626
627LLVM function definitions consist of the "``define``" keyword, an
628optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`visibility
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000629style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
630an optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`,
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000631an optional ``unnamed_addr`` attribute, a return type, an optional
632:ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function
633name, a (possibly empty) argument list (each with optional :ref:`parameter
634attributes <paramattrs>`), optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>`,
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000635an optional section, an optional alignment,
636an optional :ref:`comdat <langref_comdats>`,
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +0000637an optional :ref:`garbage collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`,
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +0000638an optional :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`,
639an optional :ref:`personality <personalityfn>`,
640an opening curly brace, a list of basic blocks, and a closing curly brace.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000641
642LLVM function declarations consist of the "``declare``" keyword, an
643optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`visibility
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000644style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
645an optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`,
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000646an optional ``unnamed_addr`` attribute, a return type, an optional
647:ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +0000648name, a possibly empty list of arguments, an optional alignment, an optional
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +0000649:ref:`garbage collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`,
650and an optional :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000651
Bill Wendling6822ecb2013-10-27 05:09:12 +0000652A function definition contains a list of basic blocks, forming the CFG (Control
653Flow Graph) for the function. Each basic block may optionally start with a label
654(giving the basic block a symbol table entry), contains a list of instructions,
655and ends with a :ref:`terminator <terminators>` instruction (such as a branch or
656function return). If an explicit label is not provided, a block is assigned an
657implicit numbered label, using the next value from the same counter as used for
658unnamed temporaries (:ref:`see above<identifiers>`). For example, if a function
659entry block does not have an explicit label, it will be assigned label "%0",
660then the first unnamed temporary in that block will be "%1", etc.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000661
662The first basic block in a function is special in two ways: it is
663immediately executed on entrance to the function, and it is not allowed
664to have predecessor basic blocks (i.e. there can not be any branches to
665the entry block of a function). Because the block can have no
666predecessors, it also cannot have any :ref:`PHI nodes <i_phi>`.
667
668LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for functions. If the
669target supports it, it will emit functions to the section specified.
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000670Additionally, the function can be placed in a COMDAT.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000671
672An explicit alignment may be specified for a function. If not present,
673or if the alignment is set to zero, the alignment of the function is set
674by the target to whatever it feels convenient. If an explicit alignment
675is specified, the function is forced to have at least that much
676alignment. All alignments must be a power of 2.
677
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000678If the ``unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to not
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000679be significant and two identical functions can be merged.
680
681Syntax::
682
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000683 define [linkage] [visibility] [DLLStorageClass]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000684 [cconv] [ret attrs]
685 <ResultType> @<FunctionName> ([argument list])
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000686 [unnamed_addr] [fn Attrs] [section "name"] [comdat [($name)]]
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +0000687 [align N] [gc] [prefix Constant] [prologue Constant]
688 [personality Constant] { ... }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000689
Dan Liew2661dfc2014-08-20 15:06:30 +0000690The argument list is a comma seperated sequence of arguments where each
691argument is of the following form
692
693Syntax::
694
695 <type> [parameter Attrs] [name]
696
697
Eli Benderskyfdc529a2013-06-07 19:40:08 +0000698.. _langref_aliases:
699
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000700Aliases
701-------
702
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000703Aliases, unlike function or variables, don't create any new data. They
704are just a new symbol and metadata for an existing position.
705
706Aliases have a name and an aliasee that is either a global value or a
707constant expression.
708
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000709Aliases may have an optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000710:ref:`visibility style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class
711<dllstorageclass>` and an optional :ref:`tls model <tls_model>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000712
713Syntax::
714
Rafael Espindola464fe022014-07-30 22:51:54 +0000715 @<Name> = [Linkage] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal] [unnamed_addr] alias <AliaseeTy> @<Aliasee>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000716
Rafael Espindola2fb5bc32014-03-13 23:18:37 +0000717The linkage must be one of ``private``, ``internal``, ``linkonce``, ``weak``,
Rafael Espindola716e7402013-11-01 17:09:14 +0000718``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``, ``external``. Note that some system linkers
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000719might not correctly handle dropping a weak symbol that is aliased.
Rafael Espindola78527052013-10-06 15:10:43 +0000720
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000721Aliases that are not ``unnamed_addr`` are guaranteed to have the same address as
Rafael Espindola42a4c9f2014-06-06 01:20:28 +0000722the aliasee expression. ``unnamed_addr`` ones are only guaranteed to point
723to the same content.
Rafael Espindolaf3336bc2014-03-12 20:15:49 +0000724
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000725Since aliases are only a second name, some restrictions apply, of which
726some can only be checked when producing an object file:
Rafael Espindolaf3336bc2014-03-12 20:15:49 +0000727
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000728* The expression defining the aliasee must be computable at assembly
729 time. Since it is just a name, no relocations can be used.
730
731* No alias in the expression can be weak as the possibility of the
732 intermediate alias being overridden cannot be represented in an
733 object file.
734
735* No global value in the expression can be a declaration, since that
736 would require a relocation, which is not possible.
Rafael Espindola24a669d2014-03-27 15:26:56 +0000737
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000738.. _langref_comdats:
739
740Comdats
741-------
742
743Comdat IR provides access to COFF and ELF object file COMDAT functionality.
744
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +0000745Comdats have a name which represents the COMDAT key. All global objects that
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000746specify this key will only end up in the final object file if the linker chooses
747that key over some other key. Aliases are placed in the same COMDAT that their
748aliasee computes to, if any.
749
750Comdats have a selection kind to provide input on how the linker should
751choose between keys in two different object files.
752
753Syntax::
754
755 $<Name> = comdat SelectionKind
756
757The selection kind must be one of the following:
758
759``any``
760 The linker may choose any COMDAT key, the choice is arbitrary.
761``exactmatch``
762 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
763 same data.
764``largest``
765 The linker will choose the section containing the largest COMDAT key.
766``noduplicates``
767 The linker requires that only section with this COMDAT key exist.
768``samesize``
769 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
770 same amount of data.
771
772Note that the Mach-O platform doesn't support COMDATs and ELF only supports
773``any`` as a selection kind.
774
775Here is an example of a COMDAT group where a function will only be selected if
776the COMDAT key's section is the largest:
777
778.. code-block:: llvm
779
780 $foo = comdat largest
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000781 @foo = global i32 2, comdat($foo)
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000782
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000783 define void @bar() comdat($foo) {
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000784 ret void
785 }
786
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000787As a syntactic sugar the ``$name`` can be omitted if the name is the same as
788the global name:
789
790.. code-block:: llvm
791
792 $foo = comdat any
793 @foo = global i32 2, comdat
794
795
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000796In a COFF object file, this will create a COMDAT section with selection kind
797``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_LARGEST`` containing the contents of the ``@foo`` symbol
798and another COMDAT section with selection kind
799``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_ASSOCIATIVE`` which is associated with the first COMDAT
Hans Wennborg0def0662014-09-10 17:05:08 +0000800section and contains the contents of the ``@bar`` symbol.
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000801
802There are some restrictions on the properties of the global object.
803It, or an alias to it, must have the same name as the COMDAT group when
804targeting COFF.
805The contents and size of this object may be used during link-time to determine
806which COMDAT groups get selected depending on the selection kind.
807Because the name of the object must match the name of the COMDAT group, the
808linkage of the global object must not be local; local symbols can get renamed
809if a collision occurs in the symbol table.
810
811The combined use of COMDATS and section attributes may yield surprising results.
812For example:
813
814.. code-block:: llvm
815
816 $foo = comdat any
817 $bar = comdat any
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000818 @g1 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($foo)
819 @g2 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($bar)
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000820
821From the object file perspective, this requires the creation of two sections
822with the same name. This is necessary because both globals belong to different
823COMDAT groups and COMDATs, at the object file level, are represented by
824sections.
825
Peter Collingbourne1feef2e2015-06-30 19:10:31 +0000826Note that certain IR constructs like global variables and functions may
827create COMDATs in the object file in addition to any which are specified using
828COMDAT IR. This arises when the code generator is configured to emit globals
829in individual sections (e.g. when `-data-sections` or `-function-sections`
830is supplied to `llc`).
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000831
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000832.. _namedmetadatastructure:
833
834Named Metadata
835--------------
836
837Named metadata is a collection of metadata. :ref:`Metadata
838nodes <metadata>` (but not metadata strings) are the only valid
839operands for a named metadata.
840
Filipe Cabecinhas62431b12015-06-02 21:25:08 +0000841#. Named metadata are represented as a string of characters with the
842 metadata prefix. The rules for metadata names are the same as for
843 identifiers, but quoted names are not allowed. ``"\xx"`` type escapes
844 are still valid, which allows any character to be part of a name.
845
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000846Syntax::
847
848 ; Some unnamed metadata nodes, which are referenced by the named metadata.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +0000849 !0 = !{!"zero"}
850 !1 = !{!"one"}
851 !2 = !{!"two"}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000852 ; A named metadata.
853 !name = !{!0, !1, !2}
854
855.. _paramattrs:
856
857Parameter Attributes
858--------------------
859
860The return type and each parameter of a function type may have a set of
861*parameter attributes* associated with them. Parameter attributes are
862used to communicate additional information about the result or
863parameters of a function. Parameter attributes are considered to be part
864of the function, not of the function type, so functions with different
865parameter attributes can have the same function type.
866
867Parameter attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
868If multiple parameter attributes are needed, they are space separated.
869For example:
870
871.. code-block:: llvm
872
873 declare i32 @printf(i8* noalias nocapture, ...)
874 declare i32 @atoi(i8 zeroext)
875 declare signext i8 @returns_signed_char()
876
877Note that any attributes for the function result (``nounwind``,
878``readonly``) come immediately after the argument list.
879
880Currently, only the following parameter attributes are defined:
881
882``zeroext``
883 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
884 value should be zero-extended to the extent required by the target's
885 ABI (which is usually 32-bits, but is 8-bits for a i1 on x86-64) by
886 the caller (for a parameter) or the callee (for a return value).
887``signext``
888 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
889 value should be sign-extended to the extent required by the target's
890 ABI (which is usually 32-bits) by the caller (for a parameter) or
891 the callee (for a return value).
892``inreg``
893 This indicates that this parameter or return value should be treated
894 in a special target-dependent fashion during while emitting code for
895 a function call or return (usually, by putting it in a register as
896 opposed to memory, though some targets use it to distinguish between
897 two different kinds of registers). Use of this attribute is
898 target-specific.
899``byval``
900 This indicates that the pointer parameter should really be passed by
901 value to the function. The attribute implies that a hidden copy of
902 the pointee is made between the caller and the callee, so the callee
903 is unable to modify the value in the caller. This attribute is only
904 valid on LLVM pointer arguments. It is generally used to pass
905 structs and arrays by value, but is also valid on pointers to
906 scalars. The copy is considered to belong to the caller not the
907 callee (for example, ``readonly`` functions should not write to
908 ``byval`` parameters). This is not a valid attribute for return
909 values.
910
911 The byval attribute also supports specifying an alignment with the
912 align attribute. It indicates the alignment of the stack slot to
913 form and the known alignment of the pointer specified to the call
914 site. If the alignment is not specified, then the code generator
915 makes a target-specific assumption.
916
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +0000917.. _attr_inalloca:
918
919``inalloca``
920
Reid Kleckner60d3a832014-01-16 22:59:24 +0000921 The ``inalloca`` argument attribute allows the caller to take the
Reid Kleckner436c42e2014-01-17 23:58:17 +0000922 address of outgoing stack arguments. An ``inalloca`` argument must
923 be a pointer to stack memory produced by an ``alloca`` instruction.
924 The alloca, or argument allocation, must also be tagged with the
Hal Finkelc8491d32014-07-16 21:22:46 +0000925 inalloca keyword. Only the last argument may have the ``inalloca``
Reid Kleckner436c42e2014-01-17 23:58:17 +0000926 attribute, and that argument is guaranteed to be passed in memory.
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +0000927
Reid Kleckner436c42e2014-01-17 23:58:17 +0000928 An argument allocation may be used by a call at most once because
929 the call may deallocate it. The ``inalloca`` attribute cannot be
930 used in conjunction with other attributes that affect argument
Reid Klecknerf5b76512014-01-31 23:50:57 +0000931 storage, like ``inreg``, ``nest``, ``sret``, or ``byval``. The
932 ``inalloca`` attribute also disables LLVM's implicit lowering of
933 large aggregate return values, which means that frontend authors
934 must lower them with ``sret`` pointers.
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +0000935
Reid Kleckner60d3a832014-01-16 22:59:24 +0000936 When the call site is reached, the argument allocation must have
937 been the most recent stack allocation that is still live, or the
938 results are undefined. It is possible to allocate additional stack
939 space after an argument allocation and before its call site, but it
940 must be cleared off with :ref:`llvm.stackrestore
941 <int_stackrestore>`.
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +0000942
943 See :doc:`InAlloca` for more information on how to use this
944 attribute.
945
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000946``sret``
947 This indicates that the pointer parameter specifies the address of a
948 structure that is the return value of the function in the source
949 program. This pointer must be guaranteed by the caller to be valid:
Eli Bendersky4f2162f2013-01-23 22:05:19 +0000950 loads and stores to the structure may be assumed by the callee
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000951 not to trap and to be properly aligned. This may only be applied to
952 the first parameter. This is not a valid attribute for return
953 values.
Sean Silva1703e702014-04-08 21:06:22 +0000954
Hal Finkelccc70902014-07-22 16:58:55 +0000955``align <n>``
956 This indicates that the pointer value may be assumed by the optimizer to
957 have the specified alignment.
958
959 Note that this attribute has additional semantics when combined with the
960 ``byval`` attribute.
961
Sean Silva1703e702014-04-08 21:06:22 +0000962.. _noalias:
963
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000964``noalias``
Hal Finkel12d36302014-11-21 02:22:46 +0000965 This indicates that objects accessed via pointer values
966 :ref:`based <pointeraliasing>` on the argument or return value are not also
967 accessed, during the execution of the function, via pointer values not
968 *based* on the argument or return value. The attribute on a return value
969 also has additional semantics described below. The caller shares the
970 responsibility with the callee for ensuring that these requirements are met.
971 For further details, please see the discussion of the NoAlias response in
972 :ref:`alias analysis <Must, May, or No>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000973
974 Note that this definition of ``noalias`` is intentionally similar
Hal Finkel12d36302014-11-21 02:22:46 +0000975 to the definition of ``restrict`` in C99 for function arguments.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000976
977 For function return values, C99's ``restrict`` is not meaningful,
Hal Finkel12d36302014-11-21 02:22:46 +0000978 while LLVM's ``noalias`` is. Furthermore, the semantics of the ``noalias``
979 attribute on return values are stronger than the semantics of the attribute
980 when used on function arguments. On function return values, the ``noalias``
981 attribute indicates that the function acts like a system memory allocation
982 function, returning a pointer to allocated storage disjoint from the
983 storage for any other object accessible to the caller.
984
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000985``nocapture``
986 This indicates that the callee does not make any copies of the
987 pointer that outlive the callee itself. This is not a valid
988 attribute for return values.
989
990.. _nest:
991
992``nest``
993 This indicates that the pointer parameter can be excised using the
994 :ref:`trampoline intrinsics <int_trampoline>`. This is not a valid
Stephen Linb8bd2322013-04-20 05:14:40 +0000995 attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
996
997``returned``
Stephen Linfec5b0b2013-06-20 21:55:10 +0000998 This indicates that the function always returns the argument as its return
999 value. This is an optimization hint to the code generator when generating
1000 the caller, allowing tail call optimization and omission of register saves
1001 and restores in some cases; it is not checked or enforced when generating
1002 the callee. The parameter and the function return type must be valid
1003 operands for the :ref:`bitcast instruction <i_bitcast>`. This is not a
1004 valid attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001005
Nick Lewyckyd52b1522014-05-20 01:23:40 +00001006``nonnull``
1007 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is not null. This
1008 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. This is not
1009 checked or enforced by LLVM, the caller must ensure that the pointer
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001010 passed in is non-null, or the callee must ensure that the returned pointer
Nick Lewyckyd52b1522014-05-20 01:23:40 +00001011 is non-null.
1012
Hal Finkelb0407ba2014-07-18 15:51:28 +00001013``dereferenceable(<n>)``
1014 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is dereferenceable. This
1015 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. A pointer that
1016 is dereferenceable can be loaded from speculatively without a risk of
1017 trapping. The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable must be provided
1018 in parentheses. It is legal for the number of bytes to be less than the
1019 size of the pointee type. The ``nonnull`` attribute does not imply
1020 dereferenceability (consider a pointer to one element past the end of an
1021 array), however ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` does imply ``nonnull`` in
1022 ``addrspace(0)`` (which is the default address space).
1023
Sanjoy Das31ea6d12015-04-16 20:29:50 +00001024``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
1025 This indicates that the parameter or return value isn't both
1026 non-null and non-dereferenceable (up to ``<n>`` bytes) at the same
1027 time. All non-null pointers tagged with
1028 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` are ``dereferenceable(<n>)``.
1029 For address space 0 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` implies that
1030 a pointer is exactly one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` or ``null``,
1031 and in other address spaces ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
1032 implies that a pointer is at least one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)``
1033 or ``null`` (i.e. it may be both ``null`` and
1034 ``dereferenceable(<n>)``). This attribute may only be applied to
1035 pointer typed parameters.
1036
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001037.. _gc:
1038
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00001039Garbage Collector Strategy Names
1040--------------------------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001041
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00001042Each function may specify a garbage collector strategy name, which is simply a
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001043string:
1044
1045.. code-block:: llvm
1046
1047 define void @f() gc "name" { ... }
1048
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001049The supported values of *name* includes those :ref:`built in to LLVM
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00001050<builtin-gc-strategies>` and any provided by loaded plugins. Specifying a GC
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001051strategy will cause the compiler to alter its output in order to support the
1052named garbage collection algorithm. Note that LLVM itself does not contain a
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00001053garbage collector, this functionality is restricted to generating machine code
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001054which can interoperate with a collector provided externally.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001055
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001056.. _prefixdata:
1057
1058Prefix Data
1059-----------
1060
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001061Prefix data is data associated with a function which the code
1062generator will emit immediately before the function's entrypoint.
1063The purpose of this feature is to allow frontends to associate
1064language-specific runtime metadata with specific functions and make it
1065available through the function pointer while still allowing the
1066function pointer to be called.
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001067
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001068To access the data for a given function, a program may bitcast the
1069function pointer to a pointer to the constant's type and dereference
1070index -1. This implies that the IR symbol points just past the end of
1071the prefix data. For instance, take the example of a function annotated
1072with a single ``i32``,
1073
1074.. code-block:: llvm
1075
1076 define void @f() prefix i32 123 { ... }
1077
1078The prefix data can be referenced as,
1079
1080.. code-block:: llvm
1081
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00001082 %0 = bitcast void* () @f to i32*
1083 %a = getelementptr inbounds i32, i32* %0, i32 -1
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00001084 %b = load i32, i32* %a
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001085
1086Prefix data is laid out as if it were an initializer for a global variable
1087of the prefix data's type. The function will be placed such that the
1088beginning of the prefix data is aligned. This means that if the size
1089of the prefix data is not a multiple of the alignment size, the
1090function's entrypoint will not be aligned. If alignment of the
1091function's entrypoint is desired, padding must be added to the prefix
1092data.
1093
1094A function may have prefix data but no body. This has similar semantics
1095to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
1096optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
1097
1098.. _prologuedata:
1099
1100Prologue Data
1101-------------
1102
1103The ``prologue`` attribute allows arbitrary code (encoded as bytes) to
1104be inserted prior to the function body. This can be used for enabling
1105function hot-patching and instrumentation.
1106
1107To maintain the semantics of ordinary function calls, the prologue data must
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001108have a particular format. Specifically, it must begin with a sequence of
1109bytes which decode to a sequence of machine instructions, valid for the
1110module's target, which transfer control to the point immediately succeeding
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001111the prologue data, without performing any other visible action. This allows
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001112the inliner and other passes to reason about the semantics of the function
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001113definition without needing to reason about the prologue data. Obviously this
1114makes the format of the prologue data highly target dependent.
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001115
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001116A trivial example of valid prologue data for the x86 architecture is ``i8 144``,
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001117which encodes the ``nop`` instruction:
1118
1119.. code-block:: llvm
1120
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001121 define void @f() prologue i8 144 { ... }
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001122
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001123Generally prologue data can be formed by encoding a relative branch instruction
1124which skips the metadata, as in this example of valid prologue data for the
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001125x86_64 architecture, where the first two bytes encode ``jmp .+10``:
1126
1127.. code-block:: llvm
1128
1129 %0 = type <{ i8, i8, i8* }>
1130
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001131 define void @f() prologue %0 <{ i8 235, i8 8, i8* @md}> { ... }
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001132
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001133A function may have prologue data but no body. This has similar semantics
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001134to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
1135optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
1136
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00001137.. _personalityfn:
1138
1139Personality Function
David Majnemerc5ad8a92015-06-17 21:21:16 +00001140--------------------
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00001141
1142The ``personality`` attribute permits functions to specify what function
1143to use for exception handling.
1144
Bill Wendling63b88192013-02-06 06:52:58 +00001145.. _attrgrp:
1146
1147Attribute Groups
1148----------------
1149
1150Attribute groups are groups of attributes that are referenced by objects within
1151the IR. They are important for keeping ``.ll`` files readable, because a lot of
1152functions will use the same set of attributes. In the degenerative case of a
1153``.ll`` file that corresponds to a single ``.c`` file, the single attribute
1154group will capture the important command line flags used to build that file.
1155
1156An attribute group is a module-level object. To use an attribute group, an
1157object references the attribute group's ID (e.g. ``#37``). An object may refer
1158to more than one attribute group. In that situation, the attributes from the
1159different groups are merged.
1160
1161Here is an example of attribute groups for a function that should always be
1162inlined, has a stack alignment of 4, and which shouldn't use SSE instructions:
1163
1164.. code-block:: llvm
1165
1166 ; Target-independent attributes:
Eli Bendersky97ad9242013-04-18 16:11:44 +00001167 attributes #0 = { alwaysinline alignstack=4 }
Bill Wendling63b88192013-02-06 06:52:58 +00001168
1169 ; Target-dependent attributes:
Eli Bendersky97ad9242013-04-18 16:11:44 +00001170 attributes #1 = { "no-sse" }
Bill Wendling63b88192013-02-06 06:52:58 +00001171
1172 ; Function @f has attributes: alwaysinline, alignstack=4, and "no-sse".
1173 define void @f() #0 #1 { ... }
1174
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001175.. _fnattrs:
1176
1177Function Attributes
1178-------------------
1179
1180Function attributes are set to communicate additional information about
1181a function. Function attributes are considered to be part of the
1182function, not of the function type, so functions with different function
1183attributes can have the same function type.
1184
1185Function attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
1186If multiple attributes are needed, they are space separated. For
1187example:
1188
1189.. code-block:: llvm
1190
1191 define void @f() noinline { ... }
1192 define void @f() alwaysinline { ... }
1193 define void @f() alwaysinline optsize { ... }
1194 define void @f() optsize { ... }
1195
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001196``alignstack(<n>)``
1197 This attribute indicates that, when emitting the prologue and
1198 epilogue, the backend should forcibly align the stack pointer.
1199 Specify the desired alignment, which must be a power of two, in
1200 parentheses.
1201``alwaysinline``
1202 This attribute indicates that the inliner should attempt to inline
1203 this function into callers whenever possible, ignoring any active
1204 inlining size threshold for this caller.
Michael Gottesman41748d72013-06-27 00:25:01 +00001205``builtin``
1206 This indicates that the callee function at a call site should be
1207 recognized as a built-in function, even though the function's declaration
Michael Gottesman3a6a9672013-07-02 21:32:56 +00001208 uses the ``nobuiltin`` attribute. This is only valid at call sites for
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00001209 direct calls to functions that are declared with the ``nobuiltin``
Michael Gottesman41748d72013-06-27 00:25:01 +00001210 attribute.
Michael Gottesman296adb82013-06-27 22:48:08 +00001211``cold``
1212 This attribute indicates that this function is rarely called. When
1213 computing edge weights, basic blocks post-dominated by a cold
1214 function call are also considered to be cold; and, thus, given low
1215 weight.
Owen Anderson85fa7d52015-05-26 23:48:40 +00001216``convergent``
1217 This attribute indicates that the callee is dependent on a convergent
1218 thread execution pattern under certain parallel execution models.
1219 Transformations that are execution model agnostic may only move or
1220 tranform this call if the final location is control equivalent to its
1221 original position in the program, where control equivalence is defined as
1222 A dominates B and B post-dominates A, or vice versa.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001223``inlinehint``
1224 This attribute indicates that the source code contained a hint that
1225 inlining this function is desirable (such as the "inline" keyword in
1226 C/C++). It is just a hint; it imposes no requirements on the
1227 inliner.
Tom Roeder44cb65f2014-06-05 19:29:43 +00001228``jumptable``
1229 This attribute indicates that the function should be added to a
1230 jump-instruction table at code-generation time, and that all address-taken
1231 references to this function should be replaced with a reference to the
1232 appropriate jump-instruction-table function pointer. Note that this creates
1233 a new pointer for the original function, which means that code that depends
1234 on function-pointer identity can break. So, any function annotated with
1235 ``jumptable`` must also be ``unnamed_addr``.
Andrea Di Biagio9b5d23b2013-08-09 18:42:18 +00001236``minsize``
1237 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
1238 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function as small
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001239 as possible and perform optimizations that may sacrifice runtime
Andrea Di Biagio9b5d23b2013-08-09 18:42:18 +00001240 performance in order to minimize the size of the generated code.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001241``naked``
1242 This attribute disables prologue / epilogue emission for the
1243 function. This can have very system-specific consequences.
Eli Bendersky97ad9242013-04-18 16:11:44 +00001244``nobuiltin``
Michael Gottesman41748d72013-06-27 00:25:01 +00001245 This indicates that the callee function at a call site is not recognized as
1246 a built-in function. LLVM will retain the original call and not replace it
1247 with equivalent code based on the semantics of the built-in function, unless
1248 the call site uses the ``builtin`` attribute. This is valid at call sites
1249 and on function declarations and definitions.
Bill Wendlingbf902f12013-02-06 06:22:58 +00001250``noduplicate``
1251 This attribute indicates that calls to the function cannot be
1252 duplicated. A call to a ``noduplicate`` function may be moved
1253 within its parent function, but may not be duplicated within
1254 its parent function.
1255
1256 A function containing a ``noduplicate`` call may still
1257 be an inlining candidate, provided that the call is not
1258 duplicated by inlining. That implies that the function has
1259 internal linkage and only has one call site, so the original
1260 call is dead after inlining.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001261``noimplicitfloat``
1262 This attributes disables implicit floating point instructions.
1263``noinline``
1264 This attribute indicates that the inliner should never inline this
1265 function in any situation. This attribute may not be used together
1266 with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute.
Sean Silva1cbbcf12013-08-06 19:34:37 +00001267``nonlazybind``
1268 This attribute suppresses lazy symbol binding for the function. This
1269 may make calls to the function faster, at the cost of extra program
1270 startup time if the function is not called during program startup.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001271``noredzone``
1272 This attribute indicates that the code generator should not use a
1273 red zone, even if the target-specific ABI normally permits it.
1274``noreturn``
1275 This function attribute indicates that the function never returns
1276 normally. This produces undefined behavior at runtime if the
1277 function ever does dynamically return.
1278``nounwind``
Reid Kleckner96d01132015-02-11 01:23:16 +00001279 This function attribute indicates that the function never raises an
1280 exception. If the function does raise an exception, its runtime
1281 behavior is undefined. However, functions marked nounwind may still
1282 trap or generate asynchronous exceptions. Exception handling schemes
1283 that are recognized by LLVM to handle asynchronous exceptions, such
1284 as SEH, will still provide their implementation defined semantics.
Andrea Di Biagio377496b2013-08-23 11:53:55 +00001285``optnone``
1286 This function attribute indicates that the function is not optimized
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001287 by any optimization or code generator passes with the
Andrea Di Biagio377496b2013-08-23 11:53:55 +00001288 exception of interprocedural optimization passes.
1289 This attribute cannot be used together with the ``alwaysinline``
1290 attribute; this attribute is also incompatible
1291 with the ``minsize`` attribute and the ``optsize`` attribute.
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001292
Paul Robinsondcbe35b2013-11-18 21:44:03 +00001293 This attribute requires the ``noinline`` attribute to be specified on
1294 the function as well, so the function is never inlined into any caller.
Andrea Di Biagio377496b2013-08-23 11:53:55 +00001295 Only functions with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute are valid
Paul Robinsondcbe35b2013-11-18 21:44:03 +00001296 candidates for inlining into the body of this function.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001297``optsize``
1298 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
1299 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function low,
Andrea Di Biagio9b5d23b2013-08-09 18:42:18 +00001300 and otherwise do optimizations specifically to reduce code size as
1301 long as they do not significantly impact runtime performance.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001302``readnone``
Nick Lewyckyc2ec0722013-07-06 00:29:58 +00001303 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function computes its
1304 result (or decides to unwind an exception) based strictly on its arguments,
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001305 without dereferencing any pointer arguments or otherwise accessing
1306 any mutable state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
1307 caller functions. It does not write through any pointer arguments
1308 (including ``byval`` arguments) and never changes any state visible
1309 to callers. This means that it cannot unwind exceptions by calling
1310 the ``C++`` exception throwing methods.
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001311
Nick Lewyckyc2ec0722013-07-06 00:29:58 +00001312 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not
1313 dereference that pointer argument, even though it may read or write the
Nick Lewyckyefe31f22013-07-06 01:04:47 +00001314 memory that the pointer points to if accessed through other pointers.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001315``readonly``
Nick Lewyckyc2ec0722013-07-06 00:29:58 +00001316 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
1317 through any pointer arguments (including ``byval`` arguments) or otherwise
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001318 modify any state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
1319 caller functions. It may dereference pointer arguments and read
1320 state that may be set in the caller. A readonly function always
1321 returns the same value (or unwinds an exception identically) when
1322 called with the same set of arguments and global state. It cannot
1323 unwind an exception by calling the ``C++`` exception throwing
1324 methods.
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001325
Nick Lewyckyc2ec0722013-07-06 00:29:58 +00001326 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
1327 through this pointer argument, even though it may write to the memory that
1328 the pointer points to.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001329``returns_twice``
1330 This attribute indicates that this function can return twice. The C
1331 ``setjmp`` is an example of such a function. The compiler disables
1332 some optimizations (like tail calls) in the caller of these
1333 functions.
Peter Collingbourne82437bf2015-06-15 21:07:11 +00001334``safestack``
1335 This attribute indicates that
1336 `SafeStack <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/SafeStack.html>`_
1337 protection is enabled for this function.
1338
1339 If a function that has a ``safestack`` attribute is inlined into a
1340 function that doesn't have a ``safestack`` attribute or which has an
1341 ``ssp``, ``sspstrong`` or ``sspreq`` attribute, then the resulting
1342 function will have a ``safestack`` attribute.
Kostya Serebryanycf880b92013-02-26 06:58:09 +00001343``sanitize_address``
1344 This attribute indicates that AddressSanitizer checks
1345 (dynamic address safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
1346``sanitize_memory``
1347 This attribute indicates that MemorySanitizer checks (dynamic detection
1348 of accesses to uninitialized memory) are enabled for this function.
1349``sanitize_thread``
1350 This attribute indicates that ThreadSanitizer checks
1351 (dynamic thread safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001352``ssp``
1353 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00001354 smashing protector. It is in the form of a "canary" --- a random value
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001355 placed on the stack before the local variables that's checked upon
1356 return from the function to see if it has been overwritten. A
1357 heuristic is used to determine if a function needs stack protectors
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001358 or not. The heuristic used will enable protectors for functions with:
Dmitri Gribenko69b56472013-01-29 23:14:41 +00001359
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001360 - Character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size`` (default 8).
1361 - Aggregates containing character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size``.
1362 - Calls to alloca() with variable sizes or constant sizes greater than
1363 ``ssp-buffer-size``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001364
Josh Magee24c7f062014-02-01 01:36:16 +00001365 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1366 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1367
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001368 If a function that has an ``ssp`` attribute is inlined into a
1369 function that doesn't have an ``ssp`` attribute, then the resulting
1370 function will have an ``ssp`` attribute.
1371``sspreq``
1372 This attribute indicates that the function should *always* emit a
1373 stack smashing protector. This overrides the ``ssp`` function
1374 attribute.
1375
Josh Magee24c7f062014-02-01 01:36:16 +00001376 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1377 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1378 The specific layout rules are:
1379
1380 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
1381 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
1382 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
1383 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
1384 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
1385 protector.
1386
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001387 If a function that has an ``sspreq`` attribute is inlined into a
1388 function that doesn't have an ``sspreq`` attribute or which has an
Bill Wendlingd154e2832013-01-23 06:41:41 +00001389 ``ssp`` or ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the resulting function will have
1390 an ``sspreq`` attribute.
1391``sspstrong``
1392 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack smashing
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001393 protector. This attribute causes a strong heuristic to be used when
1394 determining if a function needs stack protectors. The strong heuristic
1395 will enable protectors for functions with:
Dmitri Gribenko69b56472013-01-29 23:14:41 +00001396
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001397 - Arrays of any size and type
1398 - Aggregates containing an array of any size and type.
1399 - Calls to alloca().
1400 - Local variables that have had their address taken.
1401
Josh Magee24c7f062014-02-01 01:36:16 +00001402 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1403 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1404 The specific layout rules are:
1405
1406 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
1407 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
1408 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
1409 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
1410 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
1411 protector.
1412
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001413 This overrides the ``ssp`` function attribute.
Bill Wendlingd154e2832013-01-23 06:41:41 +00001414
1415 If a function that has an ``sspstrong`` attribute is inlined into a
1416 function that doesn't have an ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the
1417 resulting function will have an ``sspstrong`` attribute.
Reid Kleckner5a2ab2b2015-03-04 00:08:56 +00001418``"thunk"``
1419 This attribute indicates that the function will delegate to some other
1420 function with a tail call. The prototype of a thunk should not be used for
1421 optimization purposes. The caller is expected to cast the thunk prototype to
1422 match the thunk target prototype.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001423``uwtable``
1424 This attribute indicates that the ABI being targeted requires that
1425 an unwind table entry be produce for this function even if we can
1426 show that no exceptions passes by it. This is normally the case for
1427 the ELF x86-64 abi, but it can be disabled for some compilation
1428 units.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001429
1430.. _moduleasm:
1431
1432Module-Level Inline Assembly
1433----------------------------
1434
1435Modules may contain "module-level inline asm" blocks, which corresponds
1436to the GCC "file scope inline asm" blocks. These blocks are internally
1437concatenated by LLVM and treated as a single unit, but may be separated
1438in the ``.ll`` file if desired. The syntax is very simple:
1439
1440.. code-block:: llvm
1441
1442 module asm "inline asm code goes here"
1443 module asm "more can go here"
1444
1445The strings can contain any character by escaping non-printable
1446characters. The escape sequence used is simply "\\xx" where "xx" is the
1447two digit hex code for the number.
1448
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00001449Note that the assembly string *must* be parseable by LLVM's integrated assembler
1450(unless it is disabled), even when emitting a ``.s`` file.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001451
Eli Benderskyfdc529a2013-06-07 19:40:08 +00001452.. _langref_datalayout:
1453
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001454Data Layout
1455-----------
1456
1457A module may specify a target specific data layout string that specifies
1458how data is to be laid out in memory. The syntax for the data layout is
1459simply:
1460
1461.. code-block:: llvm
1462
1463 target datalayout = "layout specification"
1464
1465The *layout specification* consists of a list of specifications
1466separated by the minus sign character ('-'). Each specification starts
1467with a letter and may include other information after the letter to
1468define some aspect of the data layout. The specifications accepted are
1469as follows:
1470
1471``E``
1472 Specifies that the target lays out data in big-endian form. That is,
1473 the bits with the most significance have the lowest address
1474 location.
1475``e``
1476 Specifies that the target lays out data in little-endian form. That
1477 is, the bits with the least significance have the lowest address
1478 location.
1479``S<size>``
1480 Specifies the natural alignment of the stack in bits. Alignment
1481 promotion of stack variables is limited to the natural stack
1482 alignment to avoid dynamic stack realignment. The stack alignment
1483 must be a multiple of 8-bits. If omitted, the natural stack
1484 alignment defaults to "unspecified", which does not prevent any
1485 alignment promotions.
1486``p[n]:<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1487 This specifies the *size* of a pointer and its ``<abi>`` and
1488 ``<pref>``\erred alignments for address space ``n``. All sizes are in
Rafael Espindolaabdd7262014-01-06 21:40:24 +00001489 bits. The address space, ``n`` is optional, and if not specified,
1490 denotes the default address space 0. The value of ``n`` must be
1491 in the range [1,2^23).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001492``i<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1493 This specifies the alignment for an integer type of a given bit
1494 ``<size>``. The value of ``<size>`` must be in the range [1,2^23).
1495``v<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1496 This specifies the alignment for a vector type of a given bit
1497 ``<size>``.
1498``f<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1499 This specifies the alignment for a floating point type of a given bit
1500 ``<size>``. Only values of ``<size>`` that are supported by the target
1501 will work. 32 (float) and 64 (double) are supported on all targets; 80
1502 or 128 (different flavors of long double) are also supported on some
1503 targets.
Rafael Espindolaabdd7262014-01-06 21:40:24 +00001504``a:<abi>:<pref>``
1505 This specifies the alignment for an object of aggregate type.
Rafael Espindola58873562014-01-03 19:21:54 +00001506``m:<mangling>``
Hans Wennborgd4245ac2014-01-15 02:49:17 +00001507 If present, specifies that llvm names are mangled in the output. The
1508 options are
1509
1510 * ``e``: ELF mangling: Private symbols get a ``.L`` prefix.
1511 * ``m``: Mips mangling: Private symbols get a ``$`` prefix.
1512 * ``o``: Mach-O mangling: Private symbols get ``L`` prefix. Other
1513 symbols get a ``_`` prefix.
1514 * ``w``: Windows COFF prefix: Similar to Mach-O, but stdcall and fastcall
1515 functions also get a suffix based on the frame size.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001516``n<size1>:<size2>:<size3>...``
1517 This specifies a set of native integer widths for the target CPU in
1518 bits. For example, it might contain ``n32`` for 32-bit PowerPC,
1519 ``n32:64`` for PowerPC 64, or ``n8:16:32:64`` for X86-64. Elements of
1520 this set are considered to support most general arithmetic operations
1521 efficiently.
1522
Rafael Espindolaabdd7262014-01-06 21:40:24 +00001523On every specification that takes a ``<abi>:<pref>``, specifying the
1524``<pref>`` alignment is optional. If omitted, the preceding ``:``
1525should be omitted too and ``<pref>`` will be equal to ``<abi>``.
1526
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001527When constructing the data layout for a given target, LLVM starts with a
1528default set of specifications which are then (possibly) overridden by
1529the specifications in the ``datalayout`` keyword. The default
1530specifications are given in this list:
1531
1532- ``E`` - big endian
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00001533- ``p:64:64:64`` - 64-bit pointers with 64-bit alignment.
1534- ``p[n]:64:64:64`` - Other address spaces are assumed to be the
1535 same as the default address space.
Patrik Hagglunda832ab12013-01-30 09:02:06 +00001536- ``S0`` - natural stack alignment is unspecified
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001537- ``i1:8:8`` - i1 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
1538- ``i8:8:8`` - i8 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
1539- ``i16:16:16`` - i16 is 16-bit aligned
1540- ``i32:32:32`` - i32 is 32-bit aligned
1541- ``i64:32:64`` - i64 has ABI alignment of 32-bits but preferred
1542 alignment of 64-bits
Patrik Hagglunda832ab12013-01-30 09:02:06 +00001543- ``f16:16:16`` - half is 16-bit aligned
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001544- ``f32:32:32`` - float is 32-bit aligned
1545- ``f64:64:64`` - double is 64-bit aligned
Patrik Hagglunda832ab12013-01-30 09:02:06 +00001546- ``f128:128:128`` - quad is 128-bit aligned
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001547- ``v64:64:64`` - 64-bit vector is 64-bit aligned
1548- ``v128:128:128`` - 128-bit vector is 128-bit aligned
Rafael Espindolae8f4d582013-12-12 17:21:51 +00001549- ``a:0:64`` - aggregates are 64-bit aligned
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001550
1551When LLVM is determining the alignment for a given type, it uses the
1552following rules:
1553
1554#. If the type sought is an exact match for one of the specifications,
1555 that specification is used.
1556#. If no match is found, and the type sought is an integer type, then
1557 the smallest integer type that is larger than the bitwidth of the
1558 sought type is used. If none of the specifications are larger than
1559 the bitwidth then the largest integer type is used. For example,
1560 given the default specifications above, the i7 type will use the
1561 alignment of i8 (next largest) while both i65 and i256 will use the
1562 alignment of i64 (largest specified).
1563#. If no match is found, and the type sought is a vector type, then the
1564 largest vector type that is smaller than the sought vector type will
1565 be used as a fall back. This happens because <128 x double> can be
1566 implemented in terms of 64 <2 x double>, for example.
1567
1568The function of the data layout string may not be what you expect.
1569Notably, this is not a specification from the frontend of what alignment
1570the code generator should use.
1571
1572Instead, if specified, the target data layout is required to match what
1573the ultimate *code generator* expects. This string is used by the
1574mid-level optimizers to improve code, and this only works if it matches
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001575what the ultimate code generator uses. There is no way to generate IR
1576that does not embed this target-specific detail into the IR. If you
1577don't specify the string, the default specifications will be used to
1578generate a Data Layout and the optimization phases will operate
1579accordingly and introduce target specificity into the IR with respect to
1580these default specifications.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001581
Bill Wendling5cc90842013-10-18 23:41:25 +00001582.. _langref_triple:
1583
1584Target Triple
1585-------------
1586
1587A module may specify a target triple string that describes the target
1588host. The syntax for the target triple is simply:
1589
1590.. code-block:: llvm
1591
1592 target triple = "x86_64-apple-macosx10.7.0"
1593
1594The *target triple* string consists of a series of identifiers delimited
1595by the minus sign character ('-'). The canonical forms are:
1596
1597::
1598
1599 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM
1600 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM-ENVIRONMENT
1601
1602This information is passed along to the backend so that it generates
1603code for the proper architecture. It's possible to override this on the
1604command line with the ``-mtriple`` command line option.
1605
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001606.. _pointeraliasing:
1607
1608Pointer Aliasing Rules
1609----------------------
1610
1611Any memory access must be done through a pointer value associated with
1612an address range of the memory access, otherwise the behavior is
1613undefined. Pointer values are associated with address ranges according
1614to the following rules:
1615
1616- A pointer value is associated with the addresses associated with any
1617 value it is *based* on.
1618- An address of a global variable is associated with the address range
1619 of the variable's storage.
1620- The result value of an allocation instruction is associated with the
1621 address range of the allocated storage.
1622- A null pointer in the default address-space is associated with no
1623 address.
1624- An integer constant other than zero or a pointer value returned from
1625 a function not defined within LLVM may be associated with address
1626 ranges allocated through mechanisms other than those provided by
1627 LLVM. Such ranges shall not overlap with any ranges of addresses
1628 allocated by mechanisms provided by LLVM.
1629
1630A pointer value is *based* on another pointer value according to the
1631following rules:
1632
1633- A pointer value formed from a ``getelementptr`` operation is *based*
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00001634 on the first value operand of the ``getelementptr``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001635- The result value of a ``bitcast`` is *based* on the operand of the
1636 ``bitcast``.
1637- A pointer value formed by an ``inttoptr`` is *based* on all pointer
1638 values that contribute (directly or indirectly) to the computation of
1639 the pointer's value.
1640- The "*based* on" relationship is transitive.
1641
1642Note that this definition of *"based"* is intentionally similar to the
1643definition of *"based"* in C99, though it is slightly weaker.
1644
1645LLVM IR does not associate types with memory. The result type of a
1646``load`` merely indicates the size and alignment of the memory from
1647which to load, as well as the interpretation of the value. The first
1648operand type of a ``store`` similarly only indicates the size and
1649alignment of the store.
1650
1651Consequently, type-based alias analysis, aka TBAA, aka
1652``-fstrict-aliasing``, is not applicable to general unadorned LLVM IR.
1653:ref:`Metadata <metadata>` may be used to encode additional information
1654which specialized optimization passes may use to implement type-based
1655alias analysis.
1656
1657.. _volatile:
1658
1659Volatile Memory Accesses
1660------------------------
1661
1662Certain memory accesses, such as :ref:`load <i_load>`'s,
1663:ref:`store <i_store>`'s, and :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`'s may be
1664marked ``volatile``. The optimizers must not change the number of
1665volatile operations or change their order of execution relative to other
1666volatile operations. The optimizers *may* change the order of volatile
1667operations relative to non-volatile operations. This is not Java's
1668"volatile" and has no cross-thread synchronization behavior.
1669
Andrew Trick89fc5a62013-01-30 21:19:35 +00001670IR-level volatile loads and stores cannot safely be optimized into
1671llvm.memcpy or llvm.memmove intrinsics even when those intrinsics are
1672flagged volatile. Likewise, the backend should never split or merge
1673target-legal volatile load/store instructions.
1674
Andrew Trick7e6f9282013-01-31 00:49:39 +00001675.. admonition:: Rationale
1676
1677 Platforms may rely on volatile loads and stores of natively supported
1678 data width to be executed as single instruction. For example, in C
1679 this holds for an l-value of volatile primitive type with native
1680 hardware support, but not necessarily for aggregate types. The
1681 frontend upholds these expectations, which are intentionally
1682 unspecified in the IR. The rules above ensure that IR transformation
1683 do not violate the frontend's contract with the language.
1684
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001685.. _memmodel:
1686
1687Memory Model for Concurrent Operations
1688--------------------------------------
1689
1690The LLVM IR does not define any way to start parallel threads of
1691execution or to register signal handlers. Nonetheless, there are
1692platform-specific ways to create them, and we define LLVM IR's behavior
1693in their presence. This model is inspired by the C++0x memory model.
1694
1695For a more informal introduction to this model, see the :doc:`Atomics`.
1696
1697We define a *happens-before* partial order as the least partial order
1698that
1699
1700- Is a superset of single-thread program order, and
1701- When a *synchronizes-with* ``b``, includes an edge from ``a`` to
1702 ``b``. *Synchronizes-with* pairs are introduced by platform-specific
1703 techniques, like pthread locks, thread creation, thread joining,
1704 etc., and by atomic instructions. (See also :ref:`Atomic Memory Ordering
1705 Constraints <ordering>`).
1706
1707Note that program order does not introduce *happens-before* edges
1708between a thread and signals executing inside that thread.
1709
1710Every (defined) read operation (load instructions, memcpy, atomic
1711loads/read-modify-writes, etc.) R reads a series of bytes written by
1712(defined) write operations (store instructions, atomic
1713stores/read-modify-writes, memcpy, etc.). For the purposes of this
1714section, initialized globals are considered to have a write of the
1715initializer which is atomic and happens before any other read or write
1716of the memory in question. For each byte of a read R, R\ :sub:`byte`
1717may see any write to the same byte, except:
1718
1719- If write\ :sub:`1` happens before write\ :sub:`2`, and
1720 write\ :sub:`2` happens before R\ :sub:`byte`, then
1721 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`1`.
1722- If R\ :sub:`byte` happens before write\ :sub:`3`, then
1723 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`3`.
1724
1725Given that definition, R\ :sub:`byte` is defined as follows:
1726
1727- If R is volatile, the result is target-dependent. (Volatile is
1728 supposed to give guarantees which can support ``sig_atomic_t`` in
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00001729 C/C++, and may be used for accesses to addresses that do not behave
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001730 like normal memory. It does not generally provide cross-thread
1731 synchronization.)
1732- Otherwise, if there is no write to the same byte that happens before
1733 R\ :sub:`byte`, R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef`` for that byte.
1734- Otherwise, if R\ :sub:`byte` may see exactly one write,
1735 R\ :sub:`byte` returns the value written by that write.
1736- Otherwise, if R is atomic, and all the writes R\ :sub:`byte` may
1737 see are atomic, it chooses one of the values written. See the :ref:`Atomic
1738 Memory Ordering Constraints <ordering>` section for additional
1739 constraints on how the choice is made.
1740- Otherwise R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef``.
1741
1742R returns the value composed of the series of bytes it read. This
1743implies that some bytes within the value may be ``undef`` **without**
1744the entire value being ``undef``. Note that this only defines the
1745semantics of the operation; it doesn't mean that targets will emit more
1746than one instruction to read the series of bytes.
1747
1748Note that in cases where none of the atomic intrinsics are used, this
1749model places only one restriction on IR transformations on top of what
1750is required for single-threaded execution: introducing a store to a byte
1751which might not otherwise be stored is not allowed in general.
1752(Specifically, in the case where another thread might write to and read
1753from an address, introducing a store can change a load that may see
1754exactly one write into a load that may see multiple writes.)
1755
1756.. _ordering:
1757
1758Atomic Memory Ordering Constraints
1759----------------------------------
1760
1761Atomic instructions (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>`,
1762:ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`, :ref:`fence <i_fence>`,
1763:ref:`atomic load <i_load>`, and :ref:`atomic store <i_store>`) take
Tim Northovere94a5182014-03-11 10:48:52 +00001764ordering parameters that determine which other atomic instructions on
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001765the same address they *synchronize with*. These semantics are borrowed
1766from Java and C++0x, but are somewhat more colloquial. If these
1767descriptions aren't precise enough, check those specs (see spec
1768references in the :doc:`atomics guide <Atomics>`).
1769:ref:`fence <i_fence>` instructions treat these orderings somewhat
1770differently since they don't take an address. See that instruction's
1771documentation for details.
1772
1773For a simpler introduction to the ordering constraints, see the
1774:doc:`Atomics`.
1775
1776``unordered``
1777 The set of values that can be read is governed by the happens-before
1778 partial order. A value cannot be read unless some operation wrote
1779 it. This is intended to provide a guarantee strong enough to model
1780 Java's non-volatile shared variables. This ordering cannot be
1781 specified for read-modify-write operations; it is not strong enough
1782 to make them atomic in any interesting way.
1783``monotonic``
1784 In addition to the guarantees of ``unordered``, there is a single
1785 total order for modifications by ``monotonic`` operations on each
1786 address. All modification orders must be compatible with the
1787 happens-before order. There is no guarantee that the modification
1788 orders can be combined to a global total order for the whole program
1789 (and this often will not be possible). The read in an atomic
1790 read-modify-write operation (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>` and
1791 :ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`) reads the value in the modification
1792 order immediately before the value it writes. If one atomic read
1793 happens before another atomic read of the same address, the later
1794 read must see the same value or a later value in the address's
1795 modification order. This disallows reordering of ``monotonic`` (or
1796 stronger) operations on the same address. If an address is written
1797 ``monotonic``-ally by one thread, and other threads ``monotonic``-ally
1798 read that address repeatedly, the other threads must eventually see
1799 the write. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
1800 ``memory_order_relaxed``.
1801``acquire``
1802 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, a
1803 *synchronizes-with* edge may be formed with a ``release`` operation.
1804 This is intended to model C++'s ``memory_order_acquire``.
1805``release``
1806 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, if this operation
1807 writes a value which is subsequently read by an ``acquire``
1808 operation, it *synchronizes-with* that operation. (This isn't a
1809 complete description; see the C++0x definition of a release
1810 sequence.) This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
1811 ``memory_order_release``.
1812``acq_rel`` (acquire+release)
1813 Acts as both an ``acquire`` and ``release`` operation on its
1814 address. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x ``memory_order_acq_rel``.
1815``seq_cst`` (sequentially consistent)
1816 In addition to the guarantees of ``acq_rel`` (``acquire`` for an
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00001817 operation that only reads, ``release`` for an operation that only
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001818 writes), there is a global total order on all
1819 sequentially-consistent operations on all addresses, which is
1820 consistent with the *happens-before* partial order and with the
1821 modification orders of all the affected addresses. Each
1822 sequentially-consistent read sees the last preceding write to the
1823 same address in this global order. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
1824 ``memory_order_seq_cst`` and Java volatile.
1825
1826.. _singlethread:
1827
1828If an atomic operation is marked ``singlethread``, it only *synchronizes
1829with* or participates in modification and seq\_cst total orderings with
1830other operations running in the same thread (for example, in signal
1831handlers).
1832
1833.. _fastmath:
1834
1835Fast-Math Flags
1836---------------
1837
1838LLVM IR floating-point binary ops (:ref:`fadd <i_fadd>`,
1839:ref:`fsub <i_fsub>`, :ref:`fmul <i_fmul>`, :ref:`fdiv <i_fdiv>`,
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +00001840:ref:`frem <i_frem>`) have the following flags that can be set to enable
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001841otherwise unsafe floating point operations
1842
1843``nnan``
1844 No NaNs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
1845 NaN. Such optimizations are required to retain defined behavior over
1846 NaNs, but the value of the result is undefined.
1847
1848``ninf``
1849 No Infs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
1850 +/-Inf. Such optimizations are required to retain defined behavior over
1851 +/-Inf, but the value of the result is undefined.
1852
1853``nsz``
1854 No Signed Zeros - Allow optimizations to treat the sign of a zero
1855 argument or result as insignificant.
1856
1857``arcp``
1858 Allow Reciprocal - Allow optimizations to use the reciprocal of an
1859 argument rather than perform division.
1860
1861``fast``
1862 Fast - Allow algebraically equivalent transformations that may
1863 dramatically change results in floating point (e.g. reassociate). This
1864 flag implies all the others.
1865
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith0a448fb2014-08-19 21:30:15 +00001866.. _uselistorder:
1867
1868Use-list Order Directives
1869-------------------------
1870
1871Use-list directives encode the in-memory order of each use-list, allowing the
1872order to be recreated. ``<order-indexes>`` is a comma-separated list of
1873indexes that are assigned to the referenced value's uses. The referenced
1874value's use-list is immediately sorted by these indexes.
1875
1876Use-list directives may appear at function scope or global scope. They are not
1877instructions, and have no effect on the semantics of the IR. When they're at
1878function scope, they must appear after the terminator of the final basic block.
1879
1880If basic blocks have their address taken via ``blockaddress()`` expressions,
1881``uselistorder_bb`` can be used to reorder their use-lists from outside their
1882function's scope.
1883
1884:Syntax:
1885
1886::
1887
1888 uselistorder <ty> <value>, { <order-indexes> }
1889 uselistorder_bb @function, %block { <order-indexes> }
1890
1891:Examples:
1892
1893::
1894
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith23046652014-08-19 21:48:04 +00001895 define void @foo(i32 %arg1, i32 %arg2) {
1896 entry:
1897 ; ... instructions ...
1898 bb:
1899 ; ... instructions ...
1900
1901 ; At function scope.
1902 uselistorder i32 %arg1, { 1, 0, 2 }
1903 uselistorder label %bb, { 1, 0 }
1904 }
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith0a448fb2014-08-19 21:30:15 +00001905
1906 ; At global scope.
1907 uselistorder i32* @global, { 1, 2, 0 }
1908 uselistorder i32 7, { 1, 0 }
1909 uselistorder i32 (i32) @bar, { 1, 0 }
1910 uselistorder_bb @foo, %bb, { 5, 1, 3, 2, 0, 4 }
1911
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001912.. _typesystem:
1913
1914Type System
1915===========
1916
1917The LLVM type system is one of the most important features of the
1918intermediate representation. Being typed enables a number of
1919optimizations to be performed on the intermediate representation
1920directly, without having to do extra analyses on the side before the
1921transformation. A strong type system makes it easier to read the
1922generated code and enables novel analyses and transformations that are
1923not feasible to perform on normal three address code representations.
1924
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00001925.. _t_void:
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00001926
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00001927Void Type
1928---------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001929
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00001930:Overview:
1931
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00001932
1933The void type does not represent any value and has no size.
1934
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00001935:Syntax:
1936
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00001937
1938::
1939
1940 void
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001941
1942
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00001943.. _t_function:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001944
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00001945Function Type
1946-------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001947
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00001948:Overview:
1949
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001950
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00001951The function type can be thought of as a function signature. It consists of a
1952return type and a list of formal parameter types. The return type of a function
1953type is a void type or first class type --- except for :ref:`label <t_label>`
1954and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>` types.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001955
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00001956:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001957
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00001958::
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001959
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00001960 <returntype> (<parameter list>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001961
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00001962...where '``<parameter list>``' is a comma-separated list of type
1963specifiers. Optionally, the parameter list may include a type ``...``, which
1964indicates that the function takes a variable number of arguments. Variable
1965argument functions can access their arguments with the :ref:`variable argument
1966handling intrinsic <int_varargs>` functions. '``<returntype>``' is any type
1967except :ref:`label <t_label>` and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001968
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00001969:Examples:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001970
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00001971+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
1972| ``i32 (i32)`` | function taking an ``i32``, returning an ``i32`` |
1973+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
1974| ``float (i16, i32 *) *`` | :ref:`Pointer <t_pointer>` to a function that takes an ``i16`` and a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i32``, returning ``float``. |
1975+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
1976| ``i32 (i8*, ...)`` | A vararg function that takes at least one :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i8`` (char in C), which returns an integer. This is the signature for ``printf`` in LLVM. |
1977+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
1978| ``{i32, i32} (i32)`` | A function taking an ``i32``, returning a :ref:`structure <t_struct>` containing two ``i32`` values |
1979+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
1980
1981.. _t_firstclass:
1982
1983First Class Types
1984-----------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001985
1986The :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` types are perhaps the most important.
1987Values of these types are the only ones which can be produced by
1988instructions.
1989
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00001990.. _t_single_value:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001991
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00001992Single Value Types
1993^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001994
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00001995These are the types that are valid in registers from CodeGen's perspective.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001996
1997.. _t_integer:
1998
1999Integer Type
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002000""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002001
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002002:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002003
2004The integer type is a very simple type that simply specifies an
2005arbitrary bit width for the integer type desired. Any bit width from 1
2006bit to 2\ :sup:`23`\ -1 (about 8 million) can be specified.
2007
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002008:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002009
2010::
2011
2012 iN
2013
2014The number of bits the integer will occupy is specified by the ``N``
2015value.
2016
2017Examples:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002018*********
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002019
2020+----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2021| ``i1`` | a single-bit integer. |
2022+----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2023| ``i32`` | a 32-bit integer. |
2024+----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2025| ``i1942652`` | a really big integer of over 1 million bits. |
2026+----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2027
2028.. _t_floating:
2029
2030Floating Point Types
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002031""""""""""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002032
2033.. list-table::
2034 :header-rows: 1
2035
2036 * - Type
2037 - Description
2038
2039 * - ``half``
2040 - 16-bit floating point value
2041
2042 * - ``float``
2043 - 32-bit floating point value
2044
2045 * - ``double``
2046 - 64-bit floating point value
2047
2048 * - ``fp128``
2049 - 128-bit floating point value (112-bit mantissa)
2050
2051 * - ``x86_fp80``
2052 - 80-bit floating point value (X87)
2053
2054 * - ``ppc_fp128``
2055 - 128-bit floating point value (two 64-bits)
2056
Reid Kleckner9a16d082014-03-05 02:41:37 +00002057X86_mmx Type
2058""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002059
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002060:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002061
Reid Kleckner9a16d082014-03-05 02:41:37 +00002062The x86_mmx type represents a value held in an MMX register on an x86
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002063machine. The operations allowed on it are quite limited: parameters and
2064return values, load and store, and bitcast. User-specified MMX
2065instructions are represented as intrinsic or asm calls with arguments
2066and/or results of this type. There are no arrays, vectors or constants
2067of this type.
2068
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002069:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002070
2071::
2072
Reid Kleckner9a16d082014-03-05 02:41:37 +00002073 x86_mmx
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002074
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002075
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002076.. _t_pointer:
2077
2078Pointer Type
2079""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002080
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002081:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002082
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002083The pointer type is used to specify memory locations. Pointers are
2084commonly used to reference objects in memory.
2085
2086Pointer types may have an optional address space attribute defining the
2087numbered address space where the pointed-to object resides. The default
2088address space is number zero. The semantics of non-zero address spaces
2089are target-specific.
2090
2091Note that LLVM does not permit pointers to void (``void*``) nor does it
2092permit pointers to labels (``label*``). Use ``i8*`` instead.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002093
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002094:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002095
2096::
2097
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002098 <type> *
2099
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002100:Examples:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002101
2102+-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2103| ``[4 x i32]*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to :ref:`array <t_array>` of four ``i32`` values. |
2104+-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2105| ``i32 (i32*) *`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32*``, returning an ``i32``. |
2106+-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2107| ``i32 addrspace(5)*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to an ``i32`` value that resides in address space #5. |
2108+-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2109
2110.. _t_vector:
2111
2112Vector Type
2113"""""""""""
2114
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002115:Overview:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002116
2117A vector type is a simple derived type that represents a vector of
2118elements. Vector types are used when multiple primitive data are
2119operated in parallel using a single instruction (SIMD). A vector type
2120requires a size (number of elements) and an underlying primitive data
2121type. Vector types are considered :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>`.
2122
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002123:Syntax:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002124
2125::
2126
2127 < <# elements> x <elementtype> >
2128
2129The number of elements is a constant integer value larger than 0;
Manuel Jacob961f7872014-07-30 12:30:06 +00002130elementtype may be any integer, floating point or pointer type. Vectors
2131of size zero are not allowed.
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002132
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002133:Examples:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002134
2135+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2136| ``<4 x i32>`` | Vector of 4 32-bit integer values. |
2137+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2138| ``<8 x float>`` | Vector of 8 32-bit floating-point values. |
2139+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2140| ``<2 x i64>`` | Vector of 2 64-bit integer values. |
2141+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2142| ``<4 x i64*>`` | Vector of 4 pointers to 64-bit integer values. |
2143+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002144
2145.. _t_label:
2146
2147Label Type
2148^^^^^^^^^^
2149
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002150:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002151
2152The label type represents code labels.
2153
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002154:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002155
2156::
2157
2158 label
2159
2160.. _t_metadata:
2161
2162Metadata Type
2163^^^^^^^^^^^^^
2164
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002165:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002166
2167The metadata type represents embedded metadata. No derived types may be
2168created from metadata except for :ref:`function <t_function>` arguments.
2169
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002170:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002171
2172::
2173
2174 metadata
2175
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002176.. _t_aggregate:
2177
2178Aggregate Types
2179^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
2180
2181Aggregate Types are a subset of derived types that can contain multiple
2182member types. :ref:`Arrays <t_array>` and :ref:`structs <t_struct>` are
2183aggregate types. :ref:`Vectors <t_vector>` are not considered to be
2184aggregate types.
2185
2186.. _t_array:
2187
2188Array Type
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002189""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002190
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002191:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002192
2193The array type is a very simple derived type that arranges elements
2194sequentially in memory. The array type requires a size (number of
2195elements) and an underlying data type.
2196
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002197:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002198
2199::
2200
2201 [<# elements> x <elementtype>]
2202
2203The number of elements is a constant integer value; ``elementtype`` may
2204be any type with a size.
2205
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002206:Examples:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002207
2208+------------------+--------------------------------------+
2209| ``[40 x i32]`` | Array of 40 32-bit integer values. |
2210+------------------+--------------------------------------+
2211| ``[41 x i32]`` | Array of 41 32-bit integer values. |
2212+------------------+--------------------------------------+
2213| ``[4 x i8]`` | Array of 4 8-bit integer values. |
2214+------------------+--------------------------------------+
2215
2216Here are some examples of multidimensional arrays:
2217
2218+-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2219| ``[3 x [4 x i32]]`` | 3x4 array of 32-bit integer values. |
2220+-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2221| ``[12 x [10 x float]]`` | 12x10 array of single precision floating point values. |
2222+-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2223| ``[2 x [3 x [4 x i16]]]`` | 2x3x4 array of 16-bit integer values. |
2224+-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2225
2226There is no restriction on indexing beyond the end of the array implied
2227by a static type (though there are restrictions on indexing beyond the
2228bounds of an allocated object in some cases). This means that
2229single-dimension 'variable sized array' addressing can be implemented in
2230LLVM with a zero length array type. An implementation of 'pascal style
2231arrays' in LLVM could use the type "``{ i32, [0 x float]}``", for
2232example.
2233
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002234.. _t_struct:
2235
2236Structure Type
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002237""""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002238
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002239:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002240
2241The structure type is used to represent a collection of data members
2242together in memory. The elements of a structure may be any type that has
2243a size.
2244
2245Structures in memory are accessed using '``load``' and '``store``' by
2246getting a pointer to a field with the '``getelementptr``' instruction.
2247Structures in registers are accessed using the '``extractvalue``' and
2248'``insertvalue``' instructions.
2249
2250Structures may optionally be "packed" structures, which indicate that
2251the alignment of the struct is one byte, and that there is no padding
2252between the elements. In non-packed structs, padding between field types
2253is inserted as defined by the DataLayout string in the module, which is
2254required to match what the underlying code generator expects.
2255
2256Structures can either be "literal" or "identified". A literal structure
2257is defined inline with other types (e.g. ``{i32, i32}*``) whereas
2258identified types are always defined at the top level with a name.
2259Literal types are uniqued by their contents and can never be recursive
2260or opaque since there is no way to write one. Identified types can be
2261recursive, can be opaqued, and are never uniqued.
2262
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002263:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002264
2265::
2266
2267 %T1 = type { <type list> } ; Identified normal struct type
2268 %T2 = type <{ <type list> }> ; Identified packed struct type
2269
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002270:Examples:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002271
2272+------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2273| ``{ i32, i32, i32 }`` | A triple of three ``i32`` values |
2274+------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00002275| ``{ float, i32 (i32) * }`` | A pair, where the first element is a ``float`` and the second element is a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32``, returning an ``i32``. |
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002276+------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2277| ``<{ i8, i32 }>`` | A packed struct known to be 5 bytes in size. |
2278+------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2279
2280.. _t_opaque:
2281
2282Opaque Structure Types
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002283""""""""""""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002284
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002285:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002286
2287Opaque structure types are used to represent named structure types that
2288do not have a body specified. This corresponds (for example) to the C
2289notion of a forward declared structure.
2290
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002291:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002292
2293::
2294
2295 %X = type opaque
2296 %52 = type opaque
2297
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002298:Examples:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002299
2300+--------------+-------------------+
2301| ``opaque`` | An opaque type. |
2302+--------------+-------------------+
2303
Sean Silva1703e702014-04-08 21:06:22 +00002304.. _constants:
2305
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002306Constants
2307=========
2308
2309LLVM has several different basic types of constants. This section
2310describes them all and their syntax.
2311
2312Simple Constants
2313----------------
2314
2315**Boolean constants**
2316 The two strings '``true``' and '``false``' are both valid constants
2317 of the ``i1`` type.
2318**Integer constants**
2319 Standard integers (such as '4') are constants of the
2320 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. Negative numbers may be used with
2321 integer types.
2322**Floating point constants**
2323 Floating point constants use standard decimal notation (e.g.
2324 123.421), exponential notation (e.g. 1.23421e+2), or a more precise
2325 hexadecimal notation (see below). The assembler requires the exact
2326 decimal value of a floating-point constant. For example, the
2327 assembler accepts 1.25 but rejects 1.3 because 1.3 is a repeating
2328 decimal in binary. Floating point constants must have a :ref:`floating
2329 point <t_floating>` type.
2330**Null pointer constants**
2331 The identifier '``null``' is recognized as a null pointer constant
2332 and must be of :ref:`pointer type <t_pointer>`.
2333
2334The one non-intuitive notation for constants is the hexadecimal form of
2335floating point constants. For example, the form
2336'``double 0x432ff973cafa8000``' is equivalent to (but harder to read
2337than) '``double 4.5e+15``'. The only time hexadecimal floating point
2338constants are required (and the only time that they are generated by the
2339disassembler) is when a floating point constant must be emitted but it
2340cannot be represented as a decimal floating point number in a reasonable
2341number of digits. For example, NaN's, infinities, and other special
2342values are represented in their IEEE hexadecimal format so that assembly
2343and disassembly do not cause any bits to change in the constants.
2344
2345When using the hexadecimal form, constants of types half, float, and
2346double are represented using the 16-digit form shown above (which
2347matches the IEEE754 representation for double); half and float values
Dmitri Gribenko4dc2ba12013-01-16 23:40:37 +00002348must, however, be exactly representable as IEEE 754 half and single
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002349precision, respectively. Hexadecimal format is always used for long
2350double, and there are three forms of long double. The 80-bit format used
2351by x86 is represented as ``0xK`` followed by 20 hexadecimal digits. The
2352128-bit format used by PowerPC (two adjacent doubles) is represented by
2353``0xM`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. The IEEE 128-bit format is
Richard Sandifordae426b42013-05-03 14:32:27 +00002354represented by ``0xL`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. Long doubles
2355will only work if they match the long double format on your target.
2356The IEEE 16-bit format (half precision) is represented by ``0xH``
2357followed by 4 hexadecimal digits. All hexadecimal formats are big-endian
2358(sign bit at the left).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002359
Reid Kleckner9a16d082014-03-05 02:41:37 +00002360There are no constants of type x86_mmx.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002361
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00002362.. _complexconstants:
2363
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002364Complex Constants
2365-----------------
2366
2367Complex constants are a (potentially recursive) combination of simple
2368constants and smaller complex constants.
2369
2370**Structure constants**
2371 Structure constants are represented with notation similar to
2372 structure type definitions (a comma separated list of elements,
2373 surrounded by braces (``{}``)). For example:
2374 "``{ i32 4, float 17.0, i32* @G }``", where "``@G``" is declared as
2375 "``@G = external global i32``". Structure constants must have
2376 :ref:`structure type <t_struct>`, and the number and types of elements
2377 must match those specified by the type.
2378**Array constants**
2379 Array constants are represented with notation similar to array type
2380 definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
2381 square brackets (``[]``)). For example:
2382 "``[ i32 42, i32 11, i32 74 ]``". Array constants must have
2383 :ref:`array type <t_array>`, and the number and types of elements must
Daniel Sandersf6051842014-09-11 12:02:59 +00002384 match those specified by the type. As a special case, character array
2385 constants may also be represented as a double-quoted string using the ``c``
2386 prefix. For example: "``c"Hello World\0A\00"``".
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002387**Vector constants**
2388 Vector constants are represented with notation similar to vector
2389 type definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
2390 less-than/greater-than's (``<>``)). For example:
2391 "``< i32 42, i32 11, i32 74, i32 100 >``". Vector constants
2392 must have :ref:`vector type <t_vector>`, and the number and types of
2393 elements must match those specified by the type.
2394**Zero initialization**
2395 The string '``zeroinitializer``' can be used to zero initialize a
2396 value to zero of *any* type, including scalar and
2397 :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` types. This is often used to avoid
2398 having to print large zero initializers (e.g. for large arrays) and
2399 is always exactly equivalent to using explicit zero initializers.
2400**Metadata node**
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00002401 A metadata node is a constant tuple without types. For example:
2402 "``!{!0, !{!2, !0}, !"test"}``". Metadata can reference constant values,
2403 for example: "``!{!0, i32 0, i8* @global, i64 (i64)* @function, !"str"}``".
2404 Unlike other typed constants that are meant to be interpreted as part of
2405 the instruction stream, metadata is a place to attach additional
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002406 information such as debug info.
2407
2408Global Variable and Function Addresses
2409--------------------------------------
2410
2411The addresses of :ref:`global variables <globalvars>` and
2412:ref:`functions <functionstructure>` are always implicitly valid
2413(link-time) constants. These constants are explicitly referenced when
2414the :ref:`identifier for the global <identifiers>` is used and always have
2415:ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` type. For example, the following is a legal LLVM
2416file:
2417
2418.. code-block:: llvm
2419
2420 @X = global i32 17
2421 @Y = global i32 42
2422 @Z = global [2 x i32*] [ i32* @X, i32* @Y ]
2423
2424.. _undefvalues:
2425
2426Undefined Values
2427----------------
2428
2429The string '``undef``' can be used anywhere a constant is expected, and
2430indicates that the user of the value may receive an unspecified
2431bit-pattern. Undefined values may be of any type (other than '``label``'
2432or '``void``') and be used anywhere a constant is permitted.
2433
2434Undefined values are useful because they indicate to the compiler that
2435the program is well defined no matter what value is used. This gives the
2436compiler more freedom to optimize. Here are some examples of
2437(potentially surprising) transformations that are valid (in pseudo IR):
2438
2439.. code-block:: llvm
2440
2441 %A = add %X, undef
2442 %B = sub %X, undef
2443 %C = xor %X, undef
2444 Safe:
2445 %A = undef
2446 %B = undef
2447 %C = undef
2448
2449This is safe because all of the output bits are affected by the undef
2450bits. Any output bit can have a zero or one depending on the input bits.
2451
2452.. code-block:: llvm
2453
2454 %A = or %X, undef
2455 %B = and %X, undef
2456 Safe:
2457 %A = -1
2458 %B = 0
2459 Unsafe:
2460 %A = undef
2461 %B = undef
2462
2463These logical operations have bits that are not always affected by the
2464input. For example, if ``%X`` has a zero bit, then the output of the
2465'``and``' operation will always be a zero for that bit, no matter what
2466the corresponding bit from the '``undef``' is. As such, it is unsafe to
2467optimize or assume that the result of the '``and``' is '``undef``'.
2468However, it is safe to assume that all bits of the '``undef``' could be
24690, and optimize the '``and``' to 0. Likewise, it is safe to assume that
2470all the bits of the '``undef``' operand to the '``or``' could be set,
2471allowing the '``or``' to be folded to -1.
2472
2473.. code-block:: llvm
2474
2475 %A = select undef, %X, %Y
2476 %B = select undef, 42, %Y
2477 %C = select %X, %Y, undef
2478 Safe:
2479 %A = %X (or %Y)
2480 %B = 42 (or %Y)
2481 %C = %Y
2482 Unsafe:
2483 %A = undef
2484 %B = undef
2485 %C = undef
2486
2487This set of examples shows that undefined '``select``' (and conditional
2488branch) conditions can go *either way*, but they have to come from one
2489of the two operands. In the ``%A`` example, if ``%X`` and ``%Y`` were
2490both known to have a clear low bit, then ``%A`` would have to have a
2491cleared low bit. However, in the ``%C`` example, the optimizer is
2492allowed to assume that the '``undef``' operand could be the same as
2493``%Y``, allowing the whole '``select``' to be eliminated.
2494
2495.. code-block:: llvm
2496
2497 %A = xor undef, undef
2498
2499 %B = undef
2500 %C = xor %B, %B
2501
2502 %D = undef
Jonathan Roelofsec81c0b2014-10-16 19:28:10 +00002503 %E = icmp slt %D, 4
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002504 %F = icmp gte %D, 4
2505
2506 Safe:
2507 %A = undef
2508 %B = undef
2509 %C = undef
2510 %D = undef
2511 %E = undef
2512 %F = undef
2513
2514This example points out that two '``undef``' operands are not
2515necessarily the same. This can be surprising to people (and also matches
2516C semantics) where they assume that "``X^X``" is always zero, even if
2517``X`` is undefined. This isn't true for a number of reasons, but the
2518short answer is that an '``undef``' "variable" can arbitrarily change
2519its value over its "live range". This is true because the variable
2520doesn't actually *have a live range*. Instead, the value is logically
2521read from arbitrary registers that happen to be around when needed, so
2522the value is not necessarily consistent over time. In fact, ``%A`` and
2523``%C`` need to have the same semantics or the core LLVM "replace all
2524uses with" concept would not hold.
2525
2526.. code-block:: llvm
2527
2528 %A = fdiv undef, %X
2529 %B = fdiv %X, undef
2530 Safe:
2531 %A = undef
2532 b: unreachable
2533
2534These examples show the crucial difference between an *undefined value*
2535and *undefined behavior*. An undefined value (like '``undef``') is
2536allowed to have an arbitrary bit-pattern. This means that the ``%A``
2537operation can be constant folded to '``undef``', because the '``undef``'
2538could be an SNaN, and ``fdiv`` is not (currently) defined on SNaN's.
2539However, in the second example, we can make a more aggressive
2540assumption: because the ``undef`` is allowed to be an arbitrary value,
2541we are allowed to assume that it could be zero. Since a divide by zero
2542has *undefined behavior*, we are allowed to assume that the operation
2543does not execute at all. This allows us to delete the divide and all
2544code after it. Because the undefined operation "can't happen", the
2545optimizer can assume that it occurs in dead code.
2546
2547.. code-block:: llvm
2548
2549 a: store undef -> %X
2550 b: store %X -> undef
2551 Safe:
2552 a: <deleted>
2553 b: unreachable
2554
2555These examples reiterate the ``fdiv`` example: a store *of* an undefined
2556value can be assumed to not have any effect; we can assume that the
2557value is overwritten with bits that happen to match what was already
2558there. However, a store *to* an undefined location could clobber
2559arbitrary memory, therefore, it has undefined behavior.
2560
2561.. _poisonvalues:
2562
2563Poison Values
2564-------------
2565
2566Poison values are similar to :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`, however
2567they also represent the fact that an instruction or constant expression
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00002568that cannot evoke side effects has nevertheless detected a condition
2569that results in undefined behavior.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002570
2571There is currently no way of representing a poison value in the IR; they
2572only exist when produced by operations such as :ref:`add <i_add>` with
2573the ``nsw`` flag.
2574
2575Poison value behavior is defined in terms of value *dependence*:
2576
2577- Values other than :ref:`phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on their operands.
2578- :ref:`Phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on the operand corresponding to
2579 their dynamic predecessor basic block.
2580- Function arguments depend on the corresponding actual argument values
2581 in the dynamic callers of their functions.
2582- :ref:`Call <i_call>` instructions depend on the :ref:`ret <i_ret>`
2583 instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
2584- :ref:`Invoke <i_invoke>` instructions depend on the
2585 :ref:`ret <i_ret>`, :ref:`resume <i_resume>`, or exception-throwing
2586 call instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
2587- Non-volatile loads and stores depend on the most recent stores to all
2588 of the referenced memory addresses, following the order in the IR
2589 (including loads and stores implied by intrinsics such as
2590 :ref:`@llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`.)
2591- An instruction with externally visible side effects depends on the
2592 most recent preceding instruction with externally visible side
2593 effects, following the order in the IR. (This includes :ref:`volatile
2594 operations <volatile>`.)
2595- An instruction *control-depends* on a :ref:`terminator
2596 instruction <terminators>` if the terminator instruction has
2597 multiple successors and the instruction is always executed when
2598 control transfers to one of the successors, and may not be executed
2599 when control is transferred to another.
2600- Additionally, an instruction also *control-depends* on a terminator
2601 instruction if the set of instructions it otherwise depends on would
2602 be different if the terminator had transferred control to a different
2603 successor.
2604- Dependence is transitive.
2605
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00002606Poison values have the same behavior as :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`,
2607with the additional effect that any instruction that has a *dependence*
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002608on a poison value has undefined behavior.
2609
2610Here are some examples:
2611
2612.. code-block:: llvm
2613
2614 entry:
2615 %poison = sub nuw i32 0, 1 ; Results in a poison value.
2616 %still_poison = and i32 %poison, 0 ; 0, but also poison.
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00002617 %poison_yet_again = getelementptr i32, i32* @h, i32 %still_poison
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002618 store i32 0, i32* %poison_yet_again ; memory at @h[0] is poisoned
2619
2620 store i32 %poison, i32* @g ; Poison value stored to memory.
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00002621 %poison2 = load i32, i32* @g ; Poison value loaded back from memory.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002622
2623 store volatile i32 %poison, i32* @g ; External observation; undefined behavior.
2624
2625 %narrowaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i16*
2626 %wideaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i64*
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00002627 %poison3 = load i16, i16* %narrowaddr ; Returns a poison value.
2628 %poison4 = load i64, i64* %wideaddr ; Returns a poison value.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002629
2630 %cmp = icmp slt i32 %poison, 0 ; Returns a poison value.
2631 br i1 %cmp, label %true, label %end ; Branch to either destination.
2632
2633 true:
2634 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This is control-dependent on %cmp, so
2635 ; it has undefined behavior.
2636 br label %end
2637
2638 end:
2639 %p = phi i32 [ 0, %entry ], [ 1, %true ]
2640 ; Both edges into this PHI are
2641 ; control-dependent on %cmp, so this
2642 ; always results in a poison value.
2643
2644 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This would depend on the store in %true
2645 ; if %cmp is true, or the store in %entry
2646 ; otherwise, so this is undefined behavior.
2647
2648 br i1 %cmp, label %second_true, label %second_end
2649 ; The same branch again, but this time the
2650 ; true block doesn't have side effects.
2651
2652 second_true:
2653 ; No side effects!
2654 ret void
2655
2656 second_end:
2657 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This time, the instruction always depends
2658 ; on the store in %end. Also, it is
2659 ; control-equivalent to %end, so this is
2660 ; well-defined (ignoring earlier undefined
2661 ; behavior in this example).
2662
2663.. _blockaddress:
2664
2665Addresses of Basic Blocks
2666-------------------------
2667
2668``blockaddress(@function, %block)``
2669
2670The '``blockaddress``' constant computes the address of the specified
2671basic block in the specified function, and always has an ``i8*`` type.
2672Taking the address of the entry block is illegal.
2673
2674This value only has defined behavior when used as an operand to the
2675':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`' instruction, or for comparisons
2676against null. Pointer equality tests between labels addresses results in
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00002677undefined behavior --- though, again, comparison against null is ok, and
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002678no label is equal to the null pointer. This may be passed around as an
2679opaque pointer sized value as long as the bits are not inspected. This
2680allows ``ptrtoint`` and arithmetic to be performed on these values so
2681long as the original value is reconstituted before the ``indirectbr``
2682instruction.
2683
2684Finally, some targets may provide defined semantics when using the value
2685as the operand to an inline assembly, but that is target specific.
2686
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00002687.. _constantexprs:
2688
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002689Constant Expressions
2690--------------------
2691
2692Constant expressions are used to allow expressions involving other
2693constants to be used as constants. Constant expressions may be of any
2694:ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type and may involve any LLVM operation
2695that does not have side effects (e.g. load and call are not supported).
2696The following is the syntax for constant expressions:
2697
2698``trunc (CST to TYPE)``
2699 Truncate a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be
2700 larger than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers.
2701``zext (CST to TYPE)``
2702 Zero extend a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be
2703 smaller than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers.
2704``sext (CST to TYPE)``
2705 Sign extend a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be
2706 smaller than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers.
2707``fptrunc (CST to TYPE)``
2708 Truncate a floating point constant to another floating point type.
2709 The size of CST must be larger than the size of TYPE. Both types
2710 must be floating point.
2711``fpext (CST to TYPE)``
2712 Floating point extend a constant to another type. The size of CST
2713 must be smaller or equal to the size of TYPE. Both types must be
2714 floating point.
2715``fptoui (CST to TYPE)``
2716 Convert a floating point constant to the corresponding unsigned
2717 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
2718 must be of scalar or vector floating point type. Both CST and TYPE
2719 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
2720 value won't fit in the integer type, the results are undefined.
2721``fptosi (CST to TYPE)``
2722 Convert a floating point constant to the corresponding signed
2723 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
2724 must be of scalar or vector floating point type. Both CST and TYPE
2725 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
2726 value won't fit in the integer type, the results are undefined.
2727``uitofp (CST to TYPE)``
2728 Convert an unsigned integer constant to the corresponding floating
2729 point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating point type.
2730 CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
2731 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value
2732 won't fit in the floating point type, the results are undefined.
2733``sitofp (CST to TYPE)``
2734 Convert a signed integer constant to the corresponding floating
2735 point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating point type.
2736 CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
2737 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value
2738 won't fit in the floating point type, the results are undefined.
2739``ptrtoint (CST to TYPE)``
2740 Convert a pointer typed constant to the corresponding integer
Eli Bendersky9c0d4932013-03-11 16:51:15 +00002741 constant. ``TYPE`` must be an integer type. ``CST`` must be of
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002742 pointer type. The ``CST`` value is zero extended, truncated, or
2743 unchanged to make it fit in ``TYPE``.
2744``inttoptr (CST to TYPE)``
2745 Convert an integer constant to a pointer constant. TYPE must be a
2746 pointer type. CST must be of integer type. The CST value is zero
2747 extended, truncated, or unchanged to make it fit in a pointer size.
2748 This one is *really* dangerous!
2749``bitcast (CST to TYPE)``
2750 Convert a constant, CST, to another TYPE. The constraints of the
2751 operands are the same as those for the :ref:`bitcast
2752 instruction <i_bitcast>`.
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00002753``addrspacecast (CST to TYPE)``
2754 Convert a constant pointer or constant vector of pointer, CST, to another
2755 TYPE in a different address space. The constraints of the operands are the
2756 same as those for the :ref:`addrspacecast instruction <i_addrspacecast>`.
David Blaikief72d05b2015-03-13 18:20:45 +00002757``getelementptr (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``, ``getelementptr inbounds (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002758 Perform the :ref:`getelementptr operation <i_getelementptr>` on
2759 constants. As with the :ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`
2760 instruction, the index list may have zero or more indexes, which are
David Blaikief72d05b2015-03-13 18:20:45 +00002761 required to make sense for the type of "pointer to TY".
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002762``select (COND, VAL1, VAL2)``
2763 Perform the :ref:`select operation <i_select>` on constants.
2764``icmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
2765 Performs the :ref:`icmp operation <i_icmp>` on constants.
2766``fcmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
2767 Performs the :ref:`fcmp operation <i_fcmp>` on constants.
2768``extractelement (VAL, IDX)``
2769 Perform the :ref:`extractelement operation <i_extractelement>` on
2770 constants.
2771``insertelement (VAL, ELT, IDX)``
2772 Perform the :ref:`insertelement operation <i_insertelement>` on
2773 constants.
2774``shufflevector (VEC1, VEC2, IDXMASK)``
2775 Perform the :ref:`shufflevector operation <i_shufflevector>` on
2776 constants.
2777``extractvalue (VAL, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
2778 Perform the :ref:`extractvalue operation <i_extractvalue>` on
2779 constants. The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as
2780 indices in a ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At
2781 least one index value must be specified.
2782``insertvalue (VAL, ELT, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
2783 Perform the :ref:`insertvalue operation <i_insertvalue>` on constants.
2784 The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as indices in a
2785 ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At least one index
2786 value must be specified.
2787``OPCODE (LHS, RHS)``
2788 Perform the specified operation of the LHS and RHS constants. OPCODE
2789 may be any of the :ref:`binary <binaryops>` or :ref:`bitwise
2790 binary <bitwiseops>` operations. The constraints on operands are
2791 the same as those for the corresponding instruction (e.g. no bitwise
2792 operations on floating point values are allowed).
2793
2794Other Values
2795============
2796
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00002797.. _inlineasmexprs:
2798
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002799Inline Assembler Expressions
2800----------------------------
2801
2802LLVM supports inline assembler expressions (as opposed to :ref:`Module-Level
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00002803Inline Assembly <moduleasm>`) through the use of a special value. This value
2804represents the inline assembler as a template string (containing the
2805instructions to emit), a list of operand constraints (stored as a string), a
2806flag that indicates whether or not the inline asm expression has side effects,
2807and a flag indicating whether the function containing the asm needs to align its
2808stack conservatively.
2809
2810The template string supports argument substitution of the operands using "``$``"
2811followed by a number, to indicate substitution of the given register/memory
2812location, as specified by the constraint string. "``${NUM:MODIFIER}``" may also
2813be used, where ``MODIFIER`` is a target-specific annotation for how to print the
2814operand (See :ref:`inline-asm-modifiers`).
2815
2816A literal "``$``" may be included by using "``$$``" in the template. To include
2817other special characters into the output, the usual "``\XX``" escapes may be
2818used, just as in other strings. Note that after template substitution, the
2819resulting assembly string is parsed by LLVM's integrated assembler unless it is
2820disabled -- even when emitting a ``.s`` file -- and thus must contain assembly
2821syntax known to LLVM.
2822
2823LLVM's support for inline asm is modeled closely on the requirements of Clang's
2824GCC-compatible inline-asm support. Thus, the feature-set and the constraint and
2825modifier codes listed here are similar or identical to those in GCC's inline asm
2826support. However, to be clear, the syntax of the template and constraint strings
2827described here is *not* the same as the syntax accepted by GCC and Clang, and,
2828while most constraint letters are passed through as-is by Clang, some get
2829translated to other codes when converting from the C source to the LLVM
2830assembly.
2831
2832An example inline assembler expression is:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002833
2834.. code-block:: llvm
2835
2836 i32 (i32) asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"
2837
2838Inline assembler expressions may **only** be used as the callee operand
2839of a :ref:`call <i_call>` or an :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>` instruction.
2840Thus, typically we have:
2841
2842.. code-block:: llvm
2843
2844 %X = call i32 asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"(i32 %Y)
2845
2846Inline asms with side effects not visible in the constraint list must be
2847marked as having side effects. This is done through the use of the
2848'``sideeffect``' keyword, like so:
2849
2850.. code-block:: llvm
2851
2852 call void asm sideeffect "eieio", ""()
2853
2854In some cases inline asms will contain code that will not work unless
2855the stack is aligned in some way, such as calls or SSE instructions on
2856x86, yet will not contain code that does that alignment within the asm.
2857The compiler should make conservative assumptions about what the asm
2858might contain and should generate its usual stack alignment code in the
2859prologue if the '``alignstack``' keyword is present:
2860
2861.. code-block:: llvm
2862
2863 call void asm alignstack "eieio", ""()
2864
2865Inline asms also support using non-standard assembly dialects. The
2866assumed dialect is ATT. When the '``inteldialect``' keyword is present,
2867the inline asm is using the Intel dialect. Currently, ATT and Intel are
2868the only supported dialects. An example is:
2869
2870.. code-block:: llvm
2871
2872 call void asm inteldialect "eieio", ""()
2873
2874If multiple keywords appear the '``sideeffect``' keyword must come
2875first, the '``alignstack``' keyword second and the '``inteldialect``'
2876keyword last.
2877
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00002878Inline Asm Constraint String
2879^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
2880
2881The constraint list is a comma-separated string, each element containing one or
2882more constraint codes.
2883
2884For each element in the constraint list an appropriate register or memory
2885operand will be chosen, and it will be made available to assembly template
2886string expansion as ``$0`` for the first constraint in the list, ``$1`` for the
2887second, etc.
2888
2889There are three different types of constraints, which are distinguished by a
2890prefix symbol in front of the constraint code: Output, Input, and Clobber. The
2891constraints must always be given in that order: outputs first, then inputs, then
2892clobbers. They cannot be intermingled.
2893
2894There are also three different categories of constraint codes:
2895
2896- Register constraint. This is either a register class, or a fixed physical
2897 register. This kind of constraint will allocate a register, and if necessary,
2898 bitcast the argument or result to the appropriate type.
2899- Memory constraint. This kind of constraint is for use with an instruction
2900 taking a memory operand. Different constraints allow for different addressing
2901 modes used by the target.
2902- Immediate value constraint. This kind of constraint is for an integer or other
2903 immediate value which can be rendered directly into an instruction. The
2904 various target-specific constraints allow the selection of a value in the
2905 proper range for the instruction you wish to use it with.
2906
2907Output constraints
2908""""""""""""""""""
2909
2910Output constraints are specified by an "``=``" prefix (e.g. "``=r``"). This
2911indicates that the assembly will write to this operand, and the operand will
2912then be made available as a return value of the ``asm`` expression. Output
2913constraints do not consume an argument from the call instruction. (Except, see
2914below about indirect outputs).
2915
2916Normally, it is expected that no output locations are written to by the assembly
2917expression until *all* of the inputs have been read. As such, LLVM may assign
2918the same register to an output and an input. If this is not safe (e.g. if the
2919assembly contains two instructions, where the first writes to one output, and
2920the second reads an input and writes to a second output), then the "``&``"
2921modifier must be used (e.g. "``=&r``") to specify that the output is an
2922"early-clobber" output. Marking an ouput as "early-clobber" ensures that LLVM
2923will not use the same register for any inputs (other than an input tied to this
2924output).
2925
2926Input constraints
2927"""""""""""""""""
2928
2929Input constraints do not have a prefix -- just the constraint codes. Each input
2930constraint will consume one argument from the call instruction. It is not
2931permitted for the asm to write to any input register or memory location (unless
2932that input is tied to an output). Note also that multiple inputs may all be
2933assigned to the same register, if LLVM can determine that they necessarily all
2934contain the same value.
2935
2936Instead of providing a Constraint Code, input constraints may also "tie"
2937themselves to an output constraint, by providing an integer as the constraint
2938string. Tied inputs still consume an argument from the call instruction, and
2939take up a position in the asm template numbering as is usual -- they will simply
2940be constrained to always use the same register as the output they've been tied
2941to. For example, a constraint string of "``=r,0``" says to assign a register for
2942output, and use that register as an input as well (it being the 0'th
2943constraint).
2944
2945It is permitted to tie an input to an "early-clobber" output. In that case, no
2946*other* input may share the same register as the input tied to the early-clobber
2947(even when the other input has the same value).
2948
2949You may only tie an input to an output which has a register constraint, not a
2950memory constraint. Only a single input may be tied to an output.
2951
2952There is also an "interesting" feature which deserves a bit of explanation: if a
2953register class constraint allocates a register which is too small for the value
2954type operand provided as input, the input value will be split into multiple
2955registers, and all of them passed to the inline asm.
2956
2957However, this feature is often not as useful as you might think.
2958
2959Firstly, the registers are *not* guaranteed to be consecutive. So, on those
2960architectures that have instructions which operate on multiple consecutive
2961instructions, this is not an appropriate way to support them. (e.g. the 32-bit
2962SparcV8 has a 64-bit load, which instruction takes a single 32-bit register. The
2963hardware then loads into both the named register, and the next register. This
2964feature of inline asm would not be useful to support that.)
2965
2966A few of the targets provide a template string modifier allowing explicit access
2967to the second register of a two-register operand (e.g. MIPS ``L``, ``M``, and
2968``D``). On such an architecture, you can actually access the second allocated
2969register (yet, still, not any subsequent ones). But, in that case, you're still
2970probably better off simply splitting the value into two separate operands, for
2971clarity. (e.g. see the description of the ``A`` constraint on X86, which,
2972despite existing only for use with this feature, is not really a good idea to
2973use)
2974
2975Indirect inputs and outputs
2976"""""""""""""""""""""""""""
2977
2978Indirect output or input constraints can be specified by the "``*``" modifier
2979(which goes after the "``=``" in case of an output). This indicates that the asm
2980will write to or read from the contents of an *address* provided as an input
2981argument. (Note that in this way, indirect outputs act more like an *input* than
2982an output: just like an input, they consume an argument of the call expression,
2983rather than producing a return value. An indirect output constraint is an
2984"output" only in that the asm is expected to write to the contents of the input
2985memory location, instead of just read from it).
2986
2987This is most typically used for memory constraint, e.g. "``=*m``", to pass the
2988address of a variable as a value.
2989
2990It is also possible to use an indirect *register* constraint, but only on output
2991(e.g. "``=*r``"). This will cause LLVM to allocate a register for an output
2992value normally, and then, separately emit a store to the address provided as
2993input, after the provided inline asm. (It's not clear what value this
2994functionality provides, compared to writing the store explicitly after the asm
2995statement, and it can only produce worse code, since it bypasses many
2996optimization passes. I would recommend not using it.)
2997
2998
2999Clobber constraints
3000"""""""""""""""""""
3001
3002A clobber constraint is indicated by a "``~``" prefix. A clobber does not
3003consume an input operand, nor generate an output. Clobbers cannot use any of the
3004general constraint code letters -- they may use only explicit register
3005constraints, e.g. "``~{eax}``". The one exception is that a clobber string of
3006"``~{memory}``" indicates that the assembly writes to arbitrary undeclared
3007memory locations -- not only the memory pointed to by a declared indirect
3008output.
3009
3010
3011Constraint Codes
3012""""""""""""""""
3013After a potential prefix comes constraint code, or codes.
3014
3015A Constraint Code is either a single letter (e.g. "``r``"), a "``^``" character
3016followed by two letters (e.g. "``^wc``"), or "``{``" register-name "``}``"
3017(e.g. "``{eax}``").
3018
3019The one and two letter constraint codes are typically chosen to be the same as
3020GCC's constraint codes.
3021
3022A single constraint may include one or more than constraint code in it, leaving
3023it up to LLVM to choose which one to use. This is included mainly for
3024compatibility with the translation of GCC inline asm coming from clang.
3025
3026There are two ways to specify alternatives, and either or both may be used in an
3027inline asm constraint list:
3028
30291) Append the codes to each other, making a constraint code set. E.g. "``im``"
3030 or "``{eax}m``". This means "choose any of the options in the set". The
3031 choice of constraint is made independently for each constraint in the
3032 constraint list.
3033
30342) Use "``|``" between constraint code sets, creating alternatives. Every
3035 constraint in the constraint list must have the same number of alternative
3036 sets. With this syntax, the same alternative in *all* of the items in the
3037 constraint list will be chosen together.
3038
3039Putting those together, you might have a two operand constraint string like
3040``"rm|r,ri|rm"``. This indicates that if operand 0 is ``r`` or ``m``, then
3041operand 1 may be one of ``r`` or ``i``. If operand 0 is ``r``, then operand 1
3042may be one of ``r`` or ``m``. But, operand 0 and 1 cannot both be of type m.
3043
3044However, the use of either of the alternatives features is *NOT* recommended, as
3045LLVM is not able to make an intelligent choice about which one to use. (At the
3046point it currently needs to choose, not enough information is available to do so
3047in a smart way.) Thus, it simply tries to make a choice that's most likely to
3048compile, not one that will be optimal performance. (e.g., given "``rm``", it'll
3049always choose to use memory, not registers). And, if given multiple registers,
3050or multiple register classes, it will simply choose the first one. (In fact, it
3051doesn't currently even ensure explicitly specified physical registers are
3052unique, so specifying multiple physical registers as alternatives, like
3053``{r11}{r12},{r11}{r12}``, will assign r11 to both operands, not at all what was
3054intended.)
3055
3056Supported Constraint Code List
3057""""""""""""""""""""""""""""""
3058
3059The constraint codes are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
3060GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
3061inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
3062and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
3063
3064Some constraint codes are typically supported by all targets:
3065
3066- ``r``: A register in the target's general purpose register class.
3067- ``m``: A memory address operand. It is target-specific what addressing modes
3068 are supported, typical examples are register, or register + register offset,
3069 or register + immediate offset (of some target-specific size).
3070- ``i``: An integer constant (of target-specific width). Allows either a simple
3071 immediate, or a relocatable value.
3072- ``n``: An integer constant -- *not* including relocatable values.
3073- ``s``: An integer constant, but allowing *only* relocatable values.
3074- ``X``: Allows an operand of any kind, no constraint whatsoever. Typically
3075 useful to pass a label for an asm branch or call.
3076
3077 .. FIXME: but that surely isn't actually okay to jump out of an asm
3078 block without telling llvm about the control transfer???)
3079
3080- ``{register-name}``: Requires exactly the named physical register.
3081
3082Other constraints are target-specific:
3083
3084AArch64:
3085
3086- ``z``: An immediate integer 0. Outputs ``WZR`` or ``XZR``, as appropriate.
3087- ``I``: An immediate integer valid for an ``ADD`` or ``SUB`` instruction,
3088 i.e. 0 to 4095 with optional shift by 12.
3089- ``J``: An immediate integer that, when negated, is valid for an ``ADD`` or
3090 ``SUB`` instruction, i.e. -1 to -4095 with optional left shift by 12.
3091- ``K``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 32' of a
3092 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 32-bit register.
3093- ``L``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 64' of a
3094 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 64-bit register.
3095- ``M``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
3096 32-bit register. This is a superset of ``K``: in addition to the bitmask
3097 immediate, also allows immediate integers which can be loaded with a single
3098 ``MOVZ`` or ``MOVL`` instruction.
3099- ``N``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
3100 64-bit register. This is a superset of ``L``.
3101- ``Q``: Memory address operand must be in a single register (no
3102 offsets). (However, LLVM currently does this for the ``m`` constraint as
3103 well.)
3104- ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register (W* or X*).
3105- ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register.
3106- ``x``: A lower 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register (``V0`` to ``V15``).
3107
3108AMDGPU:
3109
3110- ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
3111- ``[0-9]v``: The 32-bit VGPR register, number 0-9.
3112- ``[0-9]s``: The 32-bit SGPR register, number 0-9.
3113
3114
3115All ARM modes:
3116
3117- ``Q``, ``Um``, ``Un``, ``Uq``, ``Us``, ``Ut``, ``Uv``, ``Uy``: Memory address
3118 operand. Treated the same as operand ``m``, at the moment.
3119
3120ARM and ARM's Thumb2 mode:
3121
3122- ``j``: An immediate integer between 0 and 65535 (valid for ``MOVW``)
3123- ``I``: An immediate integer valid for a data-processing instruction.
3124- ``J``: An immediate integer between -4095 and 4095.
3125- ``K``: An immediate integer whose bitwise inverse is valid for a
3126 data-processing instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``B``" to
3127 print the inverted value).
3128- ``L``: An immediate integer whose negation is valid for a data-processing
3129 instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``n``" to print the negated
3130 value).
3131- ``M``: A power of two or a integer between 0 and 32.
3132- ``N``: Invalid immediate constraint.
3133- ``O``: Invalid immediate constraint.
3134- ``r``: A general-purpose 32-bit integer register (``r0-r15``).
3135- ``l``: In Thumb2 mode, low 32-bit GPR registers (``r0-r7``). In ARM mode, same
3136 as ``r``.
3137- ``h``: In Thumb2 mode, a high 32-bit GPR register (``r8-r15``). In ARM mode,
3138 invalid.
3139- ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
3140 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
3141- ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
3142 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
3143- ``t``: A floating-point/SIMD register, only supports 32-bit values:
3144 ``s0-s31``.
3145
3146ARM's Thumb1 mode:
3147
3148- ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255.
3149- ``J``: An immediate integer between -255 and -1.
3150- ``K``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255, with optional left-shift by
3151 some amount.
3152- ``L``: An immediate integer between -7 and 7.
3153- ``M``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between 0 and 1020.
3154- ``N``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
3155- ``O``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between -508 and 508.
3156- ``r``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3157- ``l``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3158- ``h``: A high GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3159- ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
3160 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
3161- ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
3162 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
3163- ``t``: A floating-point/SIMD register, only supports 32-bit values:
3164 ``s0-s31``.
3165
3166
3167Hexagon:
3168
3169- ``o``, ``v``: A memory address operand, treated the same as constraint ``m``,
3170 at the moment.
3171- ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit register.
3172
3173MSP430:
3174
3175- ``r``: An 8 or 16-bit register.
3176
3177MIPS:
3178
3179- ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3180- ``J``: An immediate integer zero.
3181- ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
3182- ``L``: An immediate 32-bit integer, where the lower 16 bits are 0.
3183- ``N``: An immediate integer between -65535 and -1.
3184- ``O``: An immediate signed 15-bit integer.
3185- ``P``: An immediate integer between 1 and 65535.
3186- ``m``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
3187 register plus 16-bit immediate offset. In MIPS mode, just a base register.
3188- ``R``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
3189 register plus a 9-bit signed offset. In MIPS mode, the same as constraint
3190 ``m``.
3191- ``ZC``: A memory address operand, suitable for use in a ``pref``, ``ll``, or
3192 ``sc`` instruction on the given subtarget (details vary).
3193- ``r``, ``d``, ``y``: A 32 or 64-bit GPR register.
3194- ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit FPU register (``F0-F31``), or a 128-bit MSA register
3195 (``W0-W31``).
3196- ``c``: A 32-bit or 64-bit GPR register suitable for indirect jump (always
3197 ``25``).
3198- ``l``: The ``lo`` register, 32 or 64-bit.
3199- ``x``: Invalid.
3200
3201NVPTX:
3202
3203- ``b``: A 1-bit integer register.
3204- ``c`` or ``h``: A 16-bit integer register.
3205- ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3206- ``l`` or ``N``: A 64-bit integer register.
3207- ``f``: A 32-bit float register.
3208- ``d``: A 64-bit float register.
3209
3210
3211PowerPC:
3212
3213- ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3214- ``J``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
3215- ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
3216- ``L``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
3217- ``M``: An immediate integer greater than 31.
3218- ``N``: An immediate integer that is an exact power of 2.
3219- ``O``: The immediate integer constant 0.
3220- ``P``: An immediate integer constant whose negation is a signed 16-bit
3221 constant.
3222- ``es``, ``o``, ``Q``, ``Z``, ``Zy``: A memory address operand, currently
3223 treated the same as ``m``.
3224- ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
3225- ``b``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register, excluding ``R0`` (that is:
3226 ``R1-R31``).
3227- ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit float register (``F0-F31``), or when QPX is enabled, a
3228 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``; aliases the ``F`` registers).
3229- ``v``: For ``4 x f32`` or ``4 x f64`` types, when QPX is enabled, a
3230 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``), otherwise a 128-bit
3231 altivec vector register (``V0-V31``).
3232
3233 .. FIXME: is this a bug that v accepts QPX registers? I think this
3234 is supposed to only use the altivec vector registers?
3235
3236- ``y``: Condition register (``CR0-CR7``).
3237- ``wc``: An individual CR bit in a CR register.
3238- ``wa``, ``wd``, ``wf``: Any 128-bit VSX vector register, from the full VSX
3239 register set (overlapping both the floating-point and vector register files).
3240- ``ws``: A 32 or 64-bit floating point register, from the full VSX register
3241 set.
3242
3243Sparc:
3244
3245- ``I``: An immediate 13-bit signed integer.
3246- ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3247
3248SystemZ:
3249
3250- ``I``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
3251- ``J``: An immediate unsigned 12-bit integer.
3252- ``K``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3253- ``L``: An immediate signed 20-bit integer.
3254- ``M``: An immediate integer 0x7fffffff.
3255- ``Q``, ``R``, ``S``, ``T``: A memory address operand, treated the same as
3256 ``m``, at the moment.
3257- ``r`` or ``d``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer register.
3258- ``a``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer address register (excludes R0, which in an
3259 address context evaluates as zero).
3260- ``h``: A 32-bit value in the high part of a 64bit data register
3261 (LLVM-specific)
3262- ``f``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating point register.
3263
3264X86:
3265
3266- ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
3267- ``J``: An immediate integer between 0 and 64.
3268- ``K``: An immediate signed 8-bit integer.
3269- ``L``: An immediate integer, 0xff or 0xffff or (in 64-bit mode only)
3270 0xffffffff.
3271- ``M``: An immediate integer between 0 and 3.
3272- ``N``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
3273- ``O``: An immediate integer between 0 and 127.
3274- ``e``: An immediate 32-bit signed integer.
3275- ``Z``: An immediate 32-bit unsigned integer.
3276- ``o``, ``v``: Treated the same as ``m``, at the moment.
3277- ``q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
3278 ``l`` integer register. On X86-32, this is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d``
3279 registers, and on X86-64, it is all of the integer registers.
3280- ``Q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
3281 ``h`` integer register. This is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d`` registers.
3282- ``r`` or ``l``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit integer register.
3283- ``R``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit "legacy" integer register -- one which has
3284 existed since i386, and can be accessed without the REX prefix.
3285- ``f``: A 32, 64, or 80-bit '387 FPU stack pseudo-register.
3286- ``y``: A 64-bit MMX register, if MMX is enabled.
3287- ``x``: If SSE is enabled: a 32 or 64-bit scalar operand, or 128-bit vector
3288 operand in a SSE register. If AVX is also enabled, can also be a 256-bit
3289 vector operand in an AVX register. If AVX-512 is also enabled, can also be a
3290 512-bit vector operand in an AVX512 register, Otherwise, an error.
3291- ``Y``: The same as ``x``, if *SSE2* is enabled, otherwise an error.
3292- ``A``: Special case: allocates EAX first, then EDX, for a single operand (in
3293 32-bit mode, a 64-bit integer operand will get split into two registers). It
3294 is not recommended to use this constraint, as in 64-bit mode, the 64-bit
3295 operand will get allocated only to RAX -- if two 32-bit operands are needed,
3296 you're better off splitting it yourself, before passing it to the asm
3297 statement.
3298
3299XCore:
3300
3301- ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3302
3303
3304.. _inline-asm-modifiers:
3305
3306Asm template argument modifiers
3307^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3308
3309In the asm template string, modifiers can be used on the operand reference, like
3310"``${0:n}``".
3311
3312The modifiers are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
3313GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
3314inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
3315and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
3316
3317Target-independent:
3318
3319- ``c``: Print an immediate integer constant unadorned, without
3320 the target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3321- ``n``: Negate and print immediate integer constant unadorned, without the
3322 target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3323- ``l``: Print as an unadorned label, without the target-specific label
3324 punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3325
3326AArch64:
3327
3328- ``w``: Print a GPR register with a ``w*`` name instead of ``x*`` name. E.g.,
3329 instead of ``x30``, print ``w30``.
3330- ``x``: Print a GPR register with a ``x*`` name. (this is the default, anyhow).
3331- ``b``, ``h``, ``s``, ``d``, ``q``: Print a floating-point/SIMD register with a
3332 ``b*``, ``h*``, ``s*``, ``d*``, or ``q*`` name, rather than the default of
3333 ``v*``.
3334
3335AMDGPU:
3336
3337- ``r``: No effect.
3338
3339ARM:
3340
3341- ``a``: Print an operand as an address (with ``[`` and ``]`` surrounding a
3342 register).
3343- ``P``: No effect.
3344- ``q``: No effect.
3345- ``y``: Print a VFP single-precision register as an indexed double (e.g. print
3346 as ``d4[1]`` instead of ``s9``)
3347- ``B``: Bitwise invert and print an immediate integer constant without ``#``
3348 prefix.
3349- ``L``: Print the low 16-bits of an immediate integer constant.
3350- ``M``: Print as a register set suitable for ldm/stm. Also prints *all*
3351 register operands subsequent to the specified one (!), so use carefully.
3352- ``Q``: Print the low-order register of a register-pair, or the low-order
3353 register of a two-register operand.
3354- ``R``: Print the high-order register of a register-pair, or the high-order
3355 register of a two-register operand.
3356- ``H``: Print the second register of a register-pair. (On a big-endian system,
3357 ``H`` is equivalent to ``Q``, and on little-endian system, ``H`` is equivalent
3358 to ``R``.)
3359
3360 .. FIXME: H doesn't currently support printing the second register
3361 of a two-register operand.
3362
3363- ``e``: Print the low doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
3364- ``f``: Print the high doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
3365- ``m``: Print the base register of a memory operand without the ``[`` and ``]``
3366 adornment.
3367
3368Hexagon:
3369
3370- ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
3371 has been allocated consecutively to the first.
3372
3373 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
3374 nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
3375
3376- ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
3377 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
3378
3379MSP430:
3380
3381No additional modifiers.
3382
3383MIPS:
3384
3385- ``X``: Print an immediate integer as hexadecimal
3386- ``x``: Print the low 16 bits of an immediate integer as hexadecimal.
3387- ``d``: Print an immediate integer as decimal.
3388- ``m``: Subtract one and print an immediate integer as decimal.
3389- ``z``: Print $0 if an immediate zero, otherwise print normally.
3390- ``L``: Print the low-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
3391 address of the low-order word of a double-word memory operand.
3392
3393 .. FIXME: L seems to be missing memory operand support.
3394
3395- ``M``: Print the high-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
3396 address of the high-order word of a double-word memory operand.
3397
3398 .. FIXME: M seems to be missing memory operand support.
3399
3400- ``D``: Print the second register of a two-register operand, or prints the
3401 second word of a double-word memory operand. (On a big-endian system, ``D`` is
3402 equivalent to ``L``, and on little-endian system, ``D`` is equivalent to
3403 ``M``.)
3404- ``w``: No effect.
3405
3406NVPTX:
3407
3408- ``r``: No effect.
3409
3410PowerPC:
3411
3412- ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
3413 has been allocated consecutively to the first.
3414
3415 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
3416 nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
3417
3418- ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
3419 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
3420- ``y``: For a memory operand, prints formatter for a two-register X-form
3421 instruction. (Currently always prints ``r0,OPERAND``).
3422- ``U``: Prints 'u' if the memory operand is an update form, and nothing
3423 otherwise. (NOTE: LLVM does not support update form, so this will currently
3424 always print nothing)
3425- ``X``: Prints 'x' if the memory operand is an indexed form. (NOTE: LLVM does
3426 not support indexed form, so this will currently always print nothing)
3427
3428Sparc:
3429
3430- ``r``: No effect.
3431
3432SystemZ:
3433
3434SystemZ implements only ``n``, and does *not* support any of the other
3435target-independent modifiers.
3436
3437X86:
3438
3439- ``c``: Print an unadorned integer or symbol name. (The latter is
3440 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier).
3441- ``A``: Print a register name with a '``*``' before it.
3442- ``b``: Print an 8-bit register name (e.g. ``al``); do nothing on a memory
3443 operand.
3444- ``h``: Print the upper 8-bit register name (e.g. ``ah``); do nothing on a
3445 memory operand.
3446- ``w``: Print the 16-bit register name (e.g. ``ax``); do nothing on a memory
3447 operand.
3448- ``k``: Print the 32-bit register name (e.g. ``eax``); do nothing on a memory
3449 operand.
3450- ``q``: Print the 64-bit register name (e.g. ``rax``), if 64-bit registers are
3451 available, otherwise the 32-bit register name; do nothing on a memory operand.
3452- ``n``: Negate and print an unadorned integer, or, for operands other than an
3453 immediate integer (e.g. a relocatable symbol expression), print a '-' before
3454 the operand. (The behavior for relocatable symbol expressions is a
3455 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier)
3456- ``H``: Print a memory reference with additional offset +8.
3457- ``P``: Print a memory reference or operand for use as the argument of a call
3458 instruction. (E.g. omit ``(rip)``, even though it's PC-relative.)
3459
3460XCore:
3461
3462No additional modifiers.
3463
3464
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003465Inline Asm Metadata
3466^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3467
3468The call instructions that wrap inline asm nodes may have a
3469"``!srcloc``" MDNode attached to it that contains a list of constant
3470integers. If present, the code generator will use the integer as the
3471location cookie value when report errors through the ``LLVMContext``
3472error reporting mechanisms. This allows a front-end to correlate backend
3473errors that occur with inline asm back to the source code that produced
3474it. For example:
3475
3476.. code-block:: llvm
3477
3478 call void asm sideeffect "something bad", ""(), !srcloc !42
3479 ...
3480 !42 = !{ i32 1234567 }
3481
3482It is up to the front-end to make sense of the magic numbers it places
3483in the IR. If the MDNode contains multiple constants, the code generator
3484will use the one that corresponds to the line of the asm that the error
3485occurs on.
3486
3487.. _metadata:
3488
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003489Metadata
3490========
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003491
3492LLVM IR allows metadata to be attached to instructions in the program
3493that can convey extra information about the code to the optimizers and
3494code generator. One example application of metadata is source-level
3495debug information. There are two metadata primitives: strings and nodes.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003496
3497Metadata does not have a type, and is not a value. If referenced from a
3498``call`` instruction, it uses the ``metadata`` type.
3499
3500All metadata are identified in syntax by a exclamation point ('``!``').
3501
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003502.. _metadata-string:
3503
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003504Metadata Nodes and Metadata Strings
3505-----------------------------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003506
3507A metadata string is a string surrounded by double quotes. It can
3508contain any character by escaping non-printable characters with
3509"``\xx``" where "``xx``" is the two digit hex code. For example:
3510"``!"test\00"``".
3511
3512Metadata nodes are represented with notation similar to structure
3513constants (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by braces and
3514preceded by an exclamation point). Metadata nodes can have any values as
3515their operand. For example:
3516
3517.. code-block:: llvm
3518
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003519 !{ !"test\00", i32 10}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003520
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith090a19b2015-01-08 22:38:29 +00003521Metadata nodes that aren't uniqued use the ``distinct`` keyword. For example:
3522
3523.. code-block:: llvm
3524
3525 !0 = distinct !{!"test\00", i32 10}
3526
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith99010342015-01-08 23:50:26 +00003527``distinct`` nodes are useful when nodes shouldn't be merged based on their
3528content. They can also occur when transformations cause uniquing collisions
3529when metadata operands change.
3530
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003531A :ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` is a collection of
3532metadata nodes, which can be looked up in the module symbol table. For
3533example:
3534
3535.. code-block:: llvm
3536
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003537 !foo = !{!4, !3}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003538
3539Metadata can be used as function arguments. Here ``llvm.dbg.value``
3540function is using two metadata arguments:
3541
3542.. code-block:: llvm
3543
3544 call void @llvm.dbg.value(metadata !24, i64 0, metadata !25)
3545
3546Metadata can be attached with an instruction. Here metadata ``!21`` is
3547attached to the ``add`` instruction using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
3548
3549.. code-block:: llvm
3550
3551 %indvar.next = add i64 %indvar, 1, !dbg !21
3552
3553More information about specific metadata nodes recognized by the
3554optimizers and code generator is found below.
3555
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003556.. _specialized-metadata:
3557
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00003558Specialized Metadata Nodes
3559^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3560
3561Specialized metadata nodes are custom data structures in metadata (as opposed
3562to generic tuples). Their fields are labelled, and can be specified in any
3563order.
3564
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003565These aren't inherently debug info centric, but currently all the specialized
3566metadata nodes are related to debug info.
3567
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003568.. _DICompileUnit:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003569
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003570DICompileUnit
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003571"""""""""""""
3572
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003573``DICompileUnit`` nodes represent a compile unit. The ``enums:``,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003574``retainedTypes:``, ``subprograms:``, ``globals:`` and ``imports:`` fields are
3575tuples containing the debug info to be emitted along with the compile unit,
3576regardless of code optimizations (some nodes are only emitted if there are
3577references to them from instructions).
3578
3579.. code-block:: llvm
3580
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003581 !0 = !DICompileUnit(language: DW_LANG_C99, file: !1, producer: "clang",
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003582 isOptimized: true, flags: "-O2", runtimeVersion: 2,
3583 splitDebugFilename: "abc.debug", emissionKind: 1,
3584 enums: !2, retainedTypes: !3, subprograms: !4,
3585 globals: !5, imports: !6)
3586
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003587Compile unit descriptors provide the root scope for objects declared in a
3588specific compilation unit. File descriptors are defined using this scope.
3589These descriptors are collected by a named metadata ``!llvm.dbg.cu``. They
3590keep track of subprograms, global variables, type information, and imported
3591entities (declarations and namespaces).
3592
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003593.. _DIFile:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003594
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003595DIFile
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003596""""""
3597
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003598``DIFile`` nodes represent files. The ``filename:`` can include slashes.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003599
3600.. code-block:: llvm
3601
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003602 !0 = !DIFile(filename: "path/to/file", directory: "/path/to/dir")
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003603
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003604Files are sometimes used in ``scope:`` fields, and are the only valid target
3605for ``file:`` fields.
3606
Michael Kuperstein605308a2015-05-14 10:58:59 +00003607.. _DIBasicType:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003608
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003609DIBasicType
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003610"""""""""""
3611
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003612``DIBasicType`` nodes represent primitive types, such as ``int``, ``bool`` and
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003613``float``. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_base_type``.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003614
3615.. code-block:: llvm
3616
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003617 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003618 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003619 !1 = !DIBasicType(tag: DW_TAG_unspecified_type, name: "decltype(nullptr)")
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003620
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003621The ``encoding:`` describes the details of the type. Usually it's one of the
3622following:
3623
3624.. code-block:: llvm
3625
3626 DW_ATE_address = 1
3627 DW_ATE_boolean = 2
3628 DW_ATE_float = 4
3629 DW_ATE_signed = 5
3630 DW_ATE_signed_char = 6
3631 DW_ATE_unsigned = 7
3632 DW_ATE_unsigned_char = 8
3633
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003634.. _DISubroutineType:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003635
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003636DISubroutineType
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003637""""""""""""""""
3638
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003639``DISubroutineType`` nodes represent subroutine types. Their ``types:`` field
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003640refers to a tuple; the first operand is the return type, while the rest are the
3641types of the formal arguments in order. If the first operand is ``null``, that
3642represents a function with no return value (such as ``void foo() {}`` in C++).
3643
3644.. code-block:: llvm
3645
3646 !0 = !BasicType(name: "int", size: 32, align: 32, DW_ATE_signed)
3647 !1 = !BasicType(name: "char", size: 8, align: 8, DW_ATE_signed_char)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003648 !2 = !DISubroutineType(types: !{null, !0, !1}) ; void (int, char)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003649
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003650.. _DIDerivedType:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003651
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003652DIDerivedType
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003653"""""""""""""
3654
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003655``DIDerivedType`` nodes represent types derived from other types, such as
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003656qualified types.
3657
3658.. code-block:: llvm
3659
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003660 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003661 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003662 !1 = !DIDerivedType(tag: DW_TAG_pointer_type, baseType: !0, size: 32,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003663 align: 32)
3664
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003665The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
3666
3667.. code-block:: llvm
3668
3669 DW_TAG_formal_parameter = 5
3670 DW_TAG_member = 13
3671 DW_TAG_pointer_type = 15
3672 DW_TAG_reference_type = 16
3673 DW_TAG_typedef = 22
3674 DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type = 31
3675 DW_TAG_const_type = 38
3676 DW_TAG_volatile_type = 53
3677 DW_TAG_restrict_type = 55
3678
3679``DW_TAG_member`` is used to define a member of a :ref:`composite type
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003680<DICompositeType>` or :ref:`subprogram <DISubprogram>`. The type of the member
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003681is the ``baseType:``. The ``offset:`` is the member's bit offset.
3682``DW_TAG_formal_parameter`` is used to define a member which is a formal
3683argument of a subprogram.
3684
3685``DW_TAG_typedef`` is used to provide a name for the ``baseType:``.
3686
3687``DW_TAG_pointer_type``, ``DW_TAG_reference_type``, ``DW_TAG_const_type``,
3688``DW_TAG_volatile_type`` and ``DW_TAG_restrict_type`` are used to qualify the
3689``baseType:``.
3690
3691Note that the ``void *`` type is expressed as a type derived from NULL.
3692
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003693.. _DICompositeType:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003694
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003695DICompositeType
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003696"""""""""""""""
3697
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003698``DICompositeType`` nodes represent types composed of other types, like
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003699structures and unions. ``elements:`` points to a tuple of the composed types.
3700
3701If the source language supports ODR, the ``identifier:`` field gives the unique
3702identifier used for type merging between modules. When specified, other types
3703can refer to composite types indirectly via a :ref:`metadata string
3704<metadata-string>` that matches their identifier.
3705
3706.. code-block:: llvm
3707
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003708 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
3709 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
3710 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
3711 !3 = !DICompositeType(tag: DW_TAG_enumeration_type, name: "Enum", file: !12,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003712 line: 2, size: 32, align: 32, identifier: "_M4Enum",
3713 elements: !{!0, !1, !2})
3714
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003715The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
3716
3717.. code-block:: llvm
3718
3719 DW_TAG_array_type = 1
3720 DW_TAG_class_type = 2
3721 DW_TAG_enumeration_type = 4
3722 DW_TAG_structure_type = 19
3723 DW_TAG_union_type = 23
3724 DW_TAG_subroutine_type = 21
3725 DW_TAG_inheritance = 28
3726
3727
3728For ``DW_TAG_array_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`subrange
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003729descriptors <DISubrange>`, each representing the range of subscripts at that
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003730level of indexing. The ``DIFlagVector`` flag to ``flags:`` indicates that an
3731array type is a native packed vector.
3732
3733For ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`enumerator
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003734descriptors <DIEnumerator>`, each representing the definition of an enumeration
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003735value for the set. All enumeration type descriptors are collected in the
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003736``enums:`` field of the :ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003737
3738For ``DW_TAG_structure_type``, ``DW_TAG_class_type``, and
3739``DW_TAG_union_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`derived types
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003740<DIDerivedType>` with ``tag: DW_TAG_member`` or ``tag: DW_TAG_inheritance``.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003741
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003742.. _DISubrange:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003743
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003744DISubrange
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003745""""""""""
3746
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003747``DISubrange`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_array_type`` variants of
3748:ref:`DICompositeType`. ``count: -1`` indicates an empty array.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003749
3750.. code-block:: llvm
3751
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003752 !0 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 0) ; array counting from 0
3753 !1 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 1) ; array counting from 1
3754 !2 = !DISubrange(count: -1) ; empty array.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003755
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003756.. _DIEnumerator:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003757
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003758DIEnumerator
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003759""""""""""""
3760
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003761``DIEnumerator`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``
3762variants of :ref:`DICompositeType`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003763
3764.. code-block:: llvm
3765
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003766 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
3767 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
3768 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003769
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003770DITemplateTypeParameter
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003771"""""""""""""""""""""""
3772
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003773``DITemplateTypeParameter`` nodes represent type parameters to generic source
3774language constructs. They are used (optionally) in :ref:`DICompositeType` and
3775:ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003776
3777.. code-block:: llvm
3778
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003779 !0 = !DITemplateTypeParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003780
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003781DITemplateValueParameter
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003782""""""""""""""""""""""""
3783
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003784``DITemplateValueParameter`` nodes represent value parameters to generic source
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003785language constructs. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_template_value_parameter``,
3786but if specified can also be set to ``DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param`` or
3787``DW_TAG_GNU_template_param_pack``. They are used (optionally) in
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003788:ref:`DICompositeType` and :ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003789
3790.. code-block:: llvm
3791
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003792 !0 = !DITemplateValueParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1, value: i32 7)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003793
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003794DINamespace
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003795"""""""""""
3796
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003797``DINamespace`` nodes represent namespaces in the source language.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003798
3799.. code-block:: llvm
3800
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003801 !0 = !DINamespace(name: "myawesomeproject", scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003802
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003803DIGlobalVariable
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003804""""""""""""""""
3805
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003806``DIGlobalVariable`` nodes represent global variables in the source language.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003807
3808.. code-block:: llvm
3809
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003810 !0 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "foo", linkageName: "foo", scope: !1,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003811 file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
3812 isDefinition: false, variable: i32* @foo,
3813 declaration: !4)
3814
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003815All global variables should be referenced by the `globals:` field of a
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003816:ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003817
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003818.. _DISubprogram:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003819
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003820DISubprogram
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003821""""""""""""
3822
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003823``DISubprogram`` nodes represent functions from the source language. The
3824``variables:`` field points at :ref:`variables <DILocalVariable>` that must be
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003825retained, even if their IR counterparts are optimized out of the IR. The
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003826``type:`` field must point at an :ref:`DISubroutineType`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003827
3828.. code-block:: llvm
3829
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003830 !0 = !DISubprogram(name: "foo", linkageName: "_Zfoov", scope: !1,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003831 file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
3832 isDefinition: false, scopeLine: 8, containingType: !4,
3833 virtuality: DW_VIRTUALITY_pure_virtual, virtualIndex: 10,
3834 flags: DIFlagPrototyped, isOptimized: true,
3835 function: void ()* @_Z3foov,
3836 templateParams: !5, declaration: !6, variables: !7)
3837
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003838.. _DILexicalBlock:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003839
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003840DILexicalBlock
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003841""""""""""""""
3842
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003843``DILexicalBlock`` nodes describe nested blocks within a :ref:`subprogram
3844<DISubprogram>`. The line number and column numbers are used to dinstinguish
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003845two lexical blocks at same depth. They are valid targets for ``scope:``
3846fields.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003847
3848.. code-block:: llvm
3849
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003850 !0 = distinct !DILexicalBlock(scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7, column: 35)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003851
3852Usually lexical blocks are ``distinct`` to prevent node merging based on
3853operands.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003854
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003855.. _DILexicalBlockFile:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003856
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003857DILexicalBlockFile
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003858""""""""""""""""""
3859
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003860``DILexicalBlockFile`` nodes are used to discriminate between sections of a
3861:ref:`lexical block <DILexicalBlock>`. The ``file:`` field can be changed to
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003862indicate textual inclusion, or the ``discriminator:`` field can be used to
3863discriminate between control flow within a single block in the source language.
3864
3865.. code-block:: llvm
3866
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003867 !0 = !DILexicalBlock(scope: !3, file: !4, line: 7, column: 35)
3868 !1 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 0)
3869 !2 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 1)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003870
Michael Kuperstein605308a2015-05-14 10:58:59 +00003871.. _DILocation:
3872
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003873DILocation
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00003874""""""""""
3875
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003876``DILocation`` nodes represent source debug locations. The ``scope:`` field is
3877mandatory, and points at an :ref:`DILexicalBlockFile`, an
3878:ref:`DILexicalBlock`, or an :ref:`DISubprogram`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00003879
3880.. code-block:: llvm
3881
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003882 !0 = !DILocation(line: 2900, column: 42, scope: !1, inlinedAt: !2)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00003883
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003884.. _DILocalVariable:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003885
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003886DILocalVariable
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003887"""""""""""""""
3888
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003889``DILocalVariable`` nodes represent local variables in the source language.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003890Instead of ``DW_TAG_variable``, they use LLVM-specific fake tags to
3891discriminate between local variables (``DW_TAG_auto_variable``) and subprogram
3892arguments (``DW_TAG_arg_variable``). In the latter case, the ``arg:`` field
3893specifies the argument position, and this variable will be included in the
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003894``variables:`` field of its :ref:`DISubprogram`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003895
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003896.. code-block:: llvm
3897
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003898 !0 = !DILocalVariable(tag: DW_TAG_arg_variable, name: "this", arg: 0,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003899 scope: !3, file: !2, line: 7, type: !3,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith62e0f452015-04-15 22:29:27 +00003900 flags: DIFlagArtificial)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003901 !1 = !DILocalVariable(tag: DW_TAG_arg_variable, name: "x", arg: 1,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith62e0f452015-04-15 22:29:27 +00003902 scope: !4, file: !2, line: 7, type: !3)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003903 !1 = !DILocalVariable(tag: DW_TAG_auto_variable, name: "y",
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith62e0f452015-04-15 22:29:27 +00003904 scope: !5, file: !2, line: 7, type: !3)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003905
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003906DIExpression
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003907""""""""""""
3908
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003909``DIExpression`` nodes represent DWARF expression sequences. They are used in
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003910:ref:`debug intrinsics<dbg_intrinsics>` (such as ``llvm.dbg.declare``) to
3911describe how the referenced LLVM variable relates to the source language
3912variable.
3913
3914The current supported vocabulary is limited:
3915
3916- ``DW_OP_deref`` dereferences the working expression.
3917- ``DW_OP_plus, 93`` adds ``93`` to the working expression.
3918- ``DW_OP_bit_piece, 16, 8`` specifies the offset and size (``16`` and ``8``
3919 here, respectively) of the variable piece from the working expression.
3920
3921.. code-block:: llvm
3922
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003923 !0 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref)
3924 !1 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_plus, 3)
3925 !2 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7)
3926 !3 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref, DW_OP_plus, 3, DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003927
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003928DIObjCProperty
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003929""""""""""""""
3930
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003931``DIObjCProperty`` nodes represent Objective-C property nodes.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003932
3933.. code-block:: llvm
3934
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003935 !3 = !DIObjCProperty(name: "foo", file: !1, line: 7, setter: "setFoo",
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003936 getter: "getFoo", attributes: 7, type: !2)
3937
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003938DIImportedEntity
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003939""""""""""""""""
3940
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003941``DIImportedEntity`` nodes represent entities (such as modules) imported into a
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003942compile unit.
3943
3944.. code-block:: llvm
3945
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003946 !2 = !DIImportedEntity(tag: DW_TAG_imported_module, name: "foo", scope: !0,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003947 entity: !1, line: 7)
3948
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003949'``tbaa``' Metadata
3950^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3951
3952In LLVM IR, memory does not have types, so LLVM's own type system is not
3953suitable for doing TBAA. Instead, metadata is added to the IR to
3954describe a type system of a higher level language. This can be used to
3955implement typical C/C++ TBAA, but it can also be used to implement
3956custom alias analysis behavior for other languages.
3957
3958The current metadata format is very simple. TBAA metadata nodes have up
3959to three fields, e.g.:
3960
3961.. code-block:: llvm
3962
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003963 !0 = !{ !"an example type tree" }
3964 !1 = !{ !"int", !0 }
3965 !2 = !{ !"float", !0 }
3966 !3 = !{ !"const float", !2, i64 1 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003967
3968The first field is an identity field. It can be any value, usually a
3969metadata string, which uniquely identifies the type. The most important
3970name in the tree is the name of the root node. Two trees with different
3971root node names are entirely disjoint, even if they have leaves with
3972common names.
3973
3974The second field identifies the type's parent node in the tree, or is
3975null or omitted for a root node. A type is considered to alias all of
3976its descendants and all of its ancestors in the tree. Also, a type is
3977considered to alias all types in other trees, so that bitcode produced
3978from multiple front-ends is handled conservatively.
3979
3980If the third field is present, it's an integer which if equal to 1
3981indicates that the type is "constant" (meaning
3982``pointsToConstantMemory`` should return true; see `other useful
3983AliasAnalysis methods <AliasAnalysis.html#OtherItfs>`_).
3984
3985'``tbaa.struct``' Metadata
3986^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3987
3988The :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>` is often used to implement
3989aggregate assignment operations in C and similar languages, however it
3990is defined to copy a contiguous region of memory, which is more than
3991strictly necessary for aggregate types which contain holes due to
3992padding. Also, it doesn't contain any TBAA information about the fields
3993of the aggregate.
3994
3995``!tbaa.struct`` metadata can describe which memory subregions in a
3996memcpy are padding and what the TBAA tags of the struct are.
3997
3998The current metadata format is very simple. ``!tbaa.struct`` metadata
3999nodes are a list of operands which are in conceptual groups of three.
4000For each group of three, the first operand gives the byte offset of a
4001field in bytes, the second gives its size in bytes, and the third gives
4002its tbaa tag. e.g.:
4003
4004.. code-block:: llvm
4005
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004006 !4 = !{ i64 0, i64 4, !1, i64 8, i64 4, !2 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004007
4008This describes a struct with two fields. The first is at offset 0 bytes
4009with size 4 bytes, and has tbaa tag !1. The second is at offset 8 bytes
4010and has size 4 bytes and has tbaa tag !2.
4011
4012Note that the fields need not be contiguous. In this example, there is a
40134 byte gap between the two fields. This gap represents padding which
4014does not carry useful data and need not be preserved.
4015
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004016'``noalias``' and '``alias.scope``' Metadata
Dan Liewbafdcba2014-07-28 13:33:51 +00004017^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004018
4019``noalias`` and ``alias.scope`` metadata provide the ability to specify generic
4020noalias memory-access sets. This means that some collection of memory access
4021instructions (loads, stores, memory-accessing calls, etc.) that carry
4022``noalias`` metadata can specifically be specified not to alias with some other
4023collection of memory access instructions that carry ``alias.scope`` metadata.
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004024Each type of metadata specifies a list of scopes where each scope has an id and
Ed Maste8ed40ce2015-04-14 20:52:58 +00004025a domain. When evaluating an aliasing query, if for some domain, the set
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004026of scopes with that domain in one instruction's ``alias.scope`` list is a
Arch D. Robison96cf7ab2015-02-24 20:11:49 +00004027subset of (or equal to) the set of scopes for that domain in another
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004028instruction's ``noalias`` list, then the two memory accesses are assumed not to
4029alias.
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004030
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004031The metadata identifying each domain is itself a list containing one or two
4032entries. The first entry is the name of the domain. Note that if the name is a
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004033string then it can be combined accross functions and translation units. A
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004034self-reference can be used to create globally unique domain names. A
4035descriptive string may optionally be provided as a second list entry.
4036
4037The metadata identifying each scope is also itself a list containing two or
4038three entries. The first entry is the name of the scope. Note that if the name
4039is a string then it can be combined accross functions and translation units. A
4040self-reference can be used to create globally unique scope names. A metadata
4041reference to the scope's domain is the second entry. A descriptive string may
4042optionally be provided as a third list entry.
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004043
4044For example,
4045
4046.. code-block:: llvm
4047
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004048 ; Two scope domains:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004049 !0 = !{!0}
4050 !1 = !{!1}
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004051
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004052 ; Some scopes in these domains:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004053 !2 = !{!2, !0}
4054 !3 = !{!3, !0}
4055 !4 = !{!4, !1}
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004056
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004057 ; Some scope lists:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004058 !5 = !{!4} ; A list containing only scope !4
4059 !6 = !{!4, !3, !2}
4060 !7 = !{!3}
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004061
4062 ; These two instructions don't alias:
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004063 %0 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004064 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !5
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004065
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004066 ; These two instructions also don't alias (for domain !1, the set of scopes
4067 ; in the !alias.scope equals that in the !noalias list):
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004068 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004069 store float %2, float* %arrayidx.i2, align 4, !noalias !6
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004070
Adam Nemet0a8416f2015-05-11 08:30:28 +00004071 ; These two instructions may alias (for domain !0, the set of scopes in
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004072 ; the !noalias list is not a superset of, or equal to, the scopes in the
4073 ; !alias.scope list):
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004074 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !6
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004075 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !7
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004076
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004077'``fpmath``' Metadata
4078^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4079
4080``fpmath`` metadata may be attached to any instruction of floating point
4081type. It can be used to express the maximum acceptable error in the
4082result of that instruction, in ULPs, thus potentially allowing the
4083compiler to use a more efficient but less accurate method of computing
4084it. ULP is defined as follows:
4085
4086 If ``x`` is a real number that lies between two finite consecutive
4087 floating-point numbers ``a`` and ``b``, without being equal to one
4088 of them, then ``ulp(x) = |b - a|``, otherwise ``ulp(x)`` is the
4089 distance between the two non-equal finite floating-point numbers
4090 nearest ``x``. Moreover, ``ulp(NaN)`` is ``NaN``.
4091
4092The metadata node shall consist of a single positive floating point
4093number representing the maximum relative error, for example:
4094
4095.. code-block:: llvm
4096
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004097 !0 = !{ float 2.5 } ; maximum acceptable inaccuracy is 2.5 ULPs
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004098
Philip Reamesf8bf9dd2015-02-27 23:14:50 +00004099.. _range-metadata:
4100
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004101'``range``' Metadata
4102^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4103
Jingyue Wu37fcb592014-06-19 16:50:16 +00004104``range`` metadata may be attached only to ``load``, ``call`` and ``invoke`` of
4105integer types. It expresses the possible ranges the loaded value or the value
4106returned by the called function at this call site is in. The ranges are
4107represented with a flattened list of integers. The loaded value or the value
4108returned is known to be in the union of the ranges defined by each consecutive
4109pair. Each pair has the following properties:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004110
4111- The type must match the type loaded by the instruction.
4112- The pair ``a,b`` represents the range ``[a,b)``.
4113- Both ``a`` and ``b`` are constants.
4114- The range is allowed to wrap.
4115- The range should not represent the full or empty set. That is,
4116 ``a!=b``.
4117
4118In addition, the pairs must be in signed order of the lower bound and
4119they must be non-contiguous.
4120
4121Examples:
4122
4123.. code-block:: llvm
4124
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004125 %a = load i8, i8* %x, align 1, !range !0 ; Can only be 0 or 1
4126 %b = load i8, i8* %y, align 1, !range !1 ; Can only be 255 (-1), 0 or 1
Jingyue Wu37fcb592014-06-19 16:50:16 +00004127 %c = call i8 @foo(), !range !2 ; Can only be 0, 1, 3, 4 or 5
4128 %d = invoke i8 @bar() to label %cont
4129 unwind label %lpad, !range !3 ; Can only be -2, -1, 3, 4 or 5
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004130 ...
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004131 !0 = !{ i8 0, i8 2 }
4132 !1 = !{ i8 255, i8 2 }
4133 !2 = !{ i8 0, i8 2, i8 3, i8 6 }
4134 !3 = !{ i8 -2, i8 0, i8 3, i8 6 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004135
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004136'``llvm.loop``'
4137^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4138
4139It is sometimes useful to attach information to loop constructs. Currently,
4140loop metadata is implemented as metadata attached to the branch instruction
4141in the loop latch block. This type of metadata refer to a metadata node that is
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00004142guaranteed to be separate for each loop. The loop identifier metadata is
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004143specified with the name ``llvm.loop``.
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004144
4145The loop identifier metadata is implemented using a metadata that refers to
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +00004146itself to avoid merging it with any other identifier metadata, e.g.,
4147during module linkage or function inlining. That is, each loop should refer
4148to their own identification metadata even if they reside in separate functions.
4149The following example contains loop identifier metadata for two separate loop
Pekka Jaaskelainen119a2b62013-02-22 12:03:07 +00004150constructs:
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004151
4152.. code-block:: llvm
Paul Redmondeaaed3b2013-02-21 17:20:45 +00004153
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004154 !0 = !{!0}
4155 !1 = !{!1}
Pekka Jaaskelainen119a2b62013-02-22 12:03:07 +00004156
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004157The loop identifier metadata can be used to specify additional
4158per-loop metadata. Any operands after the first operand can be treated
4159as user-defined metadata. For example the ``llvm.loop.unroll.count``
4160suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller:
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004161
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004162.. code-block:: llvm
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004163
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004164 br i1 %exitcond, label %._crit_edge, label %.lr.ph, !llvm.loop !0
4165 ...
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004166 !0 = !{!0, !1}
4167 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004168
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004169'``llvm.loop.vectorize``' and '``llvm.loop.interleave``'
4170^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004171
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004172Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.vectorize`` or ``llvm.loop.interleave`` are
4173used to control per-loop vectorization and interleaving parameters such as
4174vectorization width and interleave count. These metadata should be used in
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004175conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop identification metadata. The
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004176``llvm.loop.vectorize`` and ``llvm.loop.interleave`` metadata are only
4177optimization hints and the optimizer will only interleave and vectorize loops if
4178it believes it is safe to do so. The ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata
4179which contains information about loop-carried memory dependencies can be helpful
4180in determining the safety of these transformations.
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004181
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004182'``llvm.loop.interleave.count``' Metadata
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004183^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4184
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004185This metadata suggests an interleave count to the loop interleaver.
4186The first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` and the
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004187second operand is an integer specifying the interleave count. For
4188example:
4189
4190.. code-block:: llvm
4191
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004192 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.interleave.count", i32 4}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004193
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004194Note that setting ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` to 1 disables interleaving
4195multiple iterations of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` is set to 0
4196then the interleave count will be determined automatically.
4197
4198'``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable``' Metadata
Dan Liew9a1829d2014-07-22 14:59:38 +00004199^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004200
4201This metadata selectively enables or disables vectorization for the loop. The
4202first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable`` and the second operand
4203is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 vectorization is enabled. A value of
42040 disables vectorization:
4205
4206.. code-block:: llvm
4207
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004208 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 0}
4209 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 1}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004210
4211'``llvm.loop.vectorize.width``' Metadata
4212^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4213
4214This metadata sets the target width of the vectorizer. The first
4215operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` and the second
4216operand is an integer specifying the width. For example:
4217
4218.. code-block:: llvm
4219
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004220 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.width", i32 4}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004221
4222Note that setting ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` to 1 disables
4223vectorization of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` is set to
42240 or if the loop does not have this metadata the width will be
4225determined automatically.
4226
4227'``llvm.loop.unroll``'
4228^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4229
4230Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.unroll`` are loop unrolling
4231optimization hints such as the unroll factor. ``llvm.loop.unroll``
4232metadata should be used in conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop
4233identification metadata. The ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata are only
4234optimization hints and the unrolling will only be performed if the
4235optimizer believes it is safe to do so.
4236
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004237'``llvm.loop.unroll.count``' Metadata
4238^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4239
4240This metadata suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller. The
4241first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.count`` and the second
4242operand is a positive integer specifying the unroll factor. For
4243example:
4244
4245.. code-block:: llvm
4246
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004247 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004248
4249If the trip count of the loop is less than the unroll count the loop
4250will be partially unrolled.
4251
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00004252'``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``' Metadata
4253^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4254
Mark Heffernan3e32a4e2015-06-30 22:48:51 +00004255This metadata disables loop unrolling. The metadata has a single operand
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00004256which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``. For example:
4257
4258.. code-block:: llvm
4259
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004260 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.disable"}
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00004261
Kevin Qin715b01e2015-03-09 06:14:18 +00004262'``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``' Metadata
Dan Liew868b0742015-03-11 13:34:49 +00004263^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Kevin Qin715b01e2015-03-09 06:14:18 +00004264
Mark Heffernan3e32a4e2015-06-30 22:48:51 +00004265This metadata disables runtime loop unrolling. The metadata has a single
Kevin Qin715b01e2015-03-09 06:14:18 +00004266operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``. For example:
4267
4268.. code-block:: llvm
4269
4270 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable"}
4271
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00004272'``llvm.loop.unroll.full``' Metadata
4273^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4274
Mark Heffernan3e32a4e2015-06-30 22:48:51 +00004275This metadata suggests that the loop should be unrolled fully. The
4276metadata has a single operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.full``.
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00004277For example:
4278
4279.. code-block:: llvm
4280
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004281 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.full"}
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004282
4283'``llvm.mem``'
4284^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4285
4286Metadata types used to annotate memory accesses with information helpful
4287for optimizations are prefixed with ``llvm.mem``.
4288
4289'``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access``' Metadata
4290^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4291
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00004292The ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata refers to a loop identifier,
4293or metadata containing a list of loop identifiers for nested loops.
4294The metadata is attached to memory accessing instructions and denotes that
4295no loop carried memory dependence exist between it and other instructions denoted
Pekka Jaaskelainen23b222cc2014-05-23 11:35:46 +00004296with the same loop identifier.
4297
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00004298Precisely, given two instructions ``m1`` and ``m2`` that both have the
4299``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata, with ``L1`` and ``L2`` being the
4300set of loops associated with that metadata, respectively, then there is no loop
4301carried dependence between ``m1`` and ``m2`` for loops in both ``L1`` and
Pekka Jaaskelainen23b222cc2014-05-23 11:35:46 +00004302``L2``.
4303
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00004304As a special case, if all memory accessing instructions in a loop have
4305``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata that refers to that loop, then the
4306loop has no loop carried memory dependences and is considered to be a parallel
4307loop.
Pekka Jaaskelainen23b222cc2014-05-23 11:35:46 +00004308
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00004309Note that if not all memory access instructions have such metadata referring to
4310the loop, then the loop is considered not being trivially parallel. Additional
4311memory dependence analysis is required to make that determination. As a fail
4312safe mechanism, this causes loops that were originally parallel to be considered
4313sequential (if optimization passes that are unaware of the parallel semantics
Pekka Jaaskelainen23b222cc2014-05-23 11:35:46 +00004314insert new memory instructions into the loop body).
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004315
4316Example of a loop that is considered parallel due to its correct use of
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004317both ``llvm.loop`` and ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access``
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004318metadata types that refer to the same loop identifier metadata.
4319
4320.. code-block:: llvm
4321
4322 for.body:
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004323 ...
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004324 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004325 ...
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00004326 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004327 ...
4328 br i1 %exitcond, label %for.end, label %for.body, !llvm.loop !0
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004329
4330 for.end:
4331 ...
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004332 !0 = !{!0}
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004333
4334It is also possible to have nested parallel loops. In that case the
4335memory accesses refer to a list of loop identifier metadata nodes instead of
4336the loop identifier metadata node directly:
4337
4338.. code-block:: llvm
4339
4340 outer.for.body:
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00004341 ...
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004342 %val1 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx3, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !2
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00004343 ...
4344 br label %inner.for.body
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004345
4346 inner.for.body:
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004347 ...
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004348 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004349 ...
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00004350 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx2, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004351 ...
4352 br i1 %exitcond, label %inner.for.end, label %inner.for.body, !llvm.loop !1
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004353
4354 inner.for.end:
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004355 ...
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00004356 store i32 %val1, i32* %arrayidx4, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !2
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004357 ...
4358 br i1 %exitcond, label %outer.for.end, label %outer.for.body, !llvm.loop !2
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004359
4360 outer.for.end: ; preds = %for.body
4361 ...
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004362 !0 = !{!1, !2} ; a list of loop identifiers
4363 !1 = !{!1} ; an identifier for the inner loop
4364 !2 = !{!2} ; an identifier for the outer loop
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004365
Peter Collingbournee6909c82015-02-20 20:30:47 +00004366'``llvm.bitsets``'
4367^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4368
4369The ``llvm.bitsets`` global metadata is used to implement
4370:doc:`bitsets <BitSets>`.
4371
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004372Module Flags Metadata
4373=====================
4374
4375Information about the module as a whole is difficult to convey to LLVM's
4376subsystems. The LLVM IR isn't sufficient to transmit this information.
4377The ``llvm.module.flags`` named metadata exists in order to facilitate
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00004378this. These flags are in the form of key / value pairs --- much like a
4379dictionary --- making it easy for any subsystem who cares about a flag to
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004380look it up.
4381
4382The ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata contains a list of metadata triplets.
4383Each triplet has the following form:
4384
4385- The first element is a *behavior* flag, which specifies the behavior
4386 when two (or more) modules are merged together, and it encounters two
4387 (or more) metadata with the same ID. The supported behaviors are
4388 described below.
4389- The second element is a metadata string that is a unique ID for the
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004390 metadata. Each module may only have one flag entry for each unique ID (not
4391 including entries with the **Require** behavior).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004392- The third element is the value of the flag.
4393
4394When two (or more) modules are merged together, the resulting
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004395``llvm.module.flags`` metadata is the union of the modules' flags. That is, for
4396each unique metadata ID string, there will be exactly one entry in the merged
4397modules ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata table, and the value for that entry will
4398be determined by the merge behavior flag, as described below. The only exception
4399is that entries with the *Require* behavior are always preserved.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004400
4401The following behaviors are supported:
4402
4403.. list-table::
4404 :header-rows: 1
4405 :widths: 10 90
4406
4407 * - Value
4408 - Behavior
4409
4410 * - 1
4411 - **Error**
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004412 Emits an error if two values disagree, otherwise the resulting value
4413 is that of the operands.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004414
4415 * - 2
4416 - **Warning**
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004417 Emits a warning if two values disagree. The result value will be the
4418 operand for the flag from the first module being linked.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004419
4420 * - 3
4421 - **Require**
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004422 Adds a requirement that another module flag be present and have a
4423 specified value after linking is performed. The value must be a
4424 metadata pair, where the first element of the pair is the ID of the
4425 module flag to be restricted, and the second element of the pair is
4426 the value the module flag should be restricted to. This behavior can
4427 be used to restrict the allowable results (via triggering of an
4428 error) of linking IDs with the **Override** behavior.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004429
4430 * - 4
4431 - **Override**
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004432 Uses the specified value, regardless of the behavior or value of the
4433 other module. If both modules specify **Override**, but the values
4434 differ, an error will be emitted.
4435
Daniel Dunbard77d9fb2013-01-16 21:38:56 +00004436 * - 5
4437 - **Append**
4438 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata nodes.
4439
4440 * - 6
4441 - **AppendUnique**
4442 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata
4443 nodes. However, duplicate entries in the second list are dropped
4444 during the append operation.
4445
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004446It is an error for a particular unique flag ID to have multiple behaviors,
4447except in the case of **Require** (which adds restrictions on another metadata
4448value) or **Override**.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004449
4450An example of module flags:
4451
4452.. code-block:: llvm
4453
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004454 !0 = !{ i32 1, !"foo", i32 1 }
4455 !1 = !{ i32 4, !"bar", i32 37 }
4456 !2 = !{ i32 2, !"qux", i32 42 }
4457 !3 = !{ i32 3, !"qux",
4458 !{
4459 !"foo", i32 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004460 }
4461 }
4462 !llvm.module.flags = !{ !0, !1, !2, !3 }
4463
4464- Metadata ``!0`` has the ID ``!"foo"`` and the value '1'. The behavior
4465 if two or more ``!"foo"`` flags are seen is to emit an error if their
4466 values are not equal.
4467
4468- Metadata ``!1`` has the ID ``!"bar"`` and the value '37'. The
4469 behavior if two or more ``!"bar"`` flags are seen is to use the value
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004470 '37'.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004471
4472- Metadata ``!2`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value '42'. The
4473 behavior if two or more ``!"qux"`` flags are seen is to emit a
4474 warning if their values are not equal.
4475
4476- Metadata ``!3`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value:
4477
4478 ::
4479
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004480 !{ !"foo", i32 1 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004481
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004482 The behavior is to emit an error if the ``llvm.module.flags`` does not
4483 contain a flag with the ID ``!"foo"`` that has the value '1' after linking is
4484 performed.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004485
4486Objective-C Garbage Collection Module Flags Metadata
4487----------------------------------------------------
4488
4489On the Mach-O platform, Objective-C stores metadata about garbage
4490collection in a special section called "image info". The metadata
4491consists of a version number and a bitmask specifying what types of
4492garbage collection are supported (if any) by the file. If two or more
4493modules are linked together their garbage collection metadata needs to
4494be merged rather than appended together.
4495
4496The Objective-C garbage collection module flags metadata consists of the
4497following key-value pairs:
4498
4499.. list-table::
4500 :header-rows: 1
4501 :widths: 30 70
4502
4503 * - Key
4504 - Value
4505
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00004506 * - ``Objective-C Version``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00004507 - **[Required]** --- The Objective-C ABI version. Valid values are 1 and 2.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004508
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00004509 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Version``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00004510 - **[Required]** --- The version of the image info section. Currently
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004511 always 0.
4512
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00004513 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Section``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00004514 - **[Required]** --- The section to place the metadata. Valid values are
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004515 ``"__OBJC, __image_info, regular"`` for Objective-C ABI version 1, and
4516 ``"__DATA,__objc_imageinfo, regular, no_dead_strip"`` for
4517 Objective-C ABI version 2.
4518
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00004519 * - ``Objective-C Garbage Collection``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00004520 - **[Required]** --- Specifies whether garbage collection is supported or
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004521 not. Valid values are 0, for no garbage collection, and 2, for garbage
4522 collection supported.
4523
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00004524 * - ``Objective-C GC Only``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00004525 - **[Optional]** --- Specifies that only garbage collection is supported.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004526 If present, its value must be 6. This flag requires that the
4527 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag have the value 2.
4528
4529Some important flag interactions:
4530
4531- If a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 is
4532 merged with a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to
4533 2, then the resulting module has the
4534 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag set to 0.
4535- A module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 cannot be
4536 merged with a module with ``Objective-C GC Only`` set to 6.
4537
Daniel Dunbar252bedc2013-01-17 00:16:27 +00004538Automatic Linker Flags Module Flags Metadata
4539--------------------------------------------
4540
4541Some targets support embedding flags to the linker inside individual object
4542files. Typically this is used in conjunction with language extensions which
4543allow source files to explicitly declare the libraries they depend on, and have
4544these automatically be transmitted to the linker via object files.
4545
4546These flags are encoded in the IR using metadata in the module flags section,
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00004547using the ``Linker Options`` key. The merge behavior for this flag is required
Daniel Dunbar252bedc2013-01-17 00:16:27 +00004548to be ``AppendUnique``, and the value for the key is expected to be a metadata
4549node which should be a list of other metadata nodes, each of which should be a
4550list of metadata strings defining linker options.
4551
4552For example, the following metadata section specifies two separate sets of
4553linker options, presumably to link against ``libz`` and the ``Cocoa``
4554framework::
4555
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004556 !0 = !{ i32 6, !"Linker Options",
4557 !{
4558 !{ !"-lz" },
4559 !{ !"-framework", !"Cocoa" } } }
Daniel Dunbar252bedc2013-01-17 00:16:27 +00004560 !llvm.module.flags = !{ !0 }
4561
4562The metadata encoding as lists of lists of options, as opposed to a collapsed
4563list of options, is chosen so that the IR encoding can use multiple option
4564strings to specify e.g., a single library, while still having that specifier be
4565preserved as an atomic element that can be recognized by a target specific
4566assembly writer or object file emitter.
4567
4568Each individual option is required to be either a valid option for the target's
4569linker, or an option that is reserved by the target specific assembly writer or
4570object file emitter. No other aspect of these options is defined by the IR.
4571
Oliver Stannard5dc29342014-06-20 10:08:11 +00004572C type width Module Flags Metadata
4573----------------------------------
4574
4575The ARM backend emits a section into each generated object file describing the
4576options that it was compiled with (in a compiler-independent way) to prevent
4577linking incompatible objects, and to allow automatic library selection. Some
4578of these options are not visible at the IR level, namely wchar_t width and enum
4579width.
4580
4581To pass this information to the backend, these options are encoded in module
4582flags metadata, using the following key-value pairs:
4583
4584.. list-table::
4585 :header-rows: 1
4586 :widths: 30 70
4587
4588 * - Key
4589 - Value
4590
4591 * - short_wchar
4592 - * 0 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 4
4593 * 1 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 2
4594
4595 * - short_enum
4596 - * 0 --- Enums are at least as large as an ``int``.
4597 * 1 --- Enums are stored in the smallest integer type which can
4598 represent all of its values.
4599
4600For example, the following metadata section specifies that the module was
4601compiled with a ``wchar_t`` width of 4 bytes, and the underlying type of an
4602enum is the smallest type which can represent all of its values::
4603
4604 !llvm.module.flags = !{!0, !1}
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004605 !0 = !{i32 1, !"short_wchar", i32 1}
4606 !1 = !{i32 1, !"short_enum", i32 0}
Oliver Stannard5dc29342014-06-20 10:08:11 +00004607
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00004608.. _intrinsicglobalvariables:
4609
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004610Intrinsic Global Variables
4611==========================
4612
4613LLVM has a number of "magic" global variables that contain data that
4614affect code generation or other IR semantics. These are documented here.
4615All globals of this sort should have a section specified as
4616"``llvm.metadata``". This section and all globals that start with
4617"``llvm.``" are reserved for use by LLVM.
4618
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00004619.. _gv_llvmused:
4620
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004621The '``llvm.used``' Global Variable
4622-----------------------------------
4623
Rafael Espindola74f2e462013-04-22 14:58:02 +00004624The ``@llvm.used`` global is an array which has
Paul Redmond219ef812013-05-30 17:24:32 +00004625:ref:`appending linkage <linkage_appending>`. This array contains a list of
Rafael Espindola70a729d2013-06-11 13:18:13 +00004626pointers to named global variables, functions and aliases which may optionally
4627have a pointer cast formed of bitcast or getelementptr. For example, a legal
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004628use of it is:
4629
4630.. code-block:: llvm
4631
4632 @X = global i8 4
4633 @Y = global i32 123
4634
4635 @llvm.used = appending global [2 x i8*] [
4636 i8* @X,
4637 i8* bitcast (i32* @Y to i8*)
4638 ], section "llvm.metadata"
4639
Rafael Espindola74f2e462013-04-22 14:58:02 +00004640If a symbol appears in the ``@llvm.used`` list, then the compiler, assembler,
4641and linker are required to treat the symbol as if there is a reference to the
Rafael Espindola70a729d2013-06-11 13:18:13 +00004642symbol that it cannot see (which is why they have to be named). For example, if
4643a variable has internal linkage and no references other than that from the
4644``@llvm.used`` list, it cannot be deleted. This is commonly used to represent
4645references from inline asms and other things the compiler cannot "see", and
4646corresponds to "``attribute((used))``" in GNU C.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004647
4648On some targets, the code generator must emit a directive to the
4649assembler or object file to prevent the assembler and linker from
4650molesting the symbol.
4651
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00004652.. _gv_llvmcompilerused:
4653
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004654The '``llvm.compiler.used``' Global Variable
4655--------------------------------------------
4656
4657The ``@llvm.compiler.used`` directive is the same as the ``@llvm.used``
4658directive, except that it only prevents the compiler from touching the
4659symbol. On targets that support it, this allows an intelligent linker to
4660optimize references to the symbol without being impeded as it would be
4661by ``@llvm.used``.
4662
4663This is a rare construct that should only be used in rare circumstances,
4664and should not be exposed to source languages.
4665
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00004666.. _gv_llvmglobalctors:
4667
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004668The '``llvm.global_ctors``' Global Variable
4669-------------------------------------------
4670
4671.. code-block:: llvm
4672
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00004673 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
4674 @llvm.global_ctors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @ctor, i8* @data }]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004675
4676The ``@llvm.global_ctors`` array contains a list of constructor
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00004677functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function.
4678The functions referenced by this array will be called in ascending order
4679of priority (i.e. lowest first) when the module is loaded. The order of
4680functions with the same priority is not defined.
4681
4682If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable
4683or function, the initializer function will only run if the associated
4684data from the current module is not discarded.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004685
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00004686.. _llvmglobaldtors:
4687
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004688The '``llvm.global_dtors``' Global Variable
4689-------------------------------------------
4690
4691.. code-block:: llvm
4692
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00004693 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
4694 @llvm.global_dtors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @dtor, i8* @data }]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004695
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00004696The ``@llvm.global_dtors`` array contains a list of destructor
4697functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function.
4698The functions referenced by this array will be called in descending
Reid Klecknerbffbcc52014-05-27 21:35:17 +00004699order of priority (i.e. highest first) when the module is unloaded. The
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00004700order of functions with the same priority is not defined.
4701
4702If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable
4703or function, the destructor function will only run if the associated
4704data from the current module is not discarded.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004705
4706Instruction Reference
4707=====================
4708
4709The LLVM instruction set consists of several different classifications
4710of instructions: :ref:`terminator instructions <terminators>`, :ref:`binary
4711instructions <binaryops>`, :ref:`bitwise binary
4712instructions <bitwiseops>`, :ref:`memory instructions <memoryops>`, and
4713:ref:`other instructions <otherops>`.
4714
4715.. _terminators:
4716
4717Terminator Instructions
4718-----------------------
4719
4720As mentioned :ref:`previously <functionstructure>`, every basic block in a
4721program ends with a "Terminator" instruction, which indicates which
4722block should be executed after the current block is finished. These
4723terminator instructions typically yield a '``void``' value: they produce
4724control flow, not values (the one exception being the
4725':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`' instruction).
4726
4727The terminator instructions are: ':ref:`ret <i_ret>`',
4728':ref:`br <i_br>`', ':ref:`switch <i_switch>`',
4729':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`', ':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`',
David Majnemerae2ffc82015-07-10 07:00:44 +00004730':ref:`resume <i_resume>`', ':ref:`catchblock <i_catchblock>`',
4731':ref:`catchendblock <i_catchendblock>`',
4732':ref:`catchret <i_catchret>`',
4733':ref:`terminateblock <i_terminateblock>`',
4734and ':ref:`unreachable <i_unreachable>`'.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004735
4736.. _i_ret:
4737
4738'``ret``' Instruction
4739^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4740
4741Syntax:
4742"""""""
4743
4744::
4745
4746 ret <type> <value> ; Return a value from a non-void function
4747 ret void ; Return from void function
4748
4749Overview:
4750"""""""""
4751
4752The '``ret``' instruction is used to return control flow (and optionally
4753a value) from a function back to the caller.
4754
4755There are two forms of the '``ret``' instruction: one that returns a
4756value and then causes control flow, and one that just causes control
4757flow to occur.
4758
4759Arguments:
4760""""""""""
4761
4762The '``ret``' instruction optionally accepts a single argument, the
4763return value. The type of the return value must be a ':ref:`first
4764class <t_firstclass>`' type.
4765
4766A function is not :ref:`well formed <wellformed>` if it it has a non-void
4767return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with no return value or
4768a return value with a type that does not match its type, or if it has a
4769void return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with a return
4770value.
4771
4772Semantics:
4773""""""""""
4774
4775When the '``ret``' instruction is executed, control flow returns back to
4776the calling function's context. If the caller is a
4777":ref:`call <i_call>`" instruction, execution continues at the
4778instruction after the call. If the caller was an
4779":ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`" instruction, execution continues at the
4780beginning of the "normal" destination block. If the instruction returns
4781a value, that value shall set the call or invoke instruction's return
4782value.
4783
4784Example:
4785""""""""
4786
4787.. code-block:: llvm
4788
4789 ret i32 5 ; Return an integer value of 5
4790 ret void ; Return from a void function
4791 ret { i32, i8 } { i32 4, i8 2 } ; Return a struct of values 4 and 2
4792
4793.. _i_br:
4794
4795'``br``' Instruction
4796^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4797
4798Syntax:
4799"""""""
4800
4801::
4802
4803 br i1 <cond>, label <iftrue>, label <iffalse>
4804 br label <dest> ; Unconditional branch
4805
4806Overview:
4807"""""""""
4808
4809The '``br``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to a
4810different basic block in the current function. There are two forms of
4811this instruction, corresponding to a conditional branch and an
4812unconditional branch.
4813
4814Arguments:
4815""""""""""
4816
4817The conditional branch form of the '``br``' instruction takes a single
4818'``i1``' value and two '``label``' values. The unconditional form of the
4819'``br``' instruction takes a single '``label``' value as a target.
4820
4821Semantics:
4822""""""""""
4823
4824Upon execution of a conditional '``br``' instruction, the '``i1``'
4825argument is evaluated. If the value is ``true``, control flows to the
4826'``iftrue``' ``label`` argument. If "cond" is ``false``, control flows
4827to the '``iffalse``' ``label`` argument.
4828
4829Example:
4830""""""""
4831
4832.. code-block:: llvm
4833
4834 Test:
4835 %cond = icmp eq i32 %a, %b
4836 br i1 %cond, label %IfEqual, label %IfUnequal
4837 IfEqual:
4838 ret i32 1
4839 IfUnequal:
4840 ret i32 0
4841
4842.. _i_switch:
4843
4844'``switch``' Instruction
4845^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4846
4847Syntax:
4848"""""""
4849
4850::
4851
4852 switch <intty> <value>, label <defaultdest> [ <intty> <val>, label <dest> ... ]
4853
4854Overview:
4855"""""""""
4856
4857The '``switch``' instruction is used to transfer control flow to one of
4858several different places. It is a generalization of the '``br``'
4859instruction, allowing a branch to occur to one of many possible
4860destinations.
4861
4862Arguments:
4863""""""""""
4864
4865The '``switch``' instruction uses three parameters: an integer
4866comparison value '``value``', a default '``label``' destination, and an
4867array of pairs of comparison value constants and '``label``'s. The table
4868is not allowed to contain duplicate constant entries.
4869
4870Semantics:
4871""""""""""
4872
4873The ``switch`` instruction specifies a table of values and destinations.
4874When the '``switch``' instruction is executed, this table is searched
4875for the given value. If the value is found, control flow is transferred
4876to the corresponding destination; otherwise, control flow is transferred
4877to the default destination.
4878
4879Implementation:
4880"""""""""""""""
4881
4882Depending on properties of the target machine and the particular
4883``switch`` instruction, this instruction may be code generated in
4884different ways. For example, it could be generated as a series of
4885chained conditional branches or with a lookup table.
4886
4887Example:
4888""""""""
4889
4890.. code-block:: llvm
4891
4892 ; Emulate a conditional br instruction
4893 %Val = zext i1 %value to i32
4894 switch i32 %Val, label %truedest [ i32 0, label %falsedest ]
4895
4896 ; Emulate an unconditional br instruction
4897 switch i32 0, label %dest [ ]
4898
4899 ; Implement a jump table:
4900 switch i32 %val, label %otherwise [ i32 0, label %onzero
4901 i32 1, label %onone
4902 i32 2, label %ontwo ]
4903
4904.. _i_indirectbr:
4905
4906'``indirectbr``' Instruction
4907^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4908
4909Syntax:
4910"""""""
4911
4912::
4913
4914 indirectbr <somety>* <address>, [ label <dest1>, label <dest2>, ... ]
4915
4916Overview:
4917"""""""""
4918
4919The '``indirectbr``' instruction implements an indirect branch to a
4920label within the current function, whose address is specified by
4921"``address``". Address must be derived from a
4922:ref:`blockaddress <blockaddress>` constant.
4923
4924Arguments:
4925""""""""""
4926
4927The '``address``' argument is the address of the label to jump to. The
4928rest of the arguments indicate the full set of possible destinations
4929that the address may point to. Blocks are allowed to occur multiple
4930times in the destination list, though this isn't particularly useful.
4931
4932This destination list is required so that dataflow analysis has an
4933accurate understanding of the CFG.
4934
4935Semantics:
4936""""""""""
4937
4938Control transfers to the block specified in the address argument. All
4939possible destination blocks must be listed in the label list, otherwise
4940this instruction has undefined behavior. This implies that jumps to
4941labels defined in other functions have undefined behavior as well.
4942
4943Implementation:
4944"""""""""""""""
4945
4946This is typically implemented with a jump through a register.
4947
4948Example:
4949""""""""
4950
4951.. code-block:: llvm
4952
4953 indirectbr i8* %Addr, [ label %bb1, label %bb2, label %bb3 ]
4954
4955.. _i_invoke:
4956
4957'``invoke``' Instruction
4958^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4959
4960Syntax:
4961"""""""
4962
4963::
4964
4965 <result> = invoke [cconv] [ret attrs] <ptr to function ty> <function ptr val>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
4966 to label <normal label> unwind label <exception label>
4967
4968Overview:
4969"""""""""
4970
4971The '``invoke``' instruction causes control to transfer to a specified
4972function, with the possibility of control flow transfer to either the
4973'``normal``' label or the '``exception``' label. If the callee function
4974returns with the "``ret``" instruction, control flow will return to the
4975"normal" label. If the callee (or any indirect callees) returns via the
4976":ref:`resume <i_resume>`" instruction or other exception handling
4977mechanism, control is interrupted and continued at the dynamically
4978nearest "exception" label.
4979
4980The '``exception``' label is a `landing
4981pad <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ for the exception. As such,
4982'``exception``' label is required to have the
4983":ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>`" instruction, which contains the
4984information about the behavior of the program after unwinding happens,
4985as its first non-PHI instruction. The restrictions on the
4986"``landingpad``" instruction's tightly couples it to the "``invoke``"
4987instruction, so that the important information contained within the
4988"``landingpad``" instruction can't be lost through normal code motion.
4989
4990Arguments:
4991""""""""""
4992
4993This instruction requires several arguments:
4994
4995#. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
4996 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
4997 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions.
4998#. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
4999 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
5000 are valid here.
5001#. '``ptr to function ty``': shall be the signature of the pointer to
5002 function value being invoked. In most cases, this is a direct
5003 function invocation, but indirect ``invoke``'s are just as possible,
5004 branching off an arbitrary pointer to function value.
5005#. '``function ptr val``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a
5006 function to be invoked.
5007#. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
5008 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
5009 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
5010 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
5011 extra arguments can be specified.
5012#. '``normal label``': the label reached when the called function
5013 executes a '``ret``' instruction.
5014#. '``exception label``': the label reached when a callee returns via
5015 the :ref:`resume <i_resume>` instruction or other exception handling
5016 mechanism.
5017#. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list. Only
5018 '``noreturn``', '``nounwind``', '``readonly``' and '``readnone``'
5019 attributes are valid here.
5020
5021Semantics:
5022""""""""""
5023
5024This instruction is designed to operate as a standard '``call``'
5025instruction in most regards. The primary difference is that it
5026establishes an association with a label, which is used by the runtime
5027library to unwind the stack.
5028
5029This instruction is used in languages with destructors to ensure that
5030proper cleanup is performed in the case of either a ``longjmp`` or a
5031thrown exception. Additionally, this is important for implementation of
5032'``catch``' clauses in high-level languages that support them.
5033
5034For the purposes of the SSA form, the definition of the value returned
5035by the '``invoke``' instruction is deemed to occur on the edge from the
5036current block to the "normal" label. If the callee unwinds then no
5037return value is available.
5038
5039Example:
5040""""""""
5041
5042.. code-block:: llvm
5043
5044 %retval = invoke i32 @Test(i32 15) to label %Continue
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005045 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005046 %retval = invoke coldcc i32 %Testfnptr(i32 15) to label %Continue
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005047 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005048
5049.. _i_resume:
5050
5051'``resume``' Instruction
5052^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5053
5054Syntax:
5055"""""""
5056
5057::
5058
5059 resume <type> <value>
5060
5061Overview:
5062"""""""""
5063
5064The '``resume``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has no
5065successors.
5066
5067Arguments:
5068""""""""""
5069
5070The '``resume``' instruction requires one argument, which must have the
5071same type as the result of any '``landingpad``' instruction in the same
5072function.
5073
5074Semantics:
5075""""""""""
5076
5077The '``resume``' instruction resumes propagation of an existing
5078(in-flight) exception whose unwinding was interrupted with a
5079:ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction.
5080
5081Example:
5082""""""""
5083
5084.. code-block:: llvm
5085
5086 resume { i8*, i32 } %exn
5087
David Majnemerae2ffc82015-07-10 07:00:44 +00005088.. _i_catchblock:
5089
5090'``catchblock``' Instruction
5091^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5092
5093Syntax:
5094"""""""
5095
5096::
5097
5098 <resultval> = catchblock <resultty> [<args>*]
5099 to label <normal label> unwind label <exception label>
5100
5101Overview:
5102"""""""""
5103
5104The '``catchblock``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
5105system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
5106is a catch block --- one where a personality routine attempts to transfer
5107control to catch an exception.
5108The ``args`` correspond to whatever information the personality
5109routine requires to know if this is an appropriate place to catch the
5110exception. Control is tranfered to the ``exception`` label if the
5111``catchblock`` is not an appropriate handler for the in-flight exception.
5112The ``normal`` label should contain the code found in the ``catch``
5113portion of a ``try``/``catch`` sequence. It defines values supplied by
5114the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon re-entry to the
5115function. The ``resultval`` has the type ``resultty``.
5116
5117Arguments:
5118""""""""""
5119
5120The instruction takes a list of arbitrary values which are interpreted
5121by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>`.
5122
5123The ``catchblock`` must be provided a ``normal`` label to transfer control
5124to if the ``catchblock`` matches the exception and an ``exception``
5125label to transfer control to if it doesn't.
5126
5127Semantics:
5128""""""""""
5129
5130The '``catchblock``' instruction defines the values which are set by the
5131:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon re-entry to the function, and
5132therefore the "result type" of the ``catchblock`` instruction. As with
5133calling conventions, how the personality function results are
5134represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
5135
5136When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
5137the exception is compared against the ``args``. If it doesn't match,
5138then control is transfered to the ``exception`` basic block.
5139
5140The ``catchblock`` instruction has several restrictions:
5141
5142- A catch block is a basic block which is the unwind destination of
5143 an exceptional instruction.
5144- A catch block must have a '``catchblock``' instruction as its
5145 first non-PHI instruction.
5146- There can be only one '``catchblock``' instruction within the
5147 catch block.
5148- A basic block that is not a catch block may not include a
5149 '``catchblock``' instruction.
5150
5151Example:
5152""""""""
5153
5154.. code-block:: llvm
5155
5156 ;; A catch block which can catch an integer.
5157 %res = catchblock { i8*, i32 } [i8** @_ZTIi]
5158 to label %int.handler unwind label %terminate
5159
5160.. _i_catchendblock:
5161
5162'``catchendblock``' Instruction
5163^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5164
5165Syntax:
5166"""""""
5167
5168::
5169
5170 catchendblock unwind label <nextaction>
5171 catchendblock unwind to caller
5172
5173Overview:
5174"""""""""
5175
5176The '``catchendblock``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
5177system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to communicate to the
5178:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` which invokes are associated
5179with a chain of :ref:`catchblock <i_catchblock>` instructions.
5180
5181The ``nextaction`` label indicates where control should transfer to if
5182none of the ``catchblock`` instructions are suitable for catching the
5183in-flight exception.
5184
5185If a ``nextaction`` label is not present, the instruction unwinds out of
5186the function it is located in. The
5187:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` will look for an appropriate
5188catch block in the caller.
5189
5190Arguments:
5191""""""""""
5192
5193The instruction optionally takes a label, ``nextaction``, indicating
5194where control should transfer to if none of the constituent
5195``catchblock`` instructions are suitable for the in-flight exception.
5196
5197Semantics:
5198""""""""""
5199
5200When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown
5201and none of the constituent ``catchblock`` instructions match, then
5202control is transfered to ``nextaction`` if it is present. If it is not
5203present, control is transfered to the caller.
5204
5205The ``catchendblock`` instruction has several restrictions:
5206
5207- A catch-end block is a basic block which is the unwind destination of
5208 an exceptional instruction.
5209- A catch-end block must have a '``catchendblock``' instruction as its
5210 first non-PHI instruction.
5211- There can be only one '``catchendblock``' instruction within the
5212 catch block.
5213- A basic block that is not a catch-end block may not include a
5214 '``catchendblock``' instruction.
5215
5216Example:
5217""""""""
5218
5219.. code-block:: llvm
5220
5221 catchendblock unwind label %terminate
5222 catchendblock unwind to caller
5223
5224.. _i_catchret:
5225
5226'``catchret``' Instruction
5227^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5228
5229Syntax:
5230"""""""
5231
5232::
5233
5234 catchret label <normal>
5235
5236Overview:
5237"""""""""
5238
5239The '``catchret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has a
5240single successor.
5241
5242
5243Arguments:
5244""""""""""
5245
5246The '``catchret``' instruction requires one argument which specifies
5247where control will transfer to next.
5248
5249Semantics:
5250""""""""""
5251
5252The '``catchret``' instruction ends the existing (in-flight) exception
5253whose unwinding was interrupted with a
5254:ref:`catchblock <i_catchblock>` instruction and transfer control to
5255``normal``.
5256
5257Example:
5258""""""""
5259
5260.. code-block:: llvm
5261
5262 catchret unwind label %continue
5263
5264.. _i_cleanupret:
5265
5266'``cleanupret``' Instruction
5267^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5268
5269Syntax:
5270"""""""
5271
5272::
5273
5274 cleanupret <type> <value> unwind label <continue>
5275 cleanupret <type> <value> unwind to caller
5276
5277Overview:
5278"""""""""
5279
5280The '``cleanupret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has
5281an optional successor.
5282
5283
5284Arguments:
5285""""""""""
5286
5287The '``cleanupret``' instruction requires one argument, which must have the
5288same type as the result of any '``cleanupblock``' instruction in the same
5289function. It also has an optional successor, ``continue``.
5290
5291Semantics:
5292""""""""""
5293
5294The '``cleanupret``' instruction indicates to the
5295:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` that the
5296:ref:`cleanupblock <i_cleanupblock>` it transfered control to has ended.
5297It transfers control to ``continue`` or unwinds out of the function.
5298
5299Example:
5300""""""""
5301
5302.. code-block:: llvm
5303
5304 cleanupret { i8*, i32 } %exn unwind label %continue
5305
5306.. _i_terminateblock:
5307
5308'``terminateblock``' Instruction
5309^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5310
5311Syntax:
5312"""""""
5313
5314::
5315
5316 terminateblock [<args>*] unwind label <exception label>
5317
5318Overview:
5319"""""""""
5320
5321The '``terminateblock``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
5322system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
5323is a terminate block --- one where a personality routine attempts to transfer
5324control to terminate the program.
5325The ``args`` correspond to whatever information the personality
5326routine requires to know if this is an appropriate place to terminate the
5327program. Control is tranfered to the ``exception`` label if the
5328``terminateblock`` is an appropriate handler for the in-flight exception.
5329If the ``terminateblock`` is not an appropriate handler, execution of
5330the program is terminated via
5331:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` specific means.
5332
5333Arguments:
5334""""""""""
5335
5336The instruction takes a list of arbitrary values which are interpreted
5337by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>`.
5338
5339The ``terminateblock`` must be provided an ``exception`` label to
5340transfer control to if the in-flight exception matches the ``args``.
5341
5342Semantics:
5343""""""""""
5344
5345When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
5346the exception is compared against the ``args``. If it matches,
5347then control is transfered to the ``exception`` basic block. Otherwise,
5348the program is terminated via personality-specific means. Typically,
5349the first argument to ``terminateblock`` specifies what function the
5350personality should defer to in order to terminate the program.
5351
5352The ``terminateblock`` instruction has several restrictions:
5353
5354- A terminate block is a basic block which is the unwind destination of
5355 an exceptional instruction.
5356- A terminate block must have a '``terminateblock``' instruction as its
5357 first non-PHI instruction.
5358- There can be only one '``terminateblock``' instruction within the
5359 terminate block.
5360- A basic block that is not a terminate block may not include a
5361 '``terminateblock``' instruction.
5362
5363Example:
5364""""""""
5365
5366.. code-block:: llvm
5367
5368 ;; A terminate block which only permits integers.
5369 terminateblock [i8** @_ZTIi] unwind label %continue
5370
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005371.. _i_unreachable:
5372
5373'``unreachable``' Instruction
5374^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5375
5376Syntax:
5377"""""""
5378
5379::
5380
5381 unreachable
5382
5383Overview:
5384"""""""""
5385
5386The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics. This
5387instruction is used to inform the optimizer that a particular portion of
5388the code is not reachable. This can be used to indicate that the code
5389after a no-return function cannot be reached, and other facts.
5390
5391Semantics:
5392""""""""""
5393
5394The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics.
5395
5396.. _binaryops:
5397
5398Binary Operations
5399-----------------
5400
5401Binary operators are used to do most of the computation in a program.
5402They require two operands of the same type, execute an operation on
5403them, and produce a single value. The operands might represent multiple
5404data, as is the case with the :ref:`vector <t_vector>` data type. The
5405result value has the same type as its operands.
5406
5407There are several different binary operators:
5408
5409.. _i_add:
5410
5411'``add``' Instruction
5412^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5413
5414Syntax:
5415"""""""
5416
5417::
5418
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005419 <result> = add <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5420 <result> = add nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5421 <result> = add nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5422 <result> = add nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005423
5424Overview:
5425"""""""""
5426
5427The '``add``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
5428
5429Arguments:
5430""""""""""
5431
5432The two arguments to the '``add``' instruction must be
5433:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
5434arguments must have identical types.
5435
5436Semantics:
5437""""""""""
5438
5439The value produced is the integer sum of the two operands.
5440
5441If the sum has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
5442mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
5443the result.
5444
5445Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
5446instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
5447
5448``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
5449respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
5450result value of the ``add`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
5451unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
5452
5453Example:
5454""""""""
5455
5456.. code-block:: llvm
5457
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005458 <result> = add i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 + %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005459
5460.. _i_fadd:
5461
5462'``fadd``' Instruction
5463^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5464
5465Syntax:
5466"""""""
5467
5468::
5469
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005470 <result> = fadd [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005471
5472Overview:
5473"""""""""
5474
5475The '``fadd``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
5476
5477Arguments:
5478""""""""""
5479
5480The two arguments to the '``fadd``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
5481point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
5482Both arguments must have identical types.
5483
5484Semantics:
5485""""""""""
5486
5487The value produced is the floating point sum of the two operands. This
5488instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`,
5489which are optimization hints to enable otherwise unsafe floating point
5490optimizations:
5491
5492Example:
5493""""""""
5494
5495.. code-block:: llvm
5496
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005497 <result> = fadd float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 + %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005498
5499'``sub``' Instruction
5500^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5501
5502Syntax:
5503"""""""
5504
5505::
5506
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005507 <result> = sub <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5508 <result> = sub nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5509 <result> = sub nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5510 <result> = sub nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005511
5512Overview:
5513"""""""""
5514
5515The '``sub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
5516
5517Note that the '``sub``' instruction is used to represent the '``neg``'
5518instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
5519
5520Arguments:
5521""""""""""
5522
5523The two arguments to the '``sub``' instruction must be
5524:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
5525arguments must have identical types.
5526
5527Semantics:
5528""""""""""
5529
5530The value produced is the integer difference of the two operands.
5531
5532If the difference has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
5533mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
5534the result.
5535
5536Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
5537instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
5538
5539``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
5540respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
5541result value of the ``sub`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
5542unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
5543
5544Example:
5545""""""""
5546
5547.. code-block:: llvm
5548
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005549 <result> = sub i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 - %var
5550 <result> = sub i32 0, %val ; yields i32:result = -%var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005551
5552.. _i_fsub:
5553
5554'``fsub``' Instruction
5555^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5556
5557Syntax:
5558"""""""
5559
5560::
5561
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005562 <result> = fsub [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005563
5564Overview:
5565"""""""""
5566
5567The '``fsub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
5568
5569Note that the '``fsub``' instruction is used to represent the '``fneg``'
5570instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
5571
5572Arguments:
5573""""""""""
5574
5575The two arguments to the '``fsub``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
5576point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
5577Both arguments must have identical types.
5578
5579Semantics:
5580""""""""""
5581
5582The value produced is the floating point difference of the two operands.
5583This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
5584flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
5585unsafe floating point optimizations:
5586
5587Example:
5588""""""""
5589
5590.. code-block:: llvm
5591
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005592 <result> = fsub float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 - %var
5593 <result> = fsub float -0.0, %val ; yields float:result = -%var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005594
5595'``mul``' Instruction
5596^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5597
5598Syntax:
5599"""""""
5600
5601::
5602
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005603 <result> = mul <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5604 <result> = mul nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5605 <result> = mul nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5606 <result> = mul nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005607
5608Overview:
5609"""""""""
5610
5611The '``mul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
5612
5613Arguments:
5614""""""""""
5615
5616The two arguments to the '``mul``' instruction must be
5617:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
5618arguments must have identical types.
5619
5620Semantics:
5621""""""""""
5622
5623The value produced is the integer product of the two operands.
5624
5625If the result of the multiplication has unsigned overflow, the result
5626returned is the mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the
5627bit width of the result.
5628
5629Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, and the
5630result is the same width as the operands, this instruction returns the
5631correct result for both signed and unsigned integers. If a full product
5632(e.g. ``i32`` * ``i32`` -> ``i64``) is needed, the operands should be
5633sign-extended or zero-extended as appropriate to the width of the full
5634product.
5635
5636``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
5637respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
5638result value of the ``mul`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
5639unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
5640
5641Example:
5642""""""""
5643
5644.. code-block:: llvm
5645
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005646 <result> = mul i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 * %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005647
5648.. _i_fmul:
5649
5650'``fmul``' Instruction
5651^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5652
5653Syntax:
5654"""""""
5655
5656::
5657
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005658 <result> = fmul [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005659
5660Overview:
5661"""""""""
5662
5663The '``fmul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
5664
5665Arguments:
5666""""""""""
5667
5668The two arguments to the '``fmul``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
5669point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
5670Both arguments must have identical types.
5671
5672Semantics:
5673""""""""""
5674
5675The value produced is the floating point product of the two operands.
5676This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
5677flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
5678unsafe floating point optimizations:
5679
5680Example:
5681""""""""
5682
5683.. code-block:: llvm
5684
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005685 <result> = fmul float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 * %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005686
5687'``udiv``' Instruction
5688^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5689
5690Syntax:
5691"""""""
5692
5693::
5694
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005695 <result> = udiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5696 <result> = udiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005697
5698Overview:
5699"""""""""
5700
5701The '``udiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
5702
5703Arguments:
5704""""""""""
5705
5706The two arguments to the '``udiv``' instruction must be
5707:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
5708arguments must have identical types.
5709
5710Semantics:
5711""""""""""
5712
5713The value produced is the unsigned integer quotient of the two operands.
5714
5715Note that unsigned integer division and signed integer division are
5716distinct operations; for signed integer division, use '``sdiv``'.
5717
5718Division by zero leads to undefined behavior.
5719
5720If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``udiv`` is
5721a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if %op1 is not a multiple of %op2 (as
5722such, "((a udiv exact b) mul b) == a").
5723
5724Example:
5725""""""""
5726
5727.. code-block:: llvm
5728
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005729 <result> = udiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005730
5731'``sdiv``' Instruction
5732^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5733
5734Syntax:
5735"""""""
5736
5737::
5738
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005739 <result> = sdiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5740 <result> = sdiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005741
5742Overview:
5743"""""""""
5744
5745The '``sdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
5746
5747Arguments:
5748""""""""""
5749
5750The two arguments to the '``sdiv``' instruction must be
5751:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
5752arguments must have identical types.
5753
5754Semantics:
5755""""""""""
5756
5757The value produced is the signed integer quotient of the two operands
5758rounded towards zero.
5759
5760Note that signed integer division and unsigned integer division are
5761distinct operations; for unsigned integer division, use '``udiv``'.
5762
5763Division by zero leads to undefined behavior. Overflow also leads to
5764undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can occur, for example, by
5765doing a 32-bit division of -2147483648 by -1.
5766
5767If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``sdiv`` is
5768a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the result would be rounded.
5769
5770Example:
5771""""""""
5772
5773.. code-block:: llvm
5774
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005775 <result> = sdiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005776
5777.. _i_fdiv:
5778
5779'``fdiv``' Instruction
5780^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5781
5782Syntax:
5783"""""""
5784
5785::
5786
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005787 <result> = fdiv [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005788
5789Overview:
5790"""""""""
5791
5792The '``fdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
5793
5794Arguments:
5795""""""""""
5796
5797The two arguments to the '``fdiv``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
5798point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
5799Both arguments must have identical types.
5800
5801Semantics:
5802""""""""""
5803
5804The value produced is the floating point quotient of the two operands.
5805This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
5806flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
5807unsafe floating point optimizations:
5808
5809Example:
5810""""""""
5811
5812.. code-block:: llvm
5813
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005814 <result> = fdiv float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 / %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005815
5816'``urem``' Instruction
5817^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5818
5819Syntax:
5820"""""""
5821
5822::
5823
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005824 <result> = urem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005825
5826Overview:
5827"""""""""
5828
5829The '``urem``' instruction returns the remainder from the unsigned
5830division of its two arguments.
5831
5832Arguments:
5833""""""""""
5834
5835The two arguments to the '``urem``' instruction must be
5836:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
5837arguments must have identical types.
5838
5839Semantics:
5840""""""""""
5841
5842This instruction returns the unsigned integer *remainder* of a division.
5843This instruction always performs an unsigned division to get the
5844remainder.
5845
5846Note that unsigned integer remainder and signed integer remainder are
5847distinct operations; for signed integer remainder, use '``srem``'.
5848
5849Taking the remainder of a division by zero leads to undefined behavior.
5850
5851Example:
5852""""""""
5853
5854.. code-block:: llvm
5855
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005856 <result> = urem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005857
5858'``srem``' Instruction
5859^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5860
5861Syntax:
5862"""""""
5863
5864::
5865
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005866 <result> = srem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005867
5868Overview:
5869"""""""""
5870
5871The '``srem``' instruction returns the remainder from the signed
5872division of its two operands. This instruction can also take
5873:ref:`vector <t_vector>` versions of the values in which case the elements
5874must be integers.
5875
5876Arguments:
5877""""""""""
5878
5879The two arguments to the '``srem``' instruction must be
5880:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
5881arguments must have identical types.
5882
5883Semantics:
5884""""""""""
5885
5886This instruction returns the *remainder* of a division (where the result
5887is either zero or has the same sign as the dividend, ``op1``), not the
5888*modulo* operator (where the result is either zero or has the same sign
5889as the divisor, ``op2``) of a value. For more information about the
5890difference, see `The Math
5891Forum <http://mathforum.org/dr.math/problems/anne.4.28.99.html>`_. For a
5892table of how this is implemented in various languages, please see
5893`Wikipedia: modulo
5894operation <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Modulo_operation>`_.
5895
5896Note that signed integer remainder and unsigned integer remainder are
5897distinct operations; for unsigned integer remainder, use '``urem``'.
5898
5899Taking the remainder of a division by zero leads to undefined behavior.
5900Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can
5901occur, for example, by taking the remainder of a 32-bit division of
5902-2147483648 by -1. (The remainder doesn't actually overflow, but this
5903rule lets srem be implemented using instructions that return both the
5904result of the division and the remainder.)
5905
5906Example:
5907""""""""
5908
5909.. code-block:: llvm
5910
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005911 <result> = srem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005912
5913.. _i_frem:
5914
5915'``frem``' Instruction
5916^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5917
5918Syntax:
5919"""""""
5920
5921::
5922
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005923 <result> = frem [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005924
5925Overview:
5926"""""""""
5927
5928The '``frem``' instruction returns the remainder from the division of
5929its two operands.
5930
5931Arguments:
5932""""""""""
5933
5934The two arguments to the '``frem``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
5935point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
5936Both arguments must have identical types.
5937
5938Semantics:
5939""""""""""
5940
5941This instruction returns the *remainder* of a division. The remainder
5942has the same sign as the dividend. This instruction can also take any
5943number of :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints
5944to enable otherwise unsafe floating point optimizations:
5945
5946Example:
5947""""""""
5948
5949.. code-block:: llvm
5950
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005951 <result> = frem float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 % %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005952
5953.. _bitwiseops:
5954
5955Bitwise Binary Operations
5956-------------------------
5957
5958Bitwise binary operators are used to do various forms of bit-twiddling
5959in a program. They are generally very efficient instructions and can
5960commonly be strength reduced from other instructions. They require two
5961operands of the same type, execute an operation on them, and produce a
5962single value. The resulting value is the same type as its operands.
5963
5964'``shl``' Instruction
5965^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5966
5967Syntax:
5968"""""""
5969
5970::
5971
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005972 <result> = shl <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5973 <result> = shl nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5974 <result> = shl nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5975 <result> = shl nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005976
5977Overview:
5978"""""""""
5979
5980The '``shl``' instruction returns the first operand shifted to the left
5981a specified number of bits.
5982
5983Arguments:
5984""""""""""
5985
5986Both arguments to the '``shl``' instruction must be the same
5987:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
5988'``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
5989
5990Semantics:
5991""""""""""
5992
5993The value produced is ``op1`` \* 2\ :sup:`op2` mod 2\ :sup:`n`,
5994where ``n`` is the width of the result. If ``op2`` is (statically or
Sean Silvab8a108c2015-04-17 21:58:55 +00005995dynamically) equal to or larger than the number of bits in
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005996``op1``, the result is undefined. If the arguments are vectors, each
5997vector element of ``op1`` is shifted by the corresponding shift amount
5998in ``op2``.
5999
6000If the ``nuw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a :ref:`poison
6001value <poisonvalues>` if it shifts out any non-zero bits. If the
6002``nsw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a :ref:`poison
6003value <poisonvalues>` if it shifts out any bits that disagree with the
6004resultant sign bit. As such, NUW/NSW have the same semantics as they
6005would if the shift were expressed as a mul instruction with the same
6006nsw/nuw bits in (mul %op1, (shl 1, %op2)).
6007
6008Example:
6009""""""""
6010
6011.. code-block:: llvm
6012
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006013 <result> = shl i32 4, %var ; yields i32: 4 << %var
6014 <result> = shl i32 4, 2 ; yields i32: 16
6015 <result> = shl i32 1, 10 ; yields i32: 1024
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006016 <result> = shl i32 1, 32 ; undefined
6017 <result> = shl <2 x i32> < i32 1, i32 1>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 2, i32 4>
6018
6019'``lshr``' Instruction
6020^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6021
6022Syntax:
6023"""""""
6024
6025::
6026
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006027 <result> = lshr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6028 <result> = lshr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006029
6030Overview:
6031"""""""""
6032
6033The '``lshr``' instruction (logical shift right) returns the first
6034operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with zero fill.
6035
6036Arguments:
6037""""""""""
6038
6039Both arguments to the '``lshr``' instruction must be the same
6040:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
6041'``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
6042
6043Semantics:
6044""""""""""
6045
6046This instruction always performs a logical shift right operation. The
6047most significant bits of the result will be filled with zero bits after
6048the shift. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
6049than the number of bits in ``op1``, the result is undefined. If the
6050arguments are vectors, each vector element of ``op1`` is shifted by the
6051corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
6052
6053If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``lshr`` is
6054a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if any of the bits shifted out are
6055non-zero.
6056
6057Example:
6058""""""""
6059
6060.. code-block:: llvm
6061
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006062 <result> = lshr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
6063 <result> = lshr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
6064 <result> = lshr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
6065 <result> = lshr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = 0x7F
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006066 <result> = lshr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
6067 <result> = lshr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 0x7FFFFFFF, i32 1>
6068
6069'``ashr``' Instruction
6070^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6071
6072Syntax:
6073"""""""
6074
6075::
6076
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006077 <result> = ashr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6078 <result> = ashr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006079
6080Overview:
6081"""""""""
6082
6083The '``ashr``' instruction (arithmetic shift right) returns the first
6084operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with sign
6085extension.
6086
6087Arguments:
6088""""""""""
6089
6090Both arguments to the '``ashr``' instruction must be the same
6091:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
6092'``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
6093
6094Semantics:
6095""""""""""
6096
6097This instruction always performs an arithmetic shift right operation,
6098The most significant bits of the result will be filled with the sign bit
6099of ``op1``. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
6100than the number of bits in ``op1``, the result is undefined. If the
6101arguments are vectors, each vector element of ``op1`` is shifted by the
6102corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
6103
6104If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``ashr`` is
6105a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if any of the bits shifted out are
6106non-zero.
6107
6108Example:
6109""""""""
6110
6111.. code-block:: llvm
6112
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006113 <result> = ashr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
6114 <result> = ashr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
6115 <result> = ashr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
6116 <result> = ashr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = -1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006117 <result> = ashr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
6118 <result> = ashr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 3> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 -1, i32 0>
6119
6120'``and``' Instruction
6121^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6122
6123Syntax:
6124"""""""
6125
6126::
6127
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006128 <result> = and <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006129
6130Overview:
6131"""""""""
6132
6133The '``and``' instruction returns the bitwise logical and of its two
6134operands.
6135
6136Arguments:
6137""""""""""
6138
6139The two arguments to the '``and``' instruction must be
6140:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6141arguments must have identical types.
6142
6143Semantics:
6144""""""""""
6145
6146The truth table used for the '``and``' instruction is:
6147
6148+-----+-----+-----+
6149| In0 | In1 | Out |
6150+-----+-----+-----+
6151| 0 | 0 | 0 |
6152+-----+-----+-----+
6153| 0 | 1 | 0 |
6154+-----+-----+-----+
6155| 1 | 0 | 0 |
6156+-----+-----+-----+
6157| 1 | 1 | 1 |
6158+-----+-----+-----+
6159
6160Example:
6161""""""""
6162
6163.. code-block:: llvm
6164
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006165 <result> = and i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 & %var
6166 <result> = and i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 8
6167 <result> = and i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006168
6169'``or``' Instruction
6170^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6171
6172Syntax:
6173"""""""
6174
6175::
6176
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006177 <result> = or <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006178
6179Overview:
6180"""""""""
6181
6182The '``or``' instruction returns the bitwise logical inclusive or of its
6183two operands.
6184
6185Arguments:
6186""""""""""
6187
6188The two arguments to the '``or``' instruction must be
6189:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6190arguments must have identical types.
6191
6192Semantics:
6193""""""""""
6194
6195The truth table used for the '``or``' instruction is:
6196
6197+-----+-----+-----+
6198| In0 | In1 | Out |
6199+-----+-----+-----+
6200| 0 | 0 | 0 |
6201+-----+-----+-----+
6202| 0 | 1 | 1 |
6203+-----+-----+-----+
6204| 1 | 0 | 1 |
6205+-----+-----+-----+
6206| 1 | 1 | 1 |
6207+-----+-----+-----+
6208
6209Example:
6210""""""""
6211
6212::
6213
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006214 <result> = or i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 | %var
6215 <result> = or i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 47
6216 <result> = or i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006217
6218'``xor``' Instruction
6219^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6220
6221Syntax:
6222"""""""
6223
6224::
6225
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006226 <result> = xor <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006227
6228Overview:
6229"""""""""
6230
6231The '``xor``' instruction returns the bitwise logical exclusive or of
6232its two operands. The ``xor`` is used to implement the "one's
6233complement" operation, which is the "~" operator in C.
6234
6235Arguments:
6236""""""""""
6237
6238The two arguments to the '``xor``' instruction must be
6239:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6240arguments must have identical types.
6241
6242Semantics:
6243""""""""""
6244
6245The truth table used for the '``xor``' instruction is:
6246
6247+-----+-----+-----+
6248| In0 | In1 | Out |
6249+-----+-----+-----+
6250| 0 | 0 | 0 |
6251+-----+-----+-----+
6252| 0 | 1 | 1 |
6253+-----+-----+-----+
6254| 1 | 0 | 1 |
6255+-----+-----+-----+
6256| 1 | 1 | 0 |
6257+-----+-----+-----+
6258
6259Example:
6260""""""""
6261
6262.. code-block:: llvm
6263
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006264 <result> = xor i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 ^ %var
6265 <result> = xor i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 39
6266 <result> = xor i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12
6267 <result> = xor i32 %V, -1 ; yields i32:result = ~%V
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006268
6269Vector Operations
6270-----------------
6271
6272LLVM supports several instructions to represent vector operations in a
6273target-independent manner. These instructions cover the element-access
6274and vector-specific operations needed to process vectors effectively.
6275While LLVM does directly support these vector operations, many
6276sophisticated algorithms will want to use target-specific intrinsics to
6277take full advantage of a specific target.
6278
6279.. _i_extractelement:
6280
6281'``extractelement``' Instruction
6282^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6283
6284Syntax:
6285"""""""
6286
6287::
6288
Michael J. Spencer1f10c5ea2014-05-01 22:12:39 +00006289 <result> = extractelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <ty>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006290
6291Overview:
6292"""""""""
6293
6294The '``extractelement``' instruction extracts a single scalar element
6295from a vector at a specified index.
6296
6297Arguments:
6298""""""""""
6299
6300The first operand of an '``extractelement``' instruction is a value of
6301:ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is an index indicating
6302the position from which to extract the element. The index may be a
Michael J. Spencer1f10c5ea2014-05-01 22:12:39 +00006303variable of any integer type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006304
6305Semantics:
6306""""""""""
6307
6308The result is a scalar of the same type as the element type of ``val``.
6309Its value is the value at position ``idx`` of ``val``. If ``idx``
6310exceeds the length of ``val``, the results are undefined.
6311
6312Example:
6313""""""""
6314
6315.. code-block:: llvm
6316
6317 <result> = extractelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 0 ; yields i32
6318
6319.. _i_insertelement:
6320
6321'``insertelement``' Instruction
6322^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6323
6324Syntax:
6325"""""""
6326
6327::
6328
Michael J. Spencer1f10c5ea2014-05-01 22:12:39 +00006329 <result> = insertelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <n x <ty>>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006330
6331Overview:
6332"""""""""
6333
6334The '``insertelement``' instruction inserts a scalar element into a
6335vector at a specified index.
6336
6337Arguments:
6338""""""""""
6339
6340The first operand of an '``insertelement``' instruction is a value of
6341:ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is a scalar value whose
6342type must equal the element type of the first operand. The third operand
6343is an index indicating the position at which to insert the value. The
Michael J. Spencer1f10c5ea2014-05-01 22:12:39 +00006344index may be a variable of any integer type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006345
6346Semantics:
6347""""""""""
6348
6349The result is a vector of the same type as ``val``. Its element values
6350are those of ``val`` except at position ``idx``, where it gets the value
6351``elt``. If ``idx`` exceeds the length of ``val``, the results are
6352undefined.
6353
6354Example:
6355""""""""
6356
6357.. code-block:: llvm
6358
6359 <result> = insertelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 1, i32 0 ; yields <4 x i32>
6360
6361.. _i_shufflevector:
6362
6363'``shufflevector``' Instruction
6364^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6365
6366Syntax:
6367"""""""
6368
6369::
6370
6371 <result> = shufflevector <n x <ty>> <v1>, <n x <ty>> <v2>, <m x i32> <mask> ; yields <m x <ty>>
6372
6373Overview:
6374"""""""""
6375
6376The '``shufflevector``' instruction constructs a permutation of elements
6377from two input vectors, returning a vector with the same element type as
6378the input and length that is the same as the shuffle mask.
6379
6380Arguments:
6381""""""""""
6382
6383The first two operands of a '``shufflevector``' instruction are vectors
6384with the same type. The third argument is a shuffle mask whose element
6385type is always 'i32'. The result of the instruction is a vector whose
6386length is the same as the shuffle mask and whose element type is the
6387same as the element type of the first two operands.
6388
6389The shuffle mask operand is required to be a constant vector with either
6390constant integer or undef values.
6391
6392Semantics:
6393""""""""""
6394
6395The elements of the two input vectors are numbered from left to right
6396across both of the vectors. The shuffle mask operand specifies, for each
6397element of the result vector, which element of the two input vectors the
6398result element gets. The element selector may be undef (meaning "don't
6399care") and the second operand may be undef if performing a shuffle from
6400only one vector.
6401
6402Example:
6403""""""""
6404
6405.. code-block:: llvm
6406
6407 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
6408 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 4, i32 1, i32 5> ; yields <4 x i32>
6409 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> undef,
6410 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32> - Identity shuffle.
6411 <result> = shufflevector <8 x i32> %v1, <8 x i32> undef,
6412 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32>
6413 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
6414 <8 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3, i32 4, i32 5, i32 6, i32 7 > ; yields <8 x i32>
6415
6416Aggregate Operations
6417--------------------
6418
6419LLVM supports several instructions for working with
6420:ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` values.
6421
6422.. _i_extractvalue:
6423
6424'``extractvalue``' Instruction
6425^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6426
6427Syntax:
6428"""""""
6429
6430::
6431
6432 <result> = extractvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <idx>{, <idx>}*
6433
6434Overview:
6435"""""""""
6436
6437The '``extractvalue``' instruction extracts the value of a member field
6438from an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
6439
6440Arguments:
6441""""""""""
6442
6443The first operand of an '``extractvalue``' instruction is a value of
6444:ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The operands are
6445constant indices to specify which value to extract in a similar manner
6446as indices in a '``getelementptr``' instruction.
6447
6448The major differences to ``getelementptr`` indexing are:
6449
6450- Since the value being indexed is not a pointer, the first index is
6451 omitted and assumed to be zero.
6452- At least one index must be specified.
6453- Not only struct indices but also array indices must be in bounds.
6454
6455Semantics:
6456""""""""""
6457
6458The result is the value at the position in the aggregate specified by
6459the index operands.
6460
6461Example:
6462""""""""
6463
6464.. code-block:: llvm
6465
6466 <result> = extractvalue {i32, float} %agg, 0 ; yields i32
6467
6468.. _i_insertvalue:
6469
6470'``insertvalue``' Instruction
6471^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6472
6473Syntax:
6474"""""""
6475
6476::
6477
6478 <result> = insertvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <idx>{, <idx>}* ; yields <aggregate type>
6479
6480Overview:
6481"""""""""
6482
6483The '``insertvalue``' instruction inserts a value into a member field in
6484an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
6485
6486Arguments:
6487""""""""""
6488
6489The first operand of an '``insertvalue``' instruction is a value of
6490:ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The second operand is
6491a first-class value to insert. The following operands are constant
6492indices indicating the position at which to insert the value in a
6493similar manner as indices in a '``extractvalue``' instruction. The value
6494to insert must have the same type as the value identified by the
6495indices.
6496
6497Semantics:
6498""""""""""
6499
6500The result is an aggregate of the same type as ``val``. Its value is
6501that of ``val`` except that the value at the position specified by the
6502indices is that of ``elt``.
6503
6504Example:
6505""""""""
6506
6507.. code-block:: llvm
6508
6509 %agg1 = insertvalue {i32, float} undef, i32 1, 0 ; yields {i32 1, float undef}
6510 %agg2 = insertvalue {i32, float} %agg1, float %val, 1 ; yields {i32 1, float %val}
Dan Liewffcfe7f2014-09-08 21:19:46 +00006511 %agg3 = insertvalue {i32, {float}} undef, float %val, 1, 0 ; yields {i32 undef, {float %val}}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006512
6513.. _memoryops:
6514
6515Memory Access and Addressing Operations
6516---------------------------------------
6517
6518A key design point of an SSA-based representation is how it represents
6519memory. In LLVM, no memory locations are in SSA form, which makes things
6520very simple. This section describes how to read, write, and allocate
6521memory in LLVM.
6522
6523.. _i_alloca:
6524
6525'``alloca``' Instruction
6526^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6527
6528Syntax:
6529"""""""
6530
6531::
6532
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006533 <result> = alloca [inalloca] <type> [, <ty> <NumElements>] [, align <alignment>] ; yields type*:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006534
6535Overview:
6536"""""""""
6537
6538The '``alloca``' instruction allocates memory on the stack frame of the
6539currently executing function, to be automatically released when this
6540function returns to its caller. The object is always allocated in the
6541generic address space (address space zero).
6542
6543Arguments:
6544""""""""""
6545
6546The '``alloca``' instruction allocates ``sizeof(<type>)*NumElements``
6547bytes of memory on the runtime stack, returning a pointer of the
6548appropriate type to the program. If "NumElements" is specified, it is
6549the number of elements allocated, otherwise "NumElements" is defaulted
6550to be one. If a constant alignment is specified, the value result of the
Reid Kleckner15fe7a52014-07-15 01:16:09 +00006551allocation is guaranteed to be aligned to at least that boundary. The
6552alignment may not be greater than ``1 << 29``. If not specified, or if
6553zero, the target can choose to align the allocation on any convenient
6554boundary compatible with the type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006555
6556'``type``' may be any sized type.
6557
6558Semantics:
6559""""""""""
6560
6561Memory is allocated; a pointer is returned. The operation is undefined
6562if there is insufficient stack space for the allocation. '``alloca``'d
6563memory is automatically released when the function returns. The
6564'``alloca``' instruction is commonly used to represent automatic
6565variables that must have an address available. When the function returns
6566(either with the ``ret`` or ``resume`` instructions), the memory is
6567reclaimed. Allocating zero bytes is legal, but the result is undefined.
6568The order in which memory is allocated (ie., which way the stack grows)
6569is not specified.
6570
6571Example:
6572""""""""
6573
6574.. code-block:: llvm
6575
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006576 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
6577 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4 ; yields i32*:ptr
6578 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr
6579 %ptr = alloca i32, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006580
6581.. _i_load:
6582
6583'``load``' Instruction
6584^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6585
6586Syntax:
6587"""""""
6588
6589::
6590
Sanjoy Dasf9995472015-05-19 20:10:19 +00006591 <result> = load [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.load !<index>][, !nonnull !<index>][, !dereferenceable !<index>][, !dereferenceable_or_null !<index>]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006592 <result> = load atomic [volatile] <ty>* <pointer> [singlethread] <ordering>, align <alignment>
6593 !<index> = !{ i32 1 }
6594
6595Overview:
6596"""""""""
6597
6598The '``load``' instruction is used to read from memory.
6599
6600Arguments:
6601""""""""""
6602
Eli Bendersky239a78b2013-04-17 20:17:08 +00006603The argument to the ``load`` instruction specifies the memory address
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00006604from which to load. The type specified must be a :ref:`first
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006605class <t_firstclass>` type. If the ``load`` is marked as ``volatile``,
6606then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of
6607execution of this ``load`` with other :ref:`volatile
6608operations <volatile>`.
6609
6610If the ``load`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra
6611:ref:`ordering <ordering>` and optional ``singlethread`` argument. The
6612``release`` and ``acq_rel`` orderings are not valid on ``load``
6613instructions. Atomic loads produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results
6614when they may see multiple atomic stores. The type of the pointee must
6615be an integer type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or
6616equal to eight and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit.
6617``align`` must be explicitly specified on atomic loads, and the load has
6618undefined behavior if the alignment is not set to a value which is at
6619least the size in bytes of the pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have
6620any defined semantics for atomic loads.
6621
6622The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
6623operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
Eli Bendersky239a78b2013-04-17 20:17:08 +00006624or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006625alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
6626to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
6627alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the alignment
Reid Kleckner15fe7a52014-07-15 01:16:09 +00006628may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always safe. The
6629maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006630
6631The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00006632metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006633``i32`` entry of value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal``
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00006634metadata on the instruction tells the optimizer and code generator
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006635that this load is not expected to be reused in the cache. The code
6636generator may select special instructions to save cache bandwidth, such
6637as the ``MOVNT`` instruction on x86.
6638
6639The optional ``!invariant.load`` metadata must reference a single
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00006640metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
6641entries. The existence of the ``!invariant.load`` metadata on the
Philip Reamese1526fc2014-11-24 22:32:43 +00006642instruction tells the optimizer and code generator that the address
6643operand to this load points to memory which can be assumed unchanged.
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00006644Being invariant does not imply that a location is dereferenceable,
6645but it does imply that once the location is known dereferenceable
6646its value is henceforth unchanging.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006647
Philip Reamescdb72f32014-10-20 22:40:55 +00006648The optional ``!nonnull`` metadata must reference a single
6649metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
6650entries. The existence of the ``!nonnull`` metadata on the
6651instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to
6652never be null. This is analogous to the ''nonnull'' attribute
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00006653on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
6654to loads of a pointer type.
Philip Reamescdb72f32014-10-20 22:40:55 +00006655
Sanjoy Dasf9995472015-05-19 20:10:19 +00006656The optional ``!dereferenceable`` metadata must reference a single
6657metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64``
6658entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable`` metadata on the instruction
6659tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be dereferenceable.
6660The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
6661value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable''
6662attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
6663to loads of a pointer type.
6664
6665The optional ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata must reference a single
6666metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64``
6667entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata on the
6668instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be either
6669dereferenceable or null.
6670The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
6671value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable_or_null''
6672attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
6673to loads of a pointer type.
6674
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006675Semantics:
6676""""""""""
6677
6678The location of memory pointed to is loaded. If the value being loaded
6679is of scalar type then the number of bytes read does not exceed the
6680minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
6681example, loading an ``i24`` reads at most three bytes. When loading a
6682value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
6683of bytes, the result is undefined if the value was not originally
6684written using a store of the same type.
6685
6686Examples:
6687"""""""""
6688
6689.. code-block:: llvm
6690
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006691 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
6692 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00006693 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006694
6695.. _i_store:
6696
6697'``store``' Instruction
6698^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6699
6700Syntax:
6701"""""""
6702
6703::
6704
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006705 store [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>] ; yields void
6706 store atomic [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer> [singlethread] <ordering>, align <alignment> ; yields void
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006707
6708Overview:
6709"""""""""
6710
6711The '``store``' instruction is used to write to memory.
6712
6713Arguments:
6714""""""""""
6715
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00006716There are two arguments to the ``store`` instruction: a value to store
6717and an address at which to store it. The type of the ``<pointer>``
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006718operand must be a pointer to the :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type of
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00006719the ``<value>`` operand. If the ``store`` is marked as ``volatile``,
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006720then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of
6721execution of this ``store`` with other :ref:`volatile
6722operations <volatile>`.
6723
6724If the ``store`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra
6725:ref:`ordering <ordering>` and optional ``singlethread`` argument. The
6726``acquire`` and ``acq_rel`` orderings aren't valid on ``store``
6727instructions. Atomic loads produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results
6728when they may see multiple atomic stores. The type of the pointee must
6729be an integer type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or
6730equal to eight and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit.
6731``align`` must be explicitly specified on atomic stores, and the store
6732has undefined behavior if the alignment is not set to a value which is
6733at least the size in bytes of the pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not
6734have any defined semantics for atomic stores.
6735
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00006736The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006737operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00006738or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006739alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
6740to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00006741alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006742alignment may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always
Reid Kleckner15fe7a52014-07-15 01:16:09 +00006743safe. The maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006744
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00006745The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single metadata
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00006746name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i32`` entry of
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00006747value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal`` metadata on the instruction
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006748tells the optimizer and code generator that this load is not expected to
6749be reused in the cache. The code generator may select special
6750instructions to save cache bandwidth, such as the MOVNT instruction on
6751x86.
6752
6753Semantics:
6754""""""""""
6755
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00006756The contents of memory are updated to contain ``<value>`` at the
6757location specified by the ``<pointer>`` operand. If ``<value>`` is
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006758of scalar type then the number of bytes written does not exceed the
6759minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
6760example, storing an ``i24`` writes at most three bytes. When writing a
6761value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
6762of bytes, it is unspecified what happens to the extra bits that do not
6763belong to the type, but they will typically be overwritten.
6764
6765Example:
6766""""""""
6767
6768.. code-block:: llvm
6769
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006770 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
6771 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void
6772 %val = load i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006773
6774.. _i_fence:
6775
6776'``fence``' Instruction
6777^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6778
6779Syntax:
6780"""""""
6781
6782::
6783
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006784 fence [singlethread] <ordering> ; yields void
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006785
6786Overview:
6787"""""""""
6788
6789The '``fence``' instruction is used to introduce happens-before edges
6790between operations.
6791
6792Arguments:
6793""""""""""
6794
6795'``fence``' instructions take an :ref:`ordering <ordering>` argument which
6796defines what *synchronizes-with* edges they add. They can only be given
6797``acquire``, ``release``, ``acq_rel``, and ``seq_cst`` orderings.
6798
6799Semantics:
6800""""""""""
6801
6802A fence A which has (at least) ``release`` ordering semantics
6803*synchronizes with* a fence B with (at least) ``acquire`` ordering
6804semantics if and only if there exist atomic operations X and Y, both
6805operating on some atomic object M, such that A is sequenced before X, X
6806modifies M (either directly or through some side effect of a sequence
6807headed by X), Y is sequenced before B, and Y observes M. This provides a
6808*happens-before* dependency between A and B. Rather than an explicit
6809``fence``, one (but not both) of the atomic operations X or Y might
6810provide a ``release`` or ``acquire`` (resp.) ordering constraint and
6811still *synchronize-with* the explicit ``fence`` and establish the
6812*happens-before* edge.
6813
6814A ``fence`` which has ``seq_cst`` ordering, in addition to having both
6815``acquire`` and ``release`` semantics specified above, participates in
6816the global program order of other ``seq_cst`` operations and/or fences.
6817
6818The optional ":ref:`singlethread <singlethread>`" argument specifies
6819that the fence only synchronizes with other fences in the same thread.
6820(This is useful for interacting with signal handlers.)
6821
6822Example:
6823""""""""
6824
6825.. code-block:: llvm
6826
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006827 fence acquire ; yields void
6828 fence singlethread seq_cst ; yields void
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006829
6830.. _i_cmpxchg:
6831
6832'``cmpxchg``' Instruction
6833^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6834
6835Syntax:
6836"""""""
6837
6838::
6839
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006840 cmpxchg [weak] [volatile] <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <cmp>, <ty> <new> [singlethread] <success ordering> <failure ordering> ; yields { ty, i1 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006841
6842Overview:
6843"""""""""
6844
6845The '``cmpxchg``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory. It
6846loads a value in memory and compares it to a given value. If they are
Tim Northover420a2162014-06-13 14:24:07 +00006847equal, it tries to store a new value into the memory.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006848
6849Arguments:
6850""""""""""
6851
6852There are three arguments to the '``cmpxchg``' instruction: an address
6853to operate on, a value to compare to the value currently be at that
6854address, and a new value to place at that address if the compared values
6855are equal. The type of '<cmp>' must be an integer type whose bit width
6856is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less than or equal
6857to a target-specific size limit. '<cmp>' and '<new>' must have the same
6858type, and the type of '<pointer>' must be a pointer to that type. If the
6859``cmpxchg`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed
6860to modify the number or order of execution of this ``cmpxchg`` with
6861other :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
6862
Tim Northovere94a5182014-03-11 10:48:52 +00006863The success and failure :ref:`ordering <ordering>` arguments specify how this
Tim Northover1dcc9f92014-06-13 14:24:16 +00006864``cmpxchg`` synchronizes with other atomic operations. Both ordering parameters
6865must be at least ``monotonic``, the ordering constraint on failure must be no
6866stronger than that on success, and the failure ordering cannot be either
6867``release`` or ``acq_rel``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006868
6869The optional "``singlethread``" argument declares that the ``cmpxchg``
6870is only atomic with respect to code (usually signal handlers) running in
6871the same thread as the ``cmpxchg``. Otherwise the cmpxchg is atomic with
6872respect to all other code in the system.
6873
6874The pointer passed into cmpxchg must have alignment greater than or
6875equal to the size in memory of the operand.
6876
6877Semantics:
6878""""""""""
6879
Tim Northover420a2162014-06-13 14:24:07 +00006880The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``' operand
6881is read and compared to '``<cmp>``'; if the read value is the equal, the
6882'``<new>``' is written. The original value at the location is returned, together
6883with a flag indicating success (true) or failure (false).
6884
6885If the cmpxchg operation is marked as ``weak`` then a spurious failure is
6886permitted: the operation may not write ``<new>`` even if the comparison
6887matched.
6888
6889If the cmpxchg operation is strong (the default), the i1 value is 1 if and only
6890if the value loaded equals ``cmp``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006891
Tim Northovere94a5182014-03-11 10:48:52 +00006892A successful ``cmpxchg`` is a read-modify-write instruction for the purpose of
6893identifying release sequences. A failed ``cmpxchg`` is equivalent to an atomic
6894load with an ordering parameter determined the second ordering parameter.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006895
6896Example:
6897""""""""
6898
6899.. code-block:: llvm
6900
6901 entry:
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00006902 %orig = atomic load i32, i32* %ptr unordered ; yields i32
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006903 br label %loop
6904
6905 loop:
6906 %cmp = phi i32 [ %orig, %entry ], [%old, %loop]
6907 %squared = mul i32 %cmp, %cmp
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006908 %val_success = cmpxchg i32* %ptr, i32 %cmp, i32 %squared acq_rel monotonic ; yields { i32, i1 }
Tim Northover420a2162014-06-13 14:24:07 +00006909 %value_loaded = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 0
6910 %success = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006911 br i1 %success, label %done, label %loop
6912
6913 done:
6914 ...
6915
6916.. _i_atomicrmw:
6917
6918'``atomicrmw``' Instruction
6919^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6920
6921Syntax:
6922"""""""
6923
6924::
6925
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006926 atomicrmw [volatile] <operation> <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <value> [singlethread] <ordering> ; yields ty
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006927
6928Overview:
6929"""""""""
6930
6931The '``atomicrmw``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory.
6932
6933Arguments:
6934""""""""""
6935
6936There are three arguments to the '``atomicrmw``' instruction: an
6937operation to apply, an address whose value to modify, an argument to the
6938operation. The operation must be one of the following keywords:
6939
6940- xchg
6941- add
6942- sub
6943- and
6944- nand
6945- or
6946- xor
6947- max
6948- min
6949- umax
6950- umin
6951
6952The type of '<value>' must be an integer type whose bit width is a power
6953of two greater than or equal to eight and less than or equal to a
6954target-specific size limit. The type of the '``<pointer>``' operand must
6955be a pointer to that type. If the ``atomicrmw`` is marked as
6956``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or
6957order of execution of this ``atomicrmw`` with other :ref:`volatile
6958operations <volatile>`.
6959
6960Semantics:
6961""""""""""
6962
6963The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``'
6964operand are atomically read, modified, and written back. The original
6965value at the location is returned. The modification is specified by the
6966operation argument:
6967
6968- xchg: ``*ptr = val``
6969- add: ``*ptr = *ptr + val``
6970- sub: ``*ptr = *ptr - val``
6971- and: ``*ptr = *ptr & val``
6972- nand: ``*ptr = ~(*ptr & val)``
6973- or: ``*ptr = *ptr | val``
6974- xor: ``*ptr = *ptr ^ val``
6975- max: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
6976- min: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
6977- umax: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
6978 comparison)
6979- umin: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
6980 comparison)
6981
6982Example:
6983""""""""
6984
6985.. code-block:: llvm
6986
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006987 %old = atomicrmw add i32* %ptr, i32 1 acquire ; yields i32
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006988
6989.. _i_getelementptr:
6990
6991'``getelementptr``' Instruction
6992^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6993
6994Syntax:
6995"""""""
6996
6997::
6998
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00006999 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, <ty> <idx>}*
7000 <result> = getelementptr inbounds <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, <ty> <idx>}*
7001 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ptr vector> <ptrval>, <vector index type> <idx>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007002
7003Overview:
7004"""""""""
7005
7006The '``getelementptr``' instruction is used to get the address of a
7007subelement of an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` data structure. It performs
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007008address calculation only and does not access memory. The instruction can also
7009be used to calculate a vector of such addresses.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007010
7011Arguments:
7012""""""""""
7013
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007014The first argument is always a type used as the basis for the calculations.
7015The second argument is always a pointer or a vector of pointers, and is the
7016base address to start from. The remaining arguments are indices
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007017that indicate which of the elements of the aggregate object are indexed.
7018The interpretation of each index is dependent on the type being indexed
7019into. The first index always indexes the pointer value given as the
7020first argument, the second index indexes a value of the type pointed to
7021(not necessarily the value directly pointed to, since the first index
7022can be non-zero), etc. The first type indexed into must be a pointer
7023value, subsequent types can be arrays, vectors, and structs. Note that
7024subsequent types being indexed into can never be pointers, since that
7025would require loading the pointer before continuing calculation.
7026
7027The type of each index argument depends on the type it is indexing into.
7028When indexing into a (optionally packed) structure, only ``i32`` integer
7029**constants** are allowed (when using a vector of indices they must all
7030be the **same** ``i32`` integer constant). When indexing into an array,
7031pointer or vector, integers of any width are allowed, and they are not
7032required to be constant. These integers are treated as signed values
7033where relevant.
7034
7035For example, let's consider a C code fragment and how it gets compiled
7036to LLVM:
7037
7038.. code-block:: c
7039
7040 struct RT {
7041 char A;
7042 int B[10][20];
7043 char C;
7044 };
7045 struct ST {
7046 int X;
7047 double Y;
7048 struct RT Z;
7049 };
7050
7051 int *foo(struct ST *s) {
7052 return &s[1].Z.B[5][13];
7053 }
7054
7055The LLVM code generated by Clang is:
7056
7057.. code-block:: llvm
7058
7059 %struct.RT = type { i8, [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }
7060 %struct.ST = type { i32, double, %struct.RT }
7061
7062 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) nounwind uwtable readnone optsize ssp {
7063 entry:
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007064 %arrayidx = getelementptr inbounds %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i64 1, i32 2, i32 1, i64 5, i64 13
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007065 ret i32* %arrayidx
7066 }
7067
7068Semantics:
7069""""""""""
7070
7071In the example above, the first index is indexing into the
7072'``%struct.ST*``' type, which is a pointer, yielding a '``%struct.ST``'
7073= '``{ i32, double, %struct.RT }``' type, a structure. The second index
7074indexes into the third element of the structure, yielding a
7075'``%struct.RT``' = '``{ i8 , [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }``' type, another
7076structure. The third index indexes into the second element of the
7077structure, yielding a '``[10 x [20 x i32]]``' type, an array. The two
7078dimensions of the array are subscripted into, yielding an '``i32``'
7079type. The '``getelementptr``' instruction returns a pointer to this
7080element, thus computing a value of '``i32*``' type.
7081
7082Note that it is perfectly legal to index partially through a structure,
7083returning a pointer to an inner element. Because of this, the LLVM code
7084for the given testcase is equivalent to:
7085
7086.. code-block:: llvm
7087
7088 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) {
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007089 %t1 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i32 1 ; yields %struct.ST*:%t1
7090 %t2 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %t1, i32 0, i32 2 ; yields %struct.RT*:%t2
7091 %t3 = getelementptr %struct.RT, %struct.RT* %t2, i32 0, i32 1 ; yields [10 x [20 x i32]]*:%t3
7092 %t4 = getelementptr [10 x [20 x i32]], [10 x [20 x i32]]* %t3, i32 0, i32 5 ; yields [20 x i32]*:%t4
7093 %t5 = getelementptr [20 x i32], [20 x i32]* %t4, i32 0, i32 13 ; yields i32*:%t5
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007094 ret i32* %t5
7095 }
7096
7097If the ``inbounds`` keyword is present, the result value of the
7098``getelementptr`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the base
7099pointer is not an *in bounds* address of an allocated object, or if any
7100of the addresses that would be formed by successive addition of the
7101offsets implied by the indices to the base address with infinitely
7102precise signed arithmetic are not an *in bounds* address of that
7103allocated object. The *in bounds* addresses for an allocated object are
7104all the addresses that point into the object, plus the address one byte
7105past the end. In cases where the base is a vector of pointers the
7106``inbounds`` keyword applies to each of the computations element-wise.
7107
7108If the ``inbounds`` keyword is not present, the offsets are added to the
7109base address with silently-wrapping two's complement arithmetic. If the
7110offsets have a different width from the pointer, they are sign-extended
7111or truncated to the width of the pointer. The result value of the
7112``getelementptr`` may be outside the object pointed to by the base
7113pointer. The result value may not necessarily be used to access memory
7114though, even if it happens to point into allocated storage. See the
7115:ref:`Pointer Aliasing Rules <pointeraliasing>` section for more
7116information.
7117
7118The getelementptr instruction is often confusing. For some more insight
7119into how it works, see :doc:`the getelementptr FAQ <GetElementPtr>`.
7120
7121Example:
7122""""""""
7123
7124.. code-block:: llvm
7125
7126 ; yields [12 x i8]*:aptr
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007127 %aptr = getelementptr {i32, [12 x i8]}, {i32, [12 x i8]}* %saptr, i64 0, i32 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007128 ; yields i8*:vptr
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007129 %vptr = getelementptr {i32, <2 x i8>}, {i32, <2 x i8>}* %svptr, i64 0, i32 1, i32 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007130 ; yields i8*:eptr
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007131 %eptr = getelementptr [12 x i8], [12 x i8]* %aptr, i64 0, i32 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007132 ; yields i32*:iptr
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007133 %iptr = getelementptr [10 x i32], [10 x i32]* @arr, i16 0, i16 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007134
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007135Vector of pointers:
7136"""""""""""""""""""
7137
7138The ``getelementptr`` returns a vector of pointers, instead of a single address,
7139when one or more of its arguments is a vector. In such cases, all vector
7140arguments should have the same number of elements, and every scalar argument
7141will be effectively broadcast into a vector during address calculation.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007142
7143.. code-block:: llvm
7144
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007145 ; All arguments are vectors:
7146 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
7147 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, <4 x i64> %offsets
7148
7149 ; Add the same scalar offset to each pointer of a vector:
7150 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offset*sizeof(i8)
7151 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, i64 %offset
7152
7153 ; Add distinct offsets to the same pointer:
7154 ; A[i] = ptr + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
7155 %A = getelementptr i8, i8* %ptr, <4 x i64> %offsets
7156
7157 ; In all cases described above the type of the result is <4 x i8*>
7158
7159The two following instructions are equivalent:
7160
7161.. code-block:: llvm
7162
7163 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
7164 <4 x i32> <i32 2, i32 2, i32 2, i32 2>,
7165 <4 x i32> <i32 1, i32 1, i32 1, i32 1>,
7166 <4 x i32> %ind4,
7167 <4 x i64> <i64 13, i64 13, i64 13, i64 13>
7168
7169 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
7170 i32 2, i32 1, <4 x i32> %ind4, i64 13
7171
7172Let's look at the C code, where the vector version of ``getelementptr``
7173makes sense:
7174
7175.. code-block:: c
7176
7177 // Let's assume that we vectorize the following loop:
7178 double *A, B; int *C;
7179 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
7180 A[i] = B[C[i]];
7181 }
7182
7183.. code-block:: llvm
7184
7185 ; get pointers for 8 elements from array B
7186 %ptrs = getelementptr double, double* %B, <8 x i32> %C
7187 ; load 8 elements from array B into A
7188 %A = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v8f64(<8 x double*> %ptrs,
7189 i32 8, <8 x i1> %mask, <8 x double> %passthru)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007190
7191Conversion Operations
7192---------------------
7193
7194The instructions in this category are the conversion instructions
7195(casting) which all take a single operand and a type. They perform
7196various bit conversions on the operand.
7197
7198'``trunc .. to``' Instruction
7199^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7200
7201Syntax:
7202"""""""
7203
7204::
7205
7206 <result> = trunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7207
7208Overview:
7209"""""""""
7210
7211The '``trunc``' instruction truncates its operand to the type ``ty2``.
7212
7213Arguments:
7214""""""""""
7215
7216The '``trunc``' instruction takes a value to trunc, and a type to trunc
7217it to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors
7218of the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
7219larger than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``. Equal sized
7220types are not allowed.
7221
7222Semantics:
7223""""""""""
7224
7225The '``trunc``' instruction truncates the high order bits in ``value``
7226and converts the remaining bits to ``ty2``. Since the source size must
7227be larger than the destination size, ``trunc`` cannot be a *no-op cast*.
7228It will always truncate bits.
7229
7230Example:
7231""""""""
7232
7233.. code-block:: llvm
7234
7235 %X = trunc i32 257 to i8 ; yields i8:1
7236 %Y = trunc i32 123 to i1 ; yields i1:true
7237 %Z = trunc i32 122 to i1 ; yields i1:false
7238 %W = trunc <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i8> ; yields <i8 8, i8 7>
7239
7240'``zext .. to``' Instruction
7241^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7242
7243Syntax:
7244"""""""
7245
7246::
7247
7248 <result> = zext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7249
7250Overview:
7251"""""""""
7252
7253The '``zext``' instruction zero extends its operand to type ``ty2``.
7254
7255Arguments:
7256""""""""""
7257
7258The '``zext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
7259to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
7260the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
7261smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
7262
7263Semantics:
7264""""""""""
7265
7266The ``zext`` fills the high order bits of the ``value`` with zero bits
7267until it reaches the size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
7268
7269When zero extending from i1, the result will always be either 0 or 1.
7270
7271Example:
7272""""""""
7273
7274.. code-block:: llvm
7275
7276 %X = zext i32 257 to i64 ; yields i64:257
7277 %Y = zext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:1
7278 %Z = zext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
7279
7280'``sext .. to``' Instruction
7281^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7282
7283Syntax:
7284"""""""
7285
7286::
7287
7288 <result> = sext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7289
7290Overview:
7291"""""""""
7292
7293The '``sext``' sign extends ``value`` to the type ``ty2``.
7294
7295Arguments:
7296""""""""""
7297
7298The '``sext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
7299to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
7300the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
7301smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
7302
7303Semantics:
7304""""""""""
7305
7306The '``sext``' instruction performs a sign extension by copying the sign
7307bit (highest order bit) of the ``value`` until it reaches the bit size
7308of the type ``ty2``.
7309
7310When sign extending from i1, the extension always results in -1 or 0.
7311
7312Example:
7313""""""""
7314
7315.. code-block:: llvm
7316
7317 %X = sext i8 -1 to i16 ; yields i16 :65535
7318 %Y = sext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:-1
7319 %Z = sext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
7320
7321'``fptrunc .. to``' Instruction
7322^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7323
7324Syntax:
7325"""""""
7326
7327::
7328
7329 <result> = fptrunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7330
7331Overview:
7332"""""""""
7333
7334The '``fptrunc``' instruction truncates ``value`` to type ``ty2``.
7335
7336Arguments:
7337""""""""""
7338
7339The '``fptrunc``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>`
7340value to cast and a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to cast it to.
7341The size of ``value`` must be larger than the size of ``ty2``. This
7342implies that ``fptrunc`` cannot be used to make a *no-op cast*.
7343
7344Semantics:
7345""""""""""
7346
7347The '``fptrunc``' instruction truncates a ``value`` from a larger
7348:ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to a smaller :ref:`floating
7349point <t_floating>` type. If the value cannot fit within the
7350destination type, ``ty2``, then the results are undefined.
7351
7352Example:
7353""""""""
7354
7355.. code-block:: llvm
7356
7357 %X = fptrunc double 123.0 to float ; yields float:123.0
7358 %Y = fptrunc double 1.0E+300 to float ; yields undefined
7359
7360'``fpext .. to``' Instruction
7361^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7362
7363Syntax:
7364"""""""
7365
7366::
7367
7368 <result> = fpext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7369
7370Overview:
7371"""""""""
7372
7373The '``fpext``' extends a floating point ``value`` to a larger floating
7374point value.
7375
7376Arguments:
7377""""""""""
7378
7379The '``fpext``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>`
7380``value`` to cast, and a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to cast it
7381to. The source type must be smaller than the destination type.
7382
7383Semantics:
7384""""""""""
7385
7386The '``fpext``' instruction extends the ``value`` from a smaller
7387:ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to a larger :ref:`floating
7388point <t_floating>` type. The ``fpext`` cannot be used to make a
7389*no-op cast* because it always changes bits. Use ``bitcast`` to make a
7390*no-op cast* for a floating point cast.
7391
7392Example:
7393""""""""
7394
7395.. code-block:: llvm
7396
7397 %X = fpext float 3.125 to double ; yields double:3.125000e+00
7398 %Y = fpext double %X to fp128 ; yields fp128:0xL00000000000000004000900000000000
7399
7400'``fptoui .. to``' Instruction
7401^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7402
7403Syntax:
7404"""""""
7405
7406::
7407
7408 <result> = fptoui <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7409
7410Overview:
7411"""""""""
7412
7413The '``fptoui``' converts a floating point ``value`` to its unsigned
7414integer equivalent of type ``ty2``.
7415
7416Arguments:
7417""""""""""
7418
7419The '``fptoui``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
7420scalar or vector :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
7421cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
7422``ty`` is a vector floating point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
7423type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
7424
7425Semantics:
7426""""""""""
7427
7428The '``fptoui``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating
7429point <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
7430unsigned integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the results
7431are undefined.
7432
7433Example:
7434""""""""
7435
7436.. code-block:: llvm
7437
7438 %X = fptoui double 123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:123
7439 %Y = fptoui float 1.0E+300 to i1 ; yields undefined:1
7440 %Z = fptoui float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1
7441
7442'``fptosi .. to``' Instruction
7443^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7444
7445Syntax:
7446"""""""
7447
7448::
7449
7450 <result> = fptosi <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7451
7452Overview:
7453"""""""""
7454
7455The '``fptosi``' instruction converts :ref:`floating point <t_floating>`
7456``value`` to type ``ty2``.
7457
7458Arguments:
7459""""""""""
7460
7461The '``fptosi``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
7462scalar or vector :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
7463cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
7464``ty`` is a vector floating point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
7465type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
7466
7467Semantics:
7468""""""""""
7469
7470The '``fptosi``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating
7471point <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
7472signed integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the results
7473are undefined.
7474
7475Example:
7476""""""""
7477
7478.. code-block:: llvm
7479
7480 %X = fptosi double -123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:-123
7481 %Y = fptosi float 1.0E-247 to i1 ; yields undefined:1
7482 %Z = fptosi float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1
7483
7484'``uitofp .. to``' Instruction
7485^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7486
7487Syntax:
7488"""""""
7489
7490::
7491
7492 <result> = uitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7493
7494Overview:
7495"""""""""
7496
7497The '``uitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as an unsigned integer
7498and converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
7499
7500Arguments:
7501""""""""""
7502
7503The '``uitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
7504scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
7505``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type. If
7506``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating point
7507type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
7508
7509Semantics:
7510""""""""""
7511
7512The '``uitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as an unsigned
7513integer quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating point
7514value. If the value cannot fit in the floating point value, the results
7515are undefined.
7516
7517Example:
7518""""""""
7519
7520.. code-block:: llvm
7521
7522 %X = uitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0
7523 %Y = uitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:255.0
7524
7525'``sitofp .. to``' Instruction
7526^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7527
7528Syntax:
7529"""""""
7530
7531::
7532
7533 <result> = sitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7534
7535Overview:
7536"""""""""
7537
7538The '``sitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as a signed integer and
7539converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
7540
7541Arguments:
7542""""""""""
7543
7544The '``sitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
7545scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
7546``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type. If
7547``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating point
7548type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
7549
7550Semantics:
7551""""""""""
7552
7553The '``sitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as a signed integer
7554quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating point value. If
7555the value cannot fit in the floating point value, the results are
7556undefined.
7557
7558Example:
7559""""""""
7560
7561.. code-block:: llvm
7562
7563 %X = sitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0
7564 %Y = sitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:-1.0
7565
7566.. _i_ptrtoint:
7567
7568'``ptrtoint .. to``' Instruction
7569^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7570
7571Syntax:
7572"""""""
7573
7574::
7575
7576 <result> = ptrtoint <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7577
7578Overview:
7579"""""""""
7580
7581The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts the pointer or a vector of
7582pointers ``value`` to the integer (or vector of integers) type ``ty2``.
7583
7584Arguments:
7585""""""""""
7586
7587The '``ptrtoint``' instruction takes a ``value`` to cast, which must be
Ed Maste8ed40ce2015-04-14 20:52:58 +00007588a value of type :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or a vector of pointers, and a
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007589type to cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
7590a vector of integers type.
7591
7592Semantics:
7593""""""""""
7594
7595The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts ``value`` to integer type
7596``ty2`` by interpreting the pointer value as an integer and either
7597truncating or zero extending that value to the size of the integer type.
7598If ``value`` is smaller than ``ty2`` then a zero extension is done. If
7599``value`` is larger than ``ty2`` then a truncation is done. If they are
7600the same size, then nothing is done (*no-op cast*) other than a type
7601change.
7602
7603Example:
7604""""""""
7605
7606.. code-block:: llvm
7607
7608 %X = ptrtoint i32* %P to i8 ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
7609 %Y = ptrtoint i32* %P to i64 ; yields zero extension on 32-bit architecture
7610 %Z = ptrtoint <4 x i32*> %P to <4 x i64>; yields vector zero extension for a vector of addresses on 32-bit architecture
7611
7612.. _i_inttoptr:
7613
7614'``inttoptr .. to``' Instruction
7615^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7616
7617Syntax:
7618"""""""
7619
7620::
7621
7622 <result> = inttoptr <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7623
7624Overview:
7625"""""""""
7626
7627The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts an integer ``value`` to a
7628pointer type, ``ty2``.
7629
7630Arguments:
7631""""""""""
7632
7633The '``inttoptr``' instruction takes an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value to
7634cast, and a type to cast it to, which must be a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>`
7635type.
7636
7637Semantics:
7638""""""""""
7639
7640The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` by
7641applying either a zero extension or a truncation depending on the size
7642of the integer ``value``. If ``value`` is larger than the size of a
7643pointer then a truncation is done. If ``value`` is smaller than the size
7644of a pointer then a zero extension is done. If they are the same size,
7645nothing is done (*no-op cast*).
7646
7647Example:
7648""""""""
7649
7650.. code-block:: llvm
7651
7652 %X = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields zero extension on 64-bit architecture
7653 %Y = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields no-op on 32-bit architecture
7654 %Z = inttoptr i64 0 to i32* ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
7655 %Z = inttoptr <4 x i32> %G to <4 x i8*>; yields truncation of vector G to four pointers
7656
7657.. _i_bitcast:
7658
7659'``bitcast .. to``' Instruction
7660^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7661
7662Syntax:
7663"""""""
7664
7665::
7666
7667 <result> = bitcast <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7668
7669Overview:
7670"""""""""
7671
7672The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` without
7673changing any bits.
7674
7675Arguments:
7676""""""""""
7677
7678The '``bitcast``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
7679non-aggregate first class value, and a type to cast it to, which must
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00007680also be a non-aggregate :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. The
7681bit sizes of ``value`` and the destination type, ``ty2``, must be
7682identical. If the source type is a pointer, the destination type must
7683also be a pointer of the same size. This instruction supports bitwise
7684conversion of vectors to integers and to vectors of other types (as
7685long as they have the same size).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007686
7687Semantics:
7688""""""""""
7689
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00007690The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2``. It
7691is always a *no-op cast* because no bits change with this
7692conversion. The conversion is done as if the ``value`` had been stored
7693to memory and read back as type ``ty2``. Pointer (or vector of
7694pointers) types may only be converted to other pointer (or vector of
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00007695pointers) types with the same address space through this instruction.
7696To convert pointers to other types, use the :ref:`inttoptr <i_inttoptr>`
7697or :ref:`ptrtoint <i_ptrtoint>` instructions first.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007698
7699Example:
7700""""""""
7701
7702.. code-block:: llvm
7703
7704 %X = bitcast i8 255 to i8 ; yields i8 :-1
7705 %Y = bitcast i32* %x to sint* ; yields sint*:%x
7706 %Z = bitcast <2 x int> %V to i64; ; yields i64: %V
7707 %Z = bitcast <2 x i32*> %V to <2 x i64*> ; yields <2 x i64*>
7708
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00007709.. _i_addrspacecast:
7710
7711'``addrspacecast .. to``' Instruction
7712^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7713
7714Syntax:
7715"""""""
7716
7717::
7718
7719 <result> = addrspacecast <pty> <ptrval> to <pty2> ; yields pty2
7720
7721Overview:
7722"""""""""
7723
7724The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts ``ptrval`` from ``pty`` in
7725address space ``n`` to type ``pty2`` in address space ``m``.
7726
7727Arguments:
7728""""""""""
7729
7730The '``addrspacecast``' instruction takes a pointer or vector of pointer value
7731to cast and a pointer type to cast it to, which must have a different
7732address space.
7733
7734Semantics:
7735""""""""""
7736
7737The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts the pointer value
7738``ptrval`` to type ``pty2``. It can be a *no-op cast* or a complex
Matt Arsenault54a2a172013-11-15 05:44:56 +00007739value modification, depending on the target and the address space
7740pair. Pointer conversions within the same address space must be
7741performed with the ``bitcast`` instruction. Note that if the address space
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00007742conversion is legal then both result and operand refer to the same memory
7743location.
7744
7745Example:
7746""""""""
7747
7748.. code-block:: llvm
7749
Matt Arsenault9c13dd02013-11-15 22:43:50 +00007750 %X = addrspacecast i32* %x to i32 addrspace(1)* ; yields i32 addrspace(1)*:%x
7751 %Y = addrspacecast i32 addrspace(1)* %y to i64 addrspace(2)* ; yields i64 addrspace(2)*:%y
7752 %Z = addrspacecast <4 x i32*> %z to <4 x float addrspace(3)*> ; yields <4 x float addrspace(3)*>:%z
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00007753
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007754.. _otherops:
7755
7756Other Operations
7757----------------
7758
7759The instructions in this category are the "miscellaneous" instructions,
7760which defy better classification.
7761
7762.. _i_icmp:
7763
7764'``icmp``' Instruction
7765^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7766
7767Syntax:
7768"""""""
7769
7770::
7771
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007772 <result> = icmp <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007773
7774Overview:
7775"""""""""
7776
7777The '``icmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or a vector of
7778boolean values based on comparison of its two integer, integer vector,
7779pointer, or pointer vector operands.
7780
7781Arguments:
7782""""""""""
7783
7784The '``icmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
7785the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
7786not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition code are:
7787
7788#. ``eq``: equal
7789#. ``ne``: not equal
7790#. ``ugt``: unsigned greater than
7791#. ``uge``: unsigned greater or equal
7792#. ``ult``: unsigned less than
7793#. ``ule``: unsigned less or equal
7794#. ``sgt``: signed greater than
7795#. ``sge``: signed greater or equal
7796#. ``slt``: signed less than
7797#. ``sle``: signed less or equal
7798
7799The remaining two arguments must be :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
7800:ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or integer :ref:`vector <t_vector>` typed. They
7801must also be identical types.
7802
7803Semantics:
7804""""""""""
7805
7806The '``icmp``' compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the condition
7807code given as ``cond``. The comparison performed always yields either an
7808:ref:`i1 <t_integer>` or vector of ``i1`` result, as follows:
7809
7810#. ``eq``: yields ``true`` if the operands are equal, ``false``
7811 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
7812#. ``ne``: yields ``true`` if the operands are unequal, ``false``
7813 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
7814#. ``ugt``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
7815 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
7816#. ``uge``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
7817 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
7818#. ``ult``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
7819 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
7820#. ``ule``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
7821 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
7822#. ``sgt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
7823 if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
7824#. ``sge``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
7825 if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
7826#. ``slt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
7827 if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
7828#. ``sle``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
7829 if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
7830
7831If the operands are :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` typed, the pointer values
7832are compared as if they were integers.
7833
7834If the operands are integer vectors, then they are compared element by
7835element. The result is an ``i1`` vector with the same number of elements
7836as the values being compared. Otherwise, the result is an ``i1``.
7837
7838Example:
7839""""""""
7840
7841.. code-block:: llvm
7842
7843 <result> = icmp eq i32 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
7844 <result> = icmp ne float* %X, %X ; yields: result=false
7845 <result> = icmp ult i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=true
7846 <result> = icmp sgt i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
7847 <result> = icmp ule i16 -4, 5 ; yields: result=false
7848 <result> = icmp sge i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
7849
7850Note that the code generator does not yet support vector types with the
7851``icmp`` instruction.
7852
7853.. _i_fcmp:
7854
7855'``fcmp``' Instruction
7856^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7857
7858Syntax:
7859"""""""
7860
7861::
7862
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007863 <result> = fcmp <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007864
7865Overview:
7866"""""""""
7867
7868The '``fcmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or vector of boolean
7869values based on comparison of its operands.
7870
7871If the operands are floating point scalars, then the result type is a
7872boolean (:ref:`i1 <t_integer>`).
7873
7874If the operands are floating point vectors, then the result type is a
7875vector of boolean with the same number of elements as the operands being
7876compared.
7877
7878Arguments:
7879""""""""""
7880
7881The '``fcmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
7882the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
7883not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition code are:
7884
7885#. ``false``: no comparison, always returns false
7886#. ``oeq``: ordered and equal
7887#. ``ogt``: ordered and greater than
7888#. ``oge``: ordered and greater than or equal
7889#. ``olt``: ordered and less than
7890#. ``ole``: ordered and less than or equal
7891#. ``one``: ordered and not equal
7892#. ``ord``: ordered (no nans)
7893#. ``ueq``: unordered or equal
7894#. ``ugt``: unordered or greater than
7895#. ``uge``: unordered or greater than or equal
7896#. ``ult``: unordered or less than
7897#. ``ule``: unordered or less than or equal
7898#. ``une``: unordered or not equal
7899#. ``uno``: unordered (either nans)
7900#. ``true``: no comparison, always returns true
7901
7902*Ordered* means that neither operand is a QNAN while *unordered* means
7903that either operand may be a QNAN.
7904
7905Each of ``val1`` and ``val2`` arguments must be either a :ref:`floating
7906point <t_floating>` type or a :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point
7907type. They must have identical types.
7908
7909Semantics:
7910""""""""""
7911
7912The '``fcmp``' instruction compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the
7913condition code given as ``cond``. If the operands are vectors, then the
7914vectors are compared element by element. Each comparison performed
7915always yields an :ref:`i1 <t_integer>` result, as follows:
7916
7917#. ``false``: always yields ``false``, regardless of operands.
7918#. ``oeq``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
7919 is equal to ``op2``.
7920#. ``ogt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
7921 is greater than ``op2``.
7922#. ``oge``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
7923 is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
7924#. ``olt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
7925 is less than ``op2``.
7926#. ``ole``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
7927 is less than or equal to ``op2``.
7928#. ``one``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
7929 is not equal to ``op2``.
7930#. ``ord``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN.
7931#. ``ueq``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
7932 equal to ``op2``.
7933#. ``ugt``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
7934 greater than ``op2``.
7935#. ``uge``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
7936 greater than or equal to ``op2``.
7937#. ``ult``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
7938 less than ``op2``.
7939#. ``ule``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
7940 less than or equal to ``op2``.
7941#. ``une``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
7942 not equal to ``op2``.
7943#. ``uno``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN.
7944#. ``true``: always yields ``true``, regardless of operands.
7945
7946Example:
7947""""""""
7948
7949.. code-block:: llvm
7950
7951 <result> = fcmp oeq float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=false
7952 <result> = fcmp one float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
7953 <result> = fcmp olt float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
7954 <result> = fcmp ueq double 1.0, 2.0 ; yields: result=false
7955
7956Note that the code generator does not yet support vector types with the
7957``fcmp`` instruction.
7958
7959.. _i_phi:
7960
7961'``phi``' Instruction
7962^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7963
7964Syntax:
7965"""""""
7966
7967::
7968
7969 <result> = phi <ty> [ <val0>, <label0>], ...
7970
7971Overview:
7972"""""""""
7973
7974The '``phi``' instruction is used to implement the φ node in the SSA
7975graph representing the function.
7976
7977Arguments:
7978""""""""""
7979
7980The type of the incoming values is specified with the first type field.
7981After this, the '``phi``' instruction takes a list of pairs as
7982arguments, with one pair for each predecessor basic block of the current
7983block. Only values of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type may be used as
7984the value arguments to the PHI node. Only labels may be used as the
7985label arguments.
7986
7987There must be no non-phi instructions between the start of a basic block
7988and the PHI instructions: i.e. PHI instructions must be first in a basic
7989block.
7990
7991For the purposes of the SSA form, the use of each incoming value is
7992deemed to occur on the edge from the corresponding predecessor block to
7993the current block (but after any definition of an '``invoke``'
7994instruction's return value on the same edge).
7995
7996Semantics:
7997""""""""""
7998
7999At runtime, the '``phi``' instruction logically takes on the value
8000specified by the pair corresponding to the predecessor basic block that
8001executed just prior to the current block.
8002
8003Example:
8004""""""""
8005
8006.. code-block:: llvm
8007
8008 Loop: ; Infinite loop that counts from 0 on up...
8009 %indvar = phi i32 [ 0, %LoopHeader ], [ %nextindvar, %Loop ]
8010 %nextindvar = add i32 %indvar, 1
8011 br label %Loop
8012
8013.. _i_select:
8014
8015'``select``' Instruction
8016^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8017
8018Syntax:
8019"""""""
8020
8021::
8022
8023 <result> = select selty <cond>, <ty> <val1>, <ty> <val2> ; yields ty
8024
8025 selty is either i1 or {<N x i1>}
8026
8027Overview:
8028"""""""""
8029
8030The '``select``' instruction is used to choose one value based on a
Joerg Sonnenberger94321ec2014-03-26 15:30:21 +00008031condition, without IR-level branching.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008032
8033Arguments:
8034""""""""""
8035
8036The '``select``' instruction requires an 'i1' value or a vector of 'i1'
8037values indicating the condition, and two values of the same :ref:`first
David Majnemer40a0b592015-03-03 22:45:47 +00008038class <t_firstclass>` type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008039
8040Semantics:
8041""""""""""
8042
8043If the condition is an i1 and it evaluates to 1, the instruction returns
8044the first value argument; otherwise, it returns the second value
8045argument.
8046
8047If the condition is a vector of i1, then the value arguments must be
8048vectors of the same size, and the selection is done element by element.
8049
David Majnemer40a0b592015-03-03 22:45:47 +00008050If the condition is an i1 and the value arguments are vectors of the
8051same size, then an entire vector is selected.
8052
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008053Example:
8054""""""""
8055
8056.. code-block:: llvm
8057
8058 %X = select i1 true, i8 17, i8 42 ; yields i8:17
8059
8060.. _i_call:
8061
8062'``call``' Instruction
8063^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8064
8065Syntax:
8066"""""""
8067
8068::
8069
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00008070 <result> = [tail | musttail] call [cconv] [ret attrs] <ty> [<fnty>*] <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008071
8072Overview:
8073"""""""""
8074
8075The '``call``' instruction represents a simple function call.
8076
8077Arguments:
8078""""""""""
8079
8080This instruction requires several arguments:
8081
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00008082#. The optional ``tail`` and ``musttail`` markers indicate that the optimizers
8083 should perform tail call optimization. The ``tail`` marker is a hint that
8084 `can be ignored <CodeGenerator.html#sibcallopt>`_. The ``musttail`` marker
8085 means that the call must be tail call optimized in order for the program to
8086 be correct. The ``musttail`` marker provides these guarantees:
8087
8088 #. The call will not cause unbounded stack growth if it is part of a
8089 recursive cycle in the call graph.
8090 #. Arguments with the :ref:`inalloca <attr_inalloca>` attribute are
8091 forwarded in place.
8092
8093 Both markers imply that the callee does not access allocas or varargs from
8094 the caller. Calls marked ``musttail`` must obey the following additional
8095 rules:
8096
8097 - The call must immediately precede a :ref:`ret <i_ret>` instruction,
8098 or a pointer bitcast followed by a ret instruction.
8099 - The ret instruction must return the (possibly bitcasted) value
8100 produced by the call or void.
8101 - The caller and callee prototypes must match. Pointer types of
8102 parameters or return types may differ in pointee type, but not
8103 in address space.
8104 - The calling conventions of the caller and callee must match.
8105 - All ABI-impacting function attributes, such as sret, byval, inreg,
8106 returned, and inalloca, must match.
Reid Kleckner83498642014-08-26 00:33:28 +00008107 - The callee must be varargs iff the caller is varargs. Bitcasting a
8108 non-varargs function to the appropriate varargs type is legal so
8109 long as the non-varargs prefixes obey the other rules.
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00008110
8111 Tail call optimization for calls marked ``tail`` is guaranteed to occur if
8112 the following conditions are met:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008113
8114 - Caller and callee both have the calling convention ``fastcc``.
8115 - The call is in tail position (ret immediately follows call and ret
8116 uses value of call or is void).
8117 - Option ``-tailcallopt`` is enabled, or
8118 ``llvm::GuaranteedTailCallOpt`` is ``true``.
Alp Tokercf218752014-06-30 18:57:16 +00008119 - `Platform-specific constraints are
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008120 met. <CodeGenerator.html#tailcallopt>`_
8121
8122#. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
8123 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
8124 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions. The
8125 calling convention of the call must match the calling convention of
8126 the target function, or else the behavior is undefined.
8127#. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
8128 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
8129 are valid here.
8130#. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
8131 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
8132 ``void``.
8133#. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the pointer to function value
8134 being invoked. The argument types must match the types implied by
8135 this signature. This type can be omitted if the function is not
8136 varargs and if the function type does not return a pointer to a
8137 function.
8138#. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
8139 be invoked. In most cases, this is a direct function invocation, but
8140 indirect ``call``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
8141 to function value.
8142#. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
8143 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
8144 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
8145 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
8146 extra arguments can be specified.
8147#. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list. Only
8148 '``noreturn``', '``nounwind``', '``readonly``' and '``readnone``'
8149 attributes are valid here.
8150
8151Semantics:
8152""""""""""
8153
8154The '``call``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to
8155a specified function, with its incoming arguments bound to the specified
8156values. Upon a '``ret``' instruction in the called function, control
8157flow continues with the instruction after the function call, and the
8158return value of the function is bound to the result argument.
8159
8160Example:
8161""""""""
8162
8163.. code-block:: llvm
8164
8165 %retval = call i32 @test(i32 %argc)
8166 call i32 (i8*, ...)* @printf(i8* %msg, i32 12, i8 42) ; yields i32
8167 %X = tail call i32 @foo() ; yields i32
8168 %Y = tail call fastcc i32 @foo() ; yields i32
8169 call void %foo(i8 97 signext)
8170
8171 %struct.A = type { i32, i8 }
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00008172 %r = call %struct.A @foo() ; yields { i32, i8 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008173 %gr = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 0 ; yields i32
8174 %gr1 = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 1 ; yields i8
8175 %Z = call void @foo() noreturn ; indicates that %foo never returns normally
8176 %ZZ = call zeroext i32 @bar() ; Return value is %zero extended
8177
8178llvm treats calls to some functions with names and arguments that match
8179the standard C99 library as being the C99 library functions, and may
8180perform optimizations or generate code for them under that assumption.
8181This is something we'd like to change in the future to provide better
8182support for freestanding environments and non-C-based languages.
8183
8184.. _i_va_arg:
8185
8186'``va_arg``' Instruction
8187^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8188
8189Syntax:
8190"""""""
8191
8192::
8193
8194 <resultval> = va_arg <va_list*> <arglist>, <argty>
8195
8196Overview:
8197"""""""""
8198
8199The '``va_arg``' instruction is used to access arguments passed through
8200the "variable argument" area of a function call. It is used to implement
8201the ``va_arg`` macro in C.
8202
8203Arguments:
8204""""""""""
8205
8206This instruction takes a ``va_list*`` value and the type of the
8207argument. It returns a value of the specified argument type and
8208increments the ``va_list`` to point to the next argument. The actual
8209type of ``va_list`` is target specific.
8210
8211Semantics:
8212""""""""""
8213
8214The '``va_arg``' instruction loads an argument of the specified type
8215from the specified ``va_list`` and causes the ``va_list`` to point to
8216the next argument. For more information, see the variable argument
8217handling :ref:`Intrinsic Functions <int_varargs>`.
8218
8219It is legal for this instruction to be called in a function which does
8220not take a variable number of arguments, for example, the ``vfprintf``
8221function.
8222
8223``va_arg`` is an LLVM instruction instead of an :ref:`intrinsic
8224function <intrinsics>` because it takes a type as an argument.
8225
8226Example:
8227""""""""
8228
8229See the :ref:`variable argument processing <int_varargs>` section.
8230
8231Note that the code generator does not yet fully support va\_arg on many
8232targets. Also, it does not currently support va\_arg with aggregate
8233types on any target.
8234
8235.. _i_landingpad:
8236
8237'``landingpad``' Instruction
8238^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8239
8240Syntax:
8241"""""""
8242
8243::
8244
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008245 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> <clause>+
8246 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> cleanup <clause>*
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008247
8248 <clause> := catch <type> <value>
8249 <clause> := filter <array constant type> <array constant>
8250
8251Overview:
8252"""""""""
8253
8254The '``landingpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
8255system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00008256is a landing pad --- one where the exception lands, and corresponds to the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008257code found in the ``catch`` portion of a ``try``/``catch`` sequence. It
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008258defines values supplied by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008259re-entry to the function. The ``resultval`` has the type ``resultty``.
8260
8261Arguments:
8262""""""""""
8263
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008264The optional
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008265``cleanup`` flag indicates that the landing pad block is a cleanup.
8266
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00008267A ``clause`` begins with the clause type --- ``catch`` or ``filter`` --- and
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008268contains the global variable representing the "type" that may be caught
8269or filtered respectively. Unlike the ``catch`` clause, the ``filter``
8270clause takes an array constant as its argument. Use
8271"``[0 x i8**] undef``" for a filter which cannot throw. The
8272'``landingpad``' instruction must contain *at least* one ``clause`` or
8273the ``cleanup`` flag.
8274
8275Semantics:
8276""""""""""
8277
8278The '``landingpad``' instruction defines the values which are set by the
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008279:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon re-entry to the function, and
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008280therefore the "result type" of the ``landingpad`` instruction. As with
8281calling conventions, how the personality function results are
8282represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
8283
8284The clauses are applied in order from top to bottom. If two
8285``landingpad`` instructions are merged together through inlining, the
8286clauses from the calling function are appended to the list of clauses.
8287When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
8288the exception is compared against each ``clause`` in turn. If it doesn't
8289match any of the clauses, and the ``cleanup`` flag is not set, then
8290unwinding continues further up the call stack.
8291
8292The ``landingpad`` instruction has several restrictions:
8293
8294- A landing pad block is a basic block which is the unwind destination
8295 of an '``invoke``' instruction.
8296- A landing pad block must have a '``landingpad``' instruction as its
8297 first non-PHI instruction.
8298- There can be only one '``landingpad``' instruction within the landing
8299 pad block.
8300- A basic block that is not a landing pad block may not include a
8301 '``landingpad``' instruction.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008302
8303Example:
8304""""""""
8305
8306.. code-block:: llvm
8307
8308 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer.
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008309 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008310 catch i8** @_ZTIi
8311 ;; A landing pad that is a cleanup.
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008312 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008313 cleanup
8314 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer and can only throw a double.
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008315 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008316 catch i8** @_ZTIi
8317 filter [1 x i8**] [@_ZTId]
8318
David Majnemerae2ffc82015-07-10 07:00:44 +00008319.. _i_cleanupblock:
8320
8321'``cleanupblock``' Instruction
8322^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8323
8324Syntax:
8325"""""""
8326
8327::
8328
8329 <resultval> = cleanupblock <resultty> [<args>*]
8330
8331Overview:
8332"""""""""
8333
8334The '``cleanupblock``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
8335system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
8336is a cleanup block --- one where a personality routine attempts to
8337transfer control to run cleanup actions.
8338The ``args`` correspond to whatever additional
8339information the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` requires to
8340execute the cleanup.
8341:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon re-entry to the
8342function. The ``resultval`` has the type ``resultty``.
8343
8344Arguments:
8345""""""""""
8346
8347The instruction takes a list of arbitrary values which are interpreted
8348by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>`.
8349
8350Semantics:
8351""""""""""
8352
8353The '``cleanupblock``' instruction defines the values which are set by the
8354:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon re-entry to the function, and
8355therefore the "result type" of the ``cleanupblock`` instruction. As with
8356calling conventions, how the personality function results are
8357represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
8358
8359When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
8360the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` transfers control to the
8361``cleanupblock`` with the aid of the personality-specific arguments.
8362
8363The ``cleanupblock`` instruction has several restrictions:
8364
8365- A cleanup block is a basic block which is the unwind destination of
8366 an exceptional instruction.
8367- A cleanup block must have a '``cleanupblock``' instruction as its
8368 first non-PHI instruction.
8369- There can be only one '``cleanupblock``' instruction within the
8370 cleanup block.
8371- A basic block that is not a cleanup block may not include a
8372 '``cleanupblock``' instruction.
8373
8374Example:
8375""""""""
8376
8377.. code-block:: llvm
8378
8379 %res = cleanupblock { i8*, i32 } [label %nextaction]
8380
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008381.. _intrinsics:
8382
8383Intrinsic Functions
8384===================
8385
8386LLVM supports the notion of an "intrinsic function". These functions
8387have well known names and semantics and are required to follow certain
8388restrictions. Overall, these intrinsics represent an extension mechanism
8389for the LLVM language that does not require changing all of the
8390transformations in LLVM when adding to the language (or the bitcode
8391reader/writer, the parser, etc...).
8392
8393Intrinsic function names must all start with an "``llvm.``" prefix. This
8394prefix is reserved in LLVM for intrinsic names; thus, function names may
8395not begin with this prefix. Intrinsic functions must always be external
8396functions: you cannot define the body of intrinsic functions. Intrinsic
8397functions may only be used in call or invoke instructions: it is illegal
8398to take the address of an intrinsic function. Additionally, because
8399intrinsic functions are part of the LLVM language, it is required if any
8400are added that they be documented here.
8401
8402Some intrinsic functions can be overloaded, i.e., the intrinsic
8403represents a family of functions that perform the same operation but on
8404different data types. Because LLVM can represent over 8 million
8405different integer types, overloading is used commonly to allow an
8406intrinsic function to operate on any integer type. One or more of the
8407argument types or the result type can be overloaded to accept any
8408integer type. Argument types may also be defined as exactly matching a
8409previous argument's type or the result type. This allows an intrinsic
8410function which accepts multiple arguments, but needs all of them to be
8411of the same type, to only be overloaded with respect to a single
8412argument or the result.
8413
8414Overloaded intrinsics will have the names of its overloaded argument
8415types encoded into its function name, each preceded by a period. Only
8416those types which are overloaded result in a name suffix. Arguments
8417whose type is matched against another type do not. For example, the
8418``llvm.ctpop`` function can take an integer of any width and returns an
8419integer of exactly the same integer width. This leads to a family of
8420functions such as ``i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %val)`` and
8421``i29 @llvm.ctpop.i29(i29 %val)``. Only one type, the return type, is
8422overloaded, and only one type suffix is required. Because the argument's
8423type is matched against the return type, it does not require its own
8424name suffix.
8425
8426To learn how to add an intrinsic function, please see the `Extending
8427LLVM Guide <ExtendingLLVM.html>`_.
8428
8429.. _int_varargs:
8430
8431Variable Argument Handling Intrinsics
8432-------------------------------------
8433
8434Variable argument support is defined in LLVM with the
8435:ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and these three intrinsic
8436functions. These functions are related to the similarly named macros
8437defined in the ``<stdarg.h>`` header file.
8438
8439All of these functions operate on arguments that use a target-specific
8440value type "``va_list``". The LLVM assembly language reference manual
8441does not define what this type is, so all transformations should be
8442prepared to handle these functions regardless of the type used.
8443
8444This example shows how the :ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and the
8445variable argument handling intrinsic functions are used.
8446
8447.. code-block:: llvm
8448
Tim Northoverab60bb92014-11-02 01:21:51 +00008449 ; This struct is different for every platform. For most platforms,
8450 ; it is merely an i8*.
8451 %struct.va_list = type { i8* }
8452
8453 ; For Unix x86_64 platforms, va_list is the following struct:
8454 ; %struct.va_list = type { i32, i32, i8*, i8* }
8455
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008456 define i32 @test(i32 %X, ...) {
8457 ; Initialize variable argument processing
Tim Northoverab60bb92014-11-02 01:21:51 +00008458 %ap = alloca %struct.va_list
8459 %ap2 = bitcast %struct.va_list* %ap to i8*
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008460 call void @llvm.va_start(i8* %ap2)
8461
8462 ; Read a single integer argument
Tim Northoverab60bb92014-11-02 01:21:51 +00008463 %tmp = va_arg i8* %ap2, i32
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008464
8465 ; Demonstrate usage of llvm.va_copy and llvm.va_end
8466 %aq = alloca i8*
8467 %aq2 = bitcast i8** %aq to i8*
8468 call void @llvm.va_copy(i8* %aq2, i8* %ap2)
8469 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %aq2)
8470
8471 ; Stop processing of arguments.
8472 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %ap2)
8473 ret i32 %tmp
8474 }
8475
8476 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8*)
8477 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8*, i8*)
8478 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8*)
8479
8480.. _int_va_start:
8481
8482'``llvm.va_start``' Intrinsic
8483^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8484
8485Syntax:
8486"""""""
8487
8488::
8489
Nick Lewycky04f6de02013-09-11 22:04:52 +00008490 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8* <arglist>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008491
8492Overview:
8493"""""""""
8494
8495The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic initializes ``*<arglist>`` for
8496subsequent use by ``va_arg``.
8497
8498Arguments:
8499""""""""""
8500
8501The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
8502
8503Semantics:
8504""""""""""
8505
8506The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_start`` macro
8507available in C. In a target-dependent way, it initializes the
8508``va_list`` element to which the argument points, so that the next call
8509to ``va_arg`` will produce the first variable argument passed to the
8510function. Unlike the C ``va_start`` macro, this intrinsic does not need
8511to know the last argument of the function as the compiler can figure
8512that out.
8513
8514'``llvm.va_end``' Intrinsic
8515^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8516
8517Syntax:
8518"""""""
8519
8520::
8521
8522 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8* <arglist>)
8523
8524Overview:
8525"""""""""
8526
8527The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic destroys ``*<arglist>``, which has been
8528initialized previously with ``llvm.va_start`` or ``llvm.va_copy``.
8529
8530Arguments:
8531""""""""""
8532
8533The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` to destroy.
8534
8535Semantics:
8536""""""""""
8537
8538The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_end`` macro
8539available in C. In a target-dependent way, it destroys the ``va_list``
8540element to which the argument points. Calls to
8541:ref:`llvm.va_start <int_va_start>` and
8542:ref:`llvm.va_copy <int_va_copy>` must be matched exactly with calls to
8543``llvm.va_end``.
8544
8545.. _int_va_copy:
8546
8547'``llvm.va_copy``' Intrinsic
8548^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8549
8550Syntax:
8551"""""""
8552
8553::
8554
8555 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8* <destarglist>, i8* <srcarglist>)
8556
8557Overview:
8558"""""""""
8559
8560The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic copies the current argument position
8561from the source argument list to the destination argument list.
8562
8563Arguments:
8564""""""""""
8565
8566The first argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
8567The second argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to copy from.
8568
8569Semantics:
8570""""""""""
8571
8572The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_copy`` macro
8573available in C. In a target-dependent way, it copies the source
8574``va_list`` element into the destination ``va_list`` element. This
8575intrinsic is necessary because the `` llvm.va_start`` intrinsic may be
8576arbitrarily complex and require, for example, memory allocation.
8577
8578Accurate Garbage Collection Intrinsics
8579--------------------------------------
8580
Philip Reamesc5b0f562015-02-25 23:52:06 +00008581LLVM's support for `Accurate Garbage Collection <GarbageCollection.html>`_
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00008582(GC) requires the frontend to generate code containing appropriate intrinsic
8583calls and select an appropriate GC strategy which knows how to lower these
Philip Reamesc5b0f562015-02-25 23:52:06 +00008584intrinsics in a manner which is appropriate for the target collector.
8585
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008586These intrinsics allow identification of :ref:`GC roots on the
8587stack <int_gcroot>`, as well as garbage collector implementations that
8588require :ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers.
Philip Reamesc5b0f562015-02-25 23:52:06 +00008589Frontends for type-safe garbage collected languages should generate
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008590these intrinsics to make use of the LLVM garbage collectors. For more
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00008591details, see `Garbage Collection with LLVM <GarbageCollection.html>`_.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008592
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00008593Experimental Statepoint Intrinsics
8594^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8595
8596LLVM provides an second experimental set of intrinsics for describing garbage
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00008597collection safepoints in compiled code. These intrinsics are an alternative
8598to the ``llvm.gcroot`` intrinsics, but are compatible with the ones for
8599:ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers. The
8600differences in approach are covered in the `Garbage Collection with LLVM
8601<GarbageCollection.html>`_ documentation. The intrinsics themselves are
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00008602described in :doc:`Statepoints`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008603
8604.. _int_gcroot:
8605
8606'``llvm.gcroot``' Intrinsic
8607^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8608
8609Syntax:
8610"""""""
8611
8612::
8613
8614 declare void @llvm.gcroot(i8** %ptrloc, i8* %metadata)
8615
8616Overview:
8617"""""""""
8618
8619The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic declares the existence of a GC root to
8620the code generator, and allows some metadata to be associated with it.
8621
8622Arguments:
8623""""""""""
8624
8625The first argument specifies the address of a stack object that contains
8626the root pointer. The second pointer (which must be either a constant or
8627a global value address) contains the meta-data to be associated with the
8628root.
8629
8630Semantics:
8631""""""""""
8632
8633At runtime, a call to this intrinsic stores a null pointer into the
8634"ptrloc" location. At compile-time, the code generator generates
8635information to allow the runtime to find the pointer at GC safe points.
8636The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic may only be used in a function which
8637:ref:`specifies a GC algorithm <gc>`.
8638
8639.. _int_gcread:
8640
8641'``llvm.gcread``' Intrinsic
8642^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8643
8644Syntax:
8645"""""""
8646
8647::
8648
8649 declare i8* @llvm.gcread(i8* %ObjPtr, i8** %Ptr)
8650
8651Overview:
8652"""""""""
8653
8654The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic identifies reads of references from heap
8655locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require read
8656barriers.
8657
8658Arguments:
8659""""""""""
8660
8661The second argument is the address to read from, which should be an
8662address allocated from the garbage collector. The first object is a
8663pointer to the start of the referenced object, if needed by the language
8664runtime (otherwise null).
8665
8666Semantics:
8667""""""""""
8668
8669The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a load
8670instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
8671the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcread``'
8672intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
8673algorithm <gc>`.
8674
8675.. _int_gcwrite:
8676
8677'``llvm.gcwrite``' Intrinsic
8678^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8679
8680Syntax:
8681"""""""
8682
8683::
8684
8685 declare void @llvm.gcwrite(i8* %P1, i8* %Obj, i8** %P2)
8686
8687Overview:
8688"""""""""
8689
8690The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic identifies writes of references to heap
8691locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require write
8692barriers (such as generational or reference counting collectors).
8693
8694Arguments:
8695""""""""""
8696
8697The first argument is the reference to store, the second is the start of
8698the object to store it to, and the third is the address of the field of
8699Obj to store to. If the runtime does not require a pointer to the
8700object, Obj may be null.
8701
8702Semantics:
8703""""""""""
8704
8705The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a store
8706instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
8707the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcwrite``'
8708intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
8709algorithm <gc>`.
8710
8711Code Generator Intrinsics
8712-------------------------
8713
8714These intrinsics are provided by LLVM to expose special features that
8715may only be implemented with code generator support.
8716
8717'``llvm.returnaddress``' Intrinsic
8718^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8719
8720Syntax:
8721"""""""
8722
8723::
8724
8725 declare i8 *@llvm.returnaddress(i32 <level>)
8726
8727Overview:
8728"""""""""
8729
8730The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic attempts to compute a
8731target-specific value indicating the return address of the current
8732function or one of its callers.
8733
8734Arguments:
8735""""""""""
8736
8737The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
8738address for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates its
8739caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
8740value.
8741
8742Semantics:
8743""""""""""
8744
8745The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
8746indicating the return address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
8747cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
8748be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
8749used for debugging purposes.
8750
8751Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
8752other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
8753of the obvious source-language caller.
8754
8755'``llvm.frameaddress``' Intrinsic
8756^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8757
8758Syntax:
8759"""""""
8760
8761::
8762
8763 declare i8* @llvm.frameaddress(i32 <level>)
8764
8765Overview:
8766"""""""""
8767
8768The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic attempts to return the
8769target-specific frame pointer value for the specified stack frame.
8770
8771Arguments:
8772""""""""""
8773
8774The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
8775frame pointer for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates
8776its caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
8777value.
8778
8779Semantics:
8780""""""""""
8781
8782The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
8783indicating the frame address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
8784cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
8785be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
8786used for debugging purposes.
8787
8788Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
8789other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
8790of the obvious source-language caller.
8791
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00008792'``llvm.localescape``' and '``llvm.localrecover``' Intrinsics
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00008793^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8794
8795Syntax:
8796"""""""
8797
8798::
8799
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00008800 declare void @llvm.localescape(...)
8801 declare i8* @llvm.localrecover(i8* %func, i8* %fp, i32 %idx)
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00008802
8803Overview:
8804"""""""""
8805
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00008806The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic escapes offsets of a collection of static
8807allocas, and the '``llvm.localrecover``' intrinsic applies those offsets to a
Reid Klecknercfb9ce52015-03-05 18:26:34 +00008808live frame pointer to recover the address of the allocation. The offset is
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00008809computed during frame layout of the caller of ``llvm.localescape``.
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00008810
8811Arguments:
8812""""""""""
8813
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00008814All arguments to '``llvm.localescape``' must be pointers to static allocas or
8815casts of static allocas. Each function can only call '``llvm.localescape``'
Reid Klecknercfb9ce52015-03-05 18:26:34 +00008816once, and it can only do so from the entry block.
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00008817
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00008818The ``func`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a constant
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00008819bitcasted pointer to a function defined in the current module. The code
8820generator cannot determine the frame allocation offset of functions defined in
8821other modules.
8822
Reid Klecknerd5afc62f2015-07-07 23:23:03 +00008823The ``fp`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a frame pointer of a
8824call frame that is currently live. The return value of '``llvm.localaddress``'
8825is one way to produce such a value, but various runtimes also expose a suitable
8826pointer in platform-specific ways.
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00008827
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00008828The ``idx`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' indicates which alloca passed to
8829'``llvm.localescape``' to recover. It is zero-indexed.
Reid Klecknercfb9ce52015-03-05 18:26:34 +00008830
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00008831Semantics:
8832""""""""""
8833
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00008834These intrinsics allow a group of functions to share access to a set of local
8835stack allocations of a one parent function. The parent function may call the
8836'``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic once from the function entry block, and the
8837child functions can use '``llvm.localrecover``' to access the escaped allocas.
8838The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic blocks inlining, as inlining changes where
8839the escaped allocas are allocated, which would break attempts to use
8840'``llvm.localrecover``'.
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00008841
Renato Golinc7aea402014-05-06 16:51:25 +00008842.. _int_read_register:
8843.. _int_write_register:
8844
8845'``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' Intrinsics
8846^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8847
8848Syntax:
8849"""""""
8850
8851::
8852
8853 declare i32 @llvm.read_register.i32(metadata)
8854 declare i64 @llvm.read_register.i64(metadata)
8855 declare void @llvm.write_register.i32(metadata, i32 @value)
8856 declare void @llvm.write_register.i64(metadata, i64 @value)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00008857 !0 = !{!"sp\00"}
Renato Golinc7aea402014-05-06 16:51:25 +00008858
8859Overview:
8860"""""""""
8861
8862The '``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsics
8863provides access to the named register. The register must be valid on
8864the architecture being compiled to. The type needs to be compatible
8865with the register being read.
8866
8867Semantics:
8868""""""""""
8869
8870The '``llvm.read_register``' intrinsic returns the current value of the
8871register, where possible. The '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsic sets
8872the current value of the register, where possible.
8873
8874This is useful to implement named register global variables that need
8875to always be mapped to a specific register, as is common practice on
8876bare-metal programs including OS kernels.
8877
8878The compiler doesn't check for register availability or use of the used
8879register in surrounding code, including inline assembly. Because of that,
8880allocatable registers are not supported.
8881
8882Warning: So far it only works with the stack pointer on selected
Tim Northover3b0846e2014-05-24 12:50:23 +00008883architectures (ARM, AArch64, PowerPC and x86_64). Significant amount of
Renato Golinc7aea402014-05-06 16:51:25 +00008884work is needed to support other registers and even more so, allocatable
8885registers.
8886
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008887.. _int_stacksave:
8888
8889'``llvm.stacksave``' Intrinsic
8890^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8891
8892Syntax:
8893"""""""
8894
8895::
8896
8897 declare i8* @llvm.stacksave()
8898
8899Overview:
8900"""""""""
8901
8902The '``llvm.stacksave``' intrinsic is used to remember the current state
8903of the function stack, for use with
8904:ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. This is useful for
8905implementing language features like scoped automatic variable sized
8906arrays in C99.
8907
8908Semantics:
8909""""""""""
8910
8911This intrinsic returns a opaque pointer value that can be passed to
8912:ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. When an
8913``llvm.stackrestore`` intrinsic is executed with a value saved from
8914``llvm.stacksave``, it effectively restores the state of the stack to
8915the state it was in when the ``llvm.stacksave`` intrinsic executed. In
8916practice, this pops any :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>` blocks from the stack that
8917were allocated after the ``llvm.stacksave`` was executed.
8918
8919.. _int_stackrestore:
8920
8921'``llvm.stackrestore``' Intrinsic
8922^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8923
8924Syntax:
8925"""""""
8926
8927::
8928
8929 declare void @llvm.stackrestore(i8* %ptr)
8930
8931Overview:
8932"""""""""
8933
8934The '``llvm.stackrestore``' intrinsic is used to restore the state of
8935the function stack to the state it was in when the corresponding
8936:ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` intrinsic executed. This is
8937useful for implementing language features like scoped automatic variable
8938sized arrays in C99.
8939
8940Semantics:
8941""""""""""
8942
8943See the description for :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>`.
8944
8945'``llvm.prefetch``' Intrinsic
8946^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8947
8948Syntax:
8949"""""""
8950
8951::
8952
8953 declare void @llvm.prefetch(i8* <address>, i32 <rw>, i32 <locality>, i32 <cache type>)
8954
8955Overview:
8956"""""""""
8957
8958The '``llvm.prefetch``' intrinsic is a hint to the code generator to
8959insert a prefetch instruction if supported; otherwise, it is a noop.
8960Prefetches have no effect on the behavior of the program but can change
8961its performance characteristics.
8962
8963Arguments:
8964""""""""""
8965
8966``address`` is the address to be prefetched, ``rw`` is the specifier
8967determining if the fetch should be for a read (0) or write (1), and
8968``locality`` is a temporal locality specifier ranging from (0) - no
8969locality, to (3) - extremely local keep in cache. The ``cache type``
8970specifies whether the prefetch is performed on the data (1) or
8971instruction (0) cache. The ``rw``, ``locality`` and ``cache type``
8972arguments must be constant integers.
8973
8974Semantics:
8975""""""""""
8976
8977This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. In
8978particular, prefetches cannot trap and do not produce a value. On
8979targets that support this intrinsic, the prefetch can provide hints to
8980the processor cache for better performance.
8981
8982'``llvm.pcmarker``' Intrinsic
8983^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8984
8985Syntax:
8986"""""""
8987
8988::
8989
8990 declare void @llvm.pcmarker(i32 <id>)
8991
8992Overview:
8993"""""""""
8994
8995The '``llvm.pcmarker``' intrinsic is a method to export a Program
8996Counter (PC) in a region of code to simulators and other tools. The
8997method is target specific, but it is expected that the marker will use
8998exported symbols to transmit the PC of the marker. The marker makes no
8999guarantees that it will remain with any specific instruction after
9000optimizations. It is possible that the presence of a marker will inhibit
9001optimizations. The intended use is to be inserted after optimizations to
9002allow correlations of simulation runs.
9003
9004Arguments:
9005""""""""""
9006
9007``id`` is a numerical id identifying the marker.
9008
9009Semantics:
9010""""""""""
9011
9012This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. Backends
9013that do not support this intrinsic may ignore it.
9014
9015'``llvm.readcyclecounter``' Intrinsic
9016^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9017
9018Syntax:
9019"""""""
9020
9021::
9022
9023 declare i64 @llvm.readcyclecounter()
9024
9025Overview:
9026"""""""""
9027
9028The '``llvm.readcyclecounter``' intrinsic provides access to the cycle
9029counter register (or similar low latency, high accuracy clocks) on those
9030targets that support it. On X86, it should map to RDTSC. On Alpha, it
9031should map to RPCC. As the backing counters overflow quickly (on the
9032order of 9 seconds on alpha), this should only be used for small
9033timings.
9034
9035Semantics:
9036""""""""""
9037
9038When directly supported, reading the cycle counter should not modify any
9039memory. Implementations are allowed to either return a application
9040specific value or a system wide value. On backends without support, this
9041is lowered to a constant 0.
9042
Tim Northoverbc933082013-05-23 19:11:20 +00009043Note that runtime support may be conditional on the privilege-level code is
9044running at and the host platform.
9045
Renato Golinc0a3c1d2014-03-26 12:52:28 +00009046'``llvm.clear_cache``' Intrinsic
9047^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9048
9049Syntax:
9050"""""""
9051
9052::
9053
9054 declare void @llvm.clear_cache(i8*, i8*)
9055
9056Overview:
9057"""""""""
9058
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +00009059The '``llvm.clear_cache``' intrinsic ensures visibility of modifications
9060in the specified range to the execution unit of the processor. On
9061targets with non-unified instruction and data cache, the implementation
9062flushes the instruction cache.
Renato Golinc0a3c1d2014-03-26 12:52:28 +00009063
9064Semantics:
9065""""""""""
9066
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +00009067On platforms with coherent instruction and data caches (e.g. x86), this
9068intrinsic is a nop. On platforms with non-coherent instruction and data
Alp Toker16f98b22014-04-09 14:47:27 +00009069cache (e.g. ARM, MIPS), the intrinsic is lowered either to appropriate
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +00009070instructions or a system call, if cache flushing requires special
9071privileges.
Renato Golinc0a3c1d2014-03-26 12:52:28 +00009072
Sean Silvad02bf3e2014-04-07 22:29:53 +00009073The default behavior is to emit a call to ``__clear_cache`` from the run
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +00009074time library.
Renato Golin93010e62014-03-26 14:01:32 +00009075
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +00009076This instrinsic does *not* empty the instruction pipeline. Modifications
9077of the current function are outside the scope of the intrinsic.
Renato Golinc0a3c1d2014-03-26 12:52:28 +00009078
Justin Bogner61ba2e32014-12-08 18:02:35 +00009079'``llvm.instrprof_increment``' Intrinsic
9080^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9081
9082Syntax:
9083"""""""
9084
9085::
9086
9087 declare void @llvm.instrprof_increment(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
9088 i32 <num-counters>, i32 <index>)
9089
9090Overview:
9091"""""""""
9092
9093The '``llvm.instrprof_increment``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
9094frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. These will be
9095lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate execution counts of a
9096program at runtime.
9097
9098Arguments:
9099""""""""""
9100
9101The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
9102name of the entity being instrumented. This should generally be the
9103(mangled) function name for a set of counters.
9104
9105The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
9106of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source, and
9107the third is the number of counters associated with ``name``. It is an
9108error if ``hash`` or ``num-counters`` differ between two instances of
9109``instrprof_increment`` that refer to the same name.
9110
9111The last argument refers to which of the counters for ``name`` should
9112be incremented. It should be a value between 0 and ``num-counters``.
9113
9114Semantics:
9115""""""""""
9116
9117This intrinsic represents an increment of a profiling counter. It will
9118cause the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate the appropriate data
9119structures and the code to increment the appropriate value, in a
9120format that can be written out by a compiler runtime and consumed via
9121the ``llvm-profdata`` tool.
9122
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009123Standard C Library Intrinsics
9124-----------------------------
9125
9126LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important standard C library
9127functions. These intrinsics allow source-language front-ends to pass
9128information about the alignment of the pointer arguments to the code
9129generator, providing opportunity for more efficient code generation.
9130
9131.. _int_memcpy:
9132
9133'``llvm.memcpy``' Intrinsic
9134^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9135
9136Syntax:
9137"""""""
9138
9139This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memcpy`` on any
9140integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
9141support all bit widths however.
9142
9143::
9144
9145 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
9146 i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9147 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
9148 i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9149
9150Overview:
9151"""""""""
9152
9153The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
9154source location to the destination location.
9155
9156Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memcpy.*``
9157intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra alignment/isvolatile
9158arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
9159
9160Arguments:
9161""""""""""
9162
9163The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
9164pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
9165specifying the number of bytes to copy, the fourth argument is the
9166alignment of the source and destination locations, and the fifth is a
9167boolean indicating a volatile access.
9168
9169If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1,
9170then the caller guarantees that both the source and destination pointers
9171are aligned to that boundary.
9172
9173If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memcpy`` call is
9174a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
9175very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
9176
9177Semantics:
9178""""""""""
9179
9180The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
9181source location to the destination location, which are not allowed to
9182overlap. It copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known
9183to be aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth
Bill Wendling61163152013-10-18 23:26:55 +00009184argument, otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009185
9186'``llvm.memmove``' Intrinsic
9187^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9188
9189Syntax:
9190"""""""
9191
9192This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memmove on any integer
9193bit width and for different address space. Not all targets support all
9194bit widths however.
9195
9196::
9197
9198 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
9199 i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9200 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
9201 i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9202
9203Overview:
9204"""""""""
9205
9206The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics move a block of memory from the
9207source location to the destination location. It is similar to the
9208'``llvm.memcpy``' intrinsic but allows the two memory locations to
9209overlap.
9210
9211Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memmove.*``
9212intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra alignment/isvolatile
9213arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
9214
9215Arguments:
9216""""""""""
9217
9218The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
9219pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
9220specifying the number of bytes to copy, the fourth argument is the
9221alignment of the source and destination locations, and the fifth is a
9222boolean indicating a volatile access.
9223
9224If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1,
9225then the caller guarantees that the source and destination pointers are
9226aligned to that boundary.
9227
9228If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memmove`` call
9229is a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is
9230not very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
9231
9232Semantics:
9233""""""""""
9234
9235The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
9236source location to the destination location, which may overlap. It
9237copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known to be
9238aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument,
Bill Wendling61163152013-10-18 23:26:55 +00009239otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009240
9241'``llvm.memset.*``' Intrinsics
9242^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9243
9244Syntax:
9245"""""""
9246
9247This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memset on any integer
9248bit width and for different address spaces. However, not all targets
9249support all bit widths.
9250
9251::
9252
9253 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
9254 i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9255 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
9256 i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9257
9258Overview:
9259"""""""""
9260
9261The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill a block of memory with a
9262particular byte value.
9263
9264Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memset``
9265intrinsic does not return a value and takes extra alignment/volatile
9266arguments. Also, the destination can be in an arbitrary address space.
9267
9268Arguments:
9269""""""""""
9270
9271The first argument is a pointer to the destination to fill, the second
9272is the byte value with which to fill it, the third argument is an
9273integer argument specifying the number of bytes to fill, and the fourth
9274argument is the known alignment of the destination location.
9275
9276If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1,
9277then the caller guarantees that the destination pointer is aligned to
9278that boundary.
9279
9280If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memset`` call is
9281a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
9282very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
9283
9284Semantics:
9285""""""""""
9286
9287The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill "len" bytes of memory starting
9288at the destination location. If the argument is known to be aligned to
9289some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument, otherwise
Bill Wendling61163152013-10-18 23:26:55 +00009290it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009291
9292'``llvm.sqrt.*``' Intrinsic
9293^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9294
9295Syntax:
9296"""""""
9297
9298This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sqrt`` on any
9299floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9300all types however.
9301
9302::
9303
9304 declare float @llvm.sqrt.f32(float %Val)
9305 declare double @llvm.sqrt.f64(double %Val)
9306 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sqrt.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9307 declare fp128 @llvm.sqrt.f128(fp128 %Val)
9308 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sqrt.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9309
9310Overview:
9311"""""""""
9312
9313The '``llvm.sqrt``' intrinsics return the sqrt of the specified operand,
9314returning the same value as the libm '``sqrt``' functions would. Unlike
9315``sqrt`` in libm, however, ``llvm.sqrt`` has undefined behavior for
9316negative numbers other than -0.0 (which allows for better optimization,
9317because there is no need to worry about errno being set).
9318``llvm.sqrt(-0.0)`` is defined to return -0.0 like IEEE sqrt.
9319
9320Arguments:
9321""""""""""
9322
9323The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9324type.
9325
9326Semantics:
9327""""""""""
9328
9329This function returns the sqrt of the specified operand if it is a
9330nonnegative floating point number.
9331
9332'``llvm.powi.*``' Intrinsic
9333^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9334
9335Syntax:
9336"""""""
9337
9338This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.powi`` on any
9339floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9340all types however.
9341
9342::
9343
9344 declare float @llvm.powi.f32(float %Val, i32 %power)
9345 declare double @llvm.powi.f64(double %Val, i32 %power)
9346 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.powi.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, i32 %power)
9347 declare fp128 @llvm.powi.f128(fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
9348 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.powi.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
9349
9350Overview:
9351"""""""""
9352
9353The '``llvm.powi.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
9354specified (positive or negative) power. The order of evaluation of
9355multiplications is not defined. When a vector of floating point type is
9356used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value.
9357
9358Arguments:
9359""""""""""
9360
9361The second argument is an integer power, and the first is a value to
9362raise to that power.
9363
9364Semantics:
9365""""""""""
9366
9367This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an
9368unspecified sequence of rounding operations.
9369
9370'``llvm.sin.*``' Intrinsic
9371^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9372
9373Syntax:
9374"""""""
9375
9376This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sin`` on any
9377floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9378all types however.
9379
9380::
9381
9382 declare float @llvm.sin.f32(float %Val)
9383 declare double @llvm.sin.f64(double %Val)
9384 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sin.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9385 declare fp128 @llvm.sin.f128(fp128 %Val)
9386 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sin.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9387
9388Overview:
9389"""""""""
9390
9391The '``llvm.sin.*``' intrinsics return the sine of the operand.
9392
9393Arguments:
9394""""""""""
9395
9396The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9397type.
9398
9399Semantics:
9400""""""""""
9401
9402This function returns the sine of the specified operand, returning the
9403same values as the libm ``sin`` functions would, and handles error
9404conditions in the same way.
9405
9406'``llvm.cos.*``' Intrinsic
9407^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9408
9409Syntax:
9410"""""""
9411
9412This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cos`` on any
9413floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9414all types however.
9415
9416::
9417
9418 declare float @llvm.cos.f32(float %Val)
9419 declare double @llvm.cos.f64(double %Val)
9420 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.cos.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9421 declare fp128 @llvm.cos.f128(fp128 %Val)
9422 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.cos.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9423
9424Overview:
9425"""""""""
9426
9427The '``llvm.cos.*``' intrinsics return the cosine of the operand.
9428
9429Arguments:
9430""""""""""
9431
9432The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9433type.
9434
9435Semantics:
9436""""""""""
9437
9438This function returns the cosine of the specified operand, returning the
9439same values as the libm ``cos`` functions would, and handles error
9440conditions in the same way.
9441
9442'``llvm.pow.*``' Intrinsic
9443^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9444
9445Syntax:
9446"""""""
9447
9448This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.pow`` on any
9449floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9450all types however.
9451
9452::
9453
9454 declare float @llvm.pow.f32(float %Val, float %Power)
9455 declare double @llvm.pow.f64(double %Val, double %Power)
9456 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.pow.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, x86_fp80 %Power)
9457 declare fp128 @llvm.pow.f128(fp128 %Val, fp128 %Power)
9458 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.pow.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, ppc_fp128 Power)
9459
9460Overview:
9461"""""""""
9462
9463The '``llvm.pow.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
9464specified (positive or negative) power.
9465
9466Arguments:
9467""""""""""
9468
9469The second argument is a floating point power, and the first is a value
9470to raise to that power.
9471
9472Semantics:
9473""""""""""
9474
9475This function returns the first value raised to the second power,
9476returning the same values as the libm ``pow`` functions would, and
9477handles error conditions in the same way.
9478
9479'``llvm.exp.*``' Intrinsic
9480^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9481
9482Syntax:
9483"""""""
9484
9485This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp`` on any
9486floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9487all types however.
9488
9489::
9490
9491 declare float @llvm.exp.f32(float %Val)
9492 declare double @llvm.exp.f64(double %Val)
9493 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9494 declare fp128 @llvm.exp.f128(fp128 %Val)
9495 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9496
9497Overview:
9498"""""""""
9499
9500The '``llvm.exp.*``' intrinsics perform the exp function.
9501
9502Arguments:
9503""""""""""
9504
9505The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9506type.
9507
9508Semantics:
9509""""""""""
9510
9511This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp`` functions
9512would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
9513
9514'``llvm.exp2.*``' Intrinsic
9515^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9516
9517Syntax:
9518"""""""
9519
9520This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp2`` on any
9521floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9522all types however.
9523
9524::
9525
9526 declare float @llvm.exp2.f32(float %Val)
9527 declare double @llvm.exp2.f64(double %Val)
9528 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9529 declare fp128 @llvm.exp2.f128(fp128 %Val)
9530 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9531
9532Overview:
9533"""""""""
9534
9535The '``llvm.exp2.*``' intrinsics perform the exp2 function.
9536
9537Arguments:
9538""""""""""
9539
9540The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9541type.
9542
9543Semantics:
9544""""""""""
9545
9546This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp2`` functions
9547would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
9548
9549'``llvm.log.*``' Intrinsic
9550^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9551
9552Syntax:
9553"""""""
9554
9555This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log`` on any
9556floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9557all types however.
9558
9559::
9560
9561 declare float @llvm.log.f32(float %Val)
9562 declare double @llvm.log.f64(double %Val)
9563 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9564 declare fp128 @llvm.log.f128(fp128 %Val)
9565 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9566
9567Overview:
9568"""""""""
9569
9570The '``llvm.log.*``' intrinsics perform the log function.
9571
9572Arguments:
9573""""""""""
9574
9575The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9576type.
9577
9578Semantics:
9579""""""""""
9580
9581This function returns the same values as the libm ``log`` functions
9582would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
9583
9584'``llvm.log10.*``' Intrinsic
9585^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9586
9587Syntax:
9588"""""""
9589
9590This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log10`` on any
9591floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9592all types however.
9593
9594::
9595
9596 declare float @llvm.log10.f32(float %Val)
9597 declare double @llvm.log10.f64(double %Val)
9598 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log10.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9599 declare fp128 @llvm.log10.f128(fp128 %Val)
9600 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log10.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9601
9602Overview:
9603"""""""""
9604
9605The '``llvm.log10.*``' intrinsics perform the log10 function.
9606
9607Arguments:
9608""""""""""
9609
9610The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9611type.
9612
9613Semantics:
9614""""""""""
9615
9616This function returns the same values as the libm ``log10`` functions
9617would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
9618
9619'``llvm.log2.*``' Intrinsic
9620^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9621
9622Syntax:
9623"""""""
9624
9625This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log2`` on any
9626floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9627all types however.
9628
9629::
9630
9631 declare float @llvm.log2.f32(float %Val)
9632 declare double @llvm.log2.f64(double %Val)
9633 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9634 declare fp128 @llvm.log2.f128(fp128 %Val)
9635 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9636
9637Overview:
9638"""""""""
9639
9640The '``llvm.log2.*``' intrinsics perform the log2 function.
9641
9642Arguments:
9643""""""""""
9644
9645The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9646type.
9647
9648Semantics:
9649""""""""""
9650
9651This function returns the same values as the libm ``log2`` functions
9652would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
9653
9654'``llvm.fma.*``' Intrinsic
9655^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9656
9657Syntax:
9658"""""""
9659
9660This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fma`` on any
9661floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9662all types however.
9663
9664::
9665
9666 declare float @llvm.fma.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
9667 declare double @llvm.fma.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
9668 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fma.f80(x86_fp80 %a, x86_fp80 %b, x86_fp80 %c)
9669 declare fp128 @llvm.fma.f128(fp128 %a, fp128 %b, fp128 %c)
9670 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fma.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %a, ppc_fp128 %b, ppc_fp128 %c)
9671
9672Overview:
9673"""""""""
9674
9675The '``llvm.fma.*``' intrinsics perform the fused multiply-add
9676operation.
9677
9678Arguments:
9679""""""""""
9680
9681The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9682type.
9683
9684Semantics:
9685""""""""""
9686
9687This function returns the same values as the libm ``fma`` functions
Matt Arsenaultee364ee2014-01-31 00:09:00 +00009688would, and does not set errno.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009689
9690'``llvm.fabs.*``' Intrinsic
9691^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9692
9693Syntax:
9694"""""""
9695
9696This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fabs`` on any
9697floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9698all types however.
9699
9700::
9701
9702 declare float @llvm.fabs.f32(float %Val)
9703 declare double @llvm.fabs.f64(double %Val)
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +00009704 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fabs.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009705 declare fp128 @llvm.fabs.f128(fp128 %Val)
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +00009706 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fabs.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009707
9708Overview:
9709"""""""""
9710
9711The '``llvm.fabs.*``' intrinsics return the absolute value of the
9712operand.
9713
9714Arguments:
9715""""""""""
9716
9717The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9718type.
9719
9720Semantics:
9721""""""""""
9722
9723This function returns the same values as the libm ``fabs`` functions
9724would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
9725
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +00009726'``llvm.minnum.*``' Intrinsic
Matt Arsenault9886b0d2014-10-22 00:15:53 +00009727^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +00009728
9729Syntax:
9730"""""""
9731
9732This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.minnum`` on any
9733floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9734all types however.
9735
9736::
9737
Matt Arsenault64313c92014-10-22 18:25:02 +00009738 declare float @llvm.minnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
9739 declare double @llvm.minnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
9740 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.minnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
9741 declare fp128 @llvm.minnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
9742 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.minnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +00009743
9744Overview:
9745"""""""""
9746
9747The '``llvm.minnum.*``' intrinsics return the minimum of the two
9748arguments.
9749
9750
9751Arguments:
9752""""""""""
9753
9754The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9755type.
9756
9757Semantics:
9758""""""""""
9759
9760Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for minNum, which also match for libm's
9761fmin.
9762
9763If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
9764NaN only if both operands are NaN. If the operands compare equal,
9765returns a value that compares equal to both operands. This means that
9766fmin(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could return either -0.0 or 0.0.
9767
9768'``llvm.maxnum.*``' Intrinsic
Matt Arsenault9886b0d2014-10-22 00:15:53 +00009769^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +00009770
9771Syntax:
9772"""""""
9773
9774This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.maxnum`` on any
9775floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9776all types however.
9777
9778::
9779
Matt Arsenault64313c92014-10-22 18:25:02 +00009780 declare float @llvm.maxnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1l)
9781 declare double @llvm.maxnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
9782 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.maxnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
9783 declare fp128 @llvm.maxnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
9784 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.maxnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +00009785
9786Overview:
9787"""""""""
9788
9789The '``llvm.maxnum.*``' intrinsics return the maximum of the two
9790arguments.
9791
9792
9793Arguments:
9794""""""""""
9795
9796The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9797type.
9798
9799Semantics:
9800""""""""""
9801Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for maxNum, which also match for libm's
9802fmax.
9803
9804If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
9805NaN only if both operands are NaN. If the operands compare equal,
9806returns a value that compares equal to both operands. This means that
9807fmax(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could return either -0.0 or 0.0.
9808
Hal Finkel0c5c01aa2013-08-19 23:35:46 +00009809'``llvm.copysign.*``' Intrinsic
9810^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9811
9812Syntax:
9813"""""""
9814
9815This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.copysign`` on any
9816floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9817all types however.
9818
9819::
9820
9821 declare float @llvm.copysign.f32(float %Mag, float %Sgn)
9822 declare double @llvm.copysign.f64(double %Mag, double %Sgn)
9823 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.copysign.f80(x86_fp80 %Mag, x86_fp80 %Sgn)
9824 declare fp128 @llvm.copysign.f128(fp128 %Mag, fp128 %Sgn)
9825 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.copysign.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Mag, ppc_fp128 %Sgn)
9826
9827Overview:
9828"""""""""
9829
9830The '``llvm.copysign.*``' intrinsics return a value with the magnitude of the
9831first operand and the sign of the second operand.
9832
9833Arguments:
9834""""""""""
9835
9836The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9837type.
9838
9839Semantics:
9840""""""""""
9841
9842This function returns the same values as the libm ``copysign``
9843functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
9844
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009845'``llvm.floor.*``' Intrinsic
9846^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9847
9848Syntax:
9849"""""""
9850
9851This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.floor`` on any
9852floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9853all types however.
9854
9855::
9856
9857 declare float @llvm.floor.f32(float %Val)
9858 declare double @llvm.floor.f64(double %Val)
9859 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.floor.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9860 declare fp128 @llvm.floor.f128(fp128 %Val)
9861 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.floor.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9862
9863Overview:
9864"""""""""
9865
9866The '``llvm.floor.*``' intrinsics return the floor of the operand.
9867
9868Arguments:
9869""""""""""
9870
9871The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9872type.
9873
9874Semantics:
9875""""""""""
9876
9877This function returns the same values as the libm ``floor`` functions
9878would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
9879
9880'``llvm.ceil.*``' Intrinsic
9881^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9882
9883Syntax:
9884"""""""
9885
9886This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ceil`` on any
9887floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9888all types however.
9889
9890::
9891
9892 declare float @llvm.ceil.f32(float %Val)
9893 declare double @llvm.ceil.f64(double %Val)
9894 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.ceil.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9895 declare fp128 @llvm.ceil.f128(fp128 %Val)
9896 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.ceil.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9897
9898Overview:
9899"""""""""
9900
9901The '``llvm.ceil.*``' intrinsics return the ceiling of the operand.
9902
9903Arguments:
9904""""""""""
9905
9906The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9907type.
9908
9909Semantics:
9910""""""""""
9911
9912This function returns the same values as the libm ``ceil`` functions
9913would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
9914
9915'``llvm.trunc.*``' Intrinsic
9916^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9917
9918Syntax:
9919"""""""
9920
9921This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.trunc`` on any
9922floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9923all types however.
9924
9925::
9926
9927 declare float @llvm.trunc.f32(float %Val)
9928 declare double @llvm.trunc.f64(double %Val)
9929 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.trunc.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9930 declare fp128 @llvm.trunc.f128(fp128 %Val)
9931 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.trunc.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9932
9933Overview:
9934"""""""""
9935
9936The '``llvm.trunc.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
9937nearest integer not larger in magnitude than the operand.
9938
9939Arguments:
9940""""""""""
9941
9942The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9943type.
9944
9945Semantics:
9946""""""""""
9947
9948This function returns the same values as the libm ``trunc`` functions
9949would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
9950
9951'``llvm.rint.*``' Intrinsic
9952^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9953
9954Syntax:
9955"""""""
9956
9957This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.rint`` on any
9958floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9959all types however.
9960
9961::
9962
9963 declare float @llvm.rint.f32(float %Val)
9964 declare double @llvm.rint.f64(double %Val)
9965 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.rint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9966 declare fp128 @llvm.rint.f128(fp128 %Val)
9967 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.rint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9968
9969Overview:
9970"""""""""
9971
9972The '``llvm.rint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
9973nearest integer. It may raise an inexact floating-point exception if the
9974operand isn't an integer.
9975
9976Arguments:
9977""""""""""
9978
9979The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9980type.
9981
9982Semantics:
9983""""""""""
9984
9985This function returns the same values as the libm ``rint`` functions
9986would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
9987
9988'``llvm.nearbyint.*``' Intrinsic
9989^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9990
9991Syntax:
9992"""""""
9993
9994This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.nearbyint`` on any
9995floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9996all types however.
9997
9998::
9999
10000 declare float @llvm.nearbyint.f32(float %Val)
10001 declare double @llvm.nearbyint.f64(double %Val)
10002 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.nearbyint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10003 declare fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.f128(fp128 %Val)
10004 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10005
10006Overview:
10007"""""""""
10008
10009The '``llvm.nearbyint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
10010nearest integer.
10011
10012Arguments:
10013""""""""""
10014
10015The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10016type.
10017
10018Semantics:
10019""""""""""
10020
10021This function returns the same values as the libm ``nearbyint``
10022functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10023
Hal Finkel171817e2013-08-07 22:49:12 +000010024'``llvm.round.*``' Intrinsic
10025^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10026
10027Syntax:
10028"""""""
10029
10030This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.round`` on any
10031floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10032all types however.
10033
10034::
10035
10036 declare float @llvm.round.f32(float %Val)
10037 declare double @llvm.round.f64(double %Val)
10038 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.round.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10039 declare fp128 @llvm.round.f128(fp128 %Val)
10040 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.round.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10041
10042Overview:
10043"""""""""
10044
10045The '``llvm.round.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
10046nearest integer.
10047
10048Arguments:
10049""""""""""
10050
10051The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10052type.
10053
10054Semantics:
10055""""""""""
10056
10057This function returns the same values as the libm ``round``
10058functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10059
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010060Bit Manipulation Intrinsics
10061---------------------------
10062
10063LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important bit manipulation
10064operations. These allow efficient code generation for some algorithms.
10065
10066'``llvm.bswap.*``' Intrinsics
10067^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10068
10069Syntax:
10070"""""""
10071
10072This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bswap on any
10073integer type that is an even number of bytes (i.e. BitWidth % 16 == 0).
10074
10075::
10076
10077 declare i16 @llvm.bswap.i16(i16 <id>)
10078 declare i32 @llvm.bswap.i32(i32 <id>)
10079 declare i64 @llvm.bswap.i64(i64 <id>)
10080
10081Overview:
10082"""""""""
10083
10084The '``llvm.bswap``' family of intrinsics is used to byte swap integer
10085values with an even number of bytes (positive multiple of 16 bits).
10086These are useful for performing operations on data that is not in the
10087target's native byte order.
10088
10089Semantics:
10090""""""""""
10091
10092The ``llvm.bswap.i16`` intrinsic returns an i16 value that has the high
10093and low byte of the input i16 swapped. Similarly, the ``llvm.bswap.i32``
10094intrinsic returns an i32 value that has the four bytes of the input i32
10095swapped, so that if the input bytes are numbered 0, 1, 2, 3 then the
10096returned i32 will have its bytes in 3, 2, 1, 0 order. The
10097``llvm.bswap.i48``, ``llvm.bswap.i64`` and other intrinsics extend this
10098concept to additional even-byte lengths (6 bytes, 8 bytes and more,
10099respectively).
10100
10101'``llvm.ctpop.*``' Intrinsic
10102^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10103
10104Syntax:
10105"""""""
10106
10107This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.ctpop on any integer
10108bit width, or on any vector with integer elements. Not all targets
10109support all bit widths or vector types, however.
10110
10111::
10112
10113 declare i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 <src>)
10114 declare i16 @llvm.ctpop.i16(i16 <src>)
10115 declare i32 @llvm.ctpop.i32(i32 <src>)
10116 declare i64 @llvm.ctpop.i64(i64 <src>)
10117 declare i256 @llvm.ctpop.i256(i256 <src>)
10118 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctpop.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>)
10119
10120Overview:
10121"""""""""
10122
10123The '``llvm.ctpop``' family of intrinsics counts the number of bits set
10124in a value.
10125
10126Arguments:
10127""""""""""
10128
10129The only argument is the value to be counted. The argument may be of any
10130integer type, or a vector with integer elements. The return type must
10131match the argument type.
10132
10133Semantics:
10134""""""""""
10135
10136The '``llvm.ctpop``' intrinsic counts the 1's in a variable, or within
10137each element of a vector.
10138
10139'``llvm.ctlz.*``' Intrinsic
10140^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10141
10142Syntax:
10143"""""""
10144
10145This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ctlz`` on any
10146integer bit width, or any vector whose elements are integers. Not all
10147targets support all bit widths or vector types, however.
10148
10149::
10150
10151 declare i8 @llvm.ctlz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10152 declare i16 @llvm.ctlz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10153 declare i32 @llvm.ctlz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10154 declare i64 @llvm.ctlz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10155 declare i256 @llvm.ctlz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10156 declase <2 x i32> @llvm.ctlz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10157
10158Overview:
10159"""""""""
10160
10161The '``llvm.ctlz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
10162leading zeros in a variable.
10163
10164Arguments:
10165""""""""""
10166
10167The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
Hal Finkel5dd82782015-01-05 04:05:21 +000010168any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010169type must match the first argument type.
10170
10171The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
10172the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
10173defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
10174defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
10175now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
10176
10177Semantics:
10178""""""""""
10179
10180The '``llvm.ctlz``' intrinsic counts the leading (most significant)
10181zeros in a variable, or within each element of the vector. If
10182``src == 0`` then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src``
10183if ``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
10184``llvm.ctlz(i32 2) = 30``.
10185
10186'``llvm.cttz.*``' Intrinsic
10187^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10188
10189Syntax:
10190"""""""
10191
10192This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cttz`` on any
10193integer bit width, or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
10194support all bit widths or vector types, however.
10195
10196::
10197
10198 declare i8 @llvm.cttz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10199 declare i16 @llvm.cttz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10200 declare i32 @llvm.cttz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10201 declare i64 @llvm.cttz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10202 declare i256 @llvm.cttz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10203 declase <2 x i32> @llvm.cttz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10204
10205Overview:
10206"""""""""
10207
10208The '``llvm.cttz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
10209trailing zeros.
10210
10211Arguments:
10212""""""""""
10213
10214The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
Hal Finkel5dd82782015-01-05 04:05:21 +000010215any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010216type must match the first argument type.
10217
10218The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
10219the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
10220defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
10221defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
10222now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
10223
10224Semantics:
10225""""""""""
10226
10227The '``llvm.cttz``' intrinsic counts the trailing (least significant)
10228zeros in a variable, or within each element of a vector. If ``src == 0``
10229then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src`` if
10230``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
10231``llvm.cttz(2) = 1``.
10232
Philip Reames34843ae2015-03-05 05:55:55 +000010233.. _int_overflow:
10234
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010235Arithmetic with Overflow Intrinsics
10236-----------------------------------
10237
10238LLVM provides intrinsics for some arithmetic with overflow operations.
10239
10240'``llvm.sadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
10241^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10242
10243Syntax:
10244"""""""
10245
10246This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``
10247on any integer bit width.
10248
10249::
10250
10251 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
10252 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10253 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
10254
10255Overview:
10256"""""""""
10257
10258The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
10259a signed addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether an overflow
10260occurred during the signed summation.
10261
10262Arguments:
10263""""""""""
10264
10265The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
10266may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
10267bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
10268``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
10269addition.
10270
10271Semantics:
10272""""""""""
10273
10274The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000010275a signed addition of the two variables. They return a structure --- the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010276first element of which is the signed summation, and the second element
10277of which is a bit specifying if the signed summation resulted in an
10278overflow.
10279
10280Examples:
10281"""""""""
10282
10283.. code-block:: llvm
10284
10285 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10286 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
10287 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
10288 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
10289
10290'``llvm.uadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
10291^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10292
10293Syntax:
10294"""""""
10295
10296This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``
10297on any integer bit width.
10298
10299::
10300
10301 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
10302 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10303 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
10304
10305Overview:
10306"""""""""
10307
10308The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
10309an unsigned addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether a carry
10310occurred during the unsigned summation.
10311
10312Arguments:
10313""""""""""
10314
10315The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
10316may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
10317bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
10318``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
10319addition.
10320
10321Semantics:
10322""""""""""
10323
10324The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000010325an unsigned addition of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010326first element of which is the sum, and the second element of which is a
10327bit specifying if the unsigned summation resulted in a carry.
10328
10329Examples:
10330"""""""""
10331
10332.. code-block:: llvm
10333
10334 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10335 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
10336 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
10337 br i1 %obit, label %carry, label %normal
10338
10339'``llvm.ssub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
10340^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10341
10342Syntax:
10343"""""""
10344
10345This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``
10346on any integer bit width.
10347
10348::
10349
10350 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
10351 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10352 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
10353
10354Overview:
10355"""""""""
10356
10357The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
10358a signed subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
10359overflow occurred during the signed subtraction.
10360
10361Arguments:
10362""""""""""
10363
10364The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
10365may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
10366bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
10367``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
10368subtraction.
10369
10370Semantics:
10371""""""""""
10372
10373The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000010374a signed subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010375first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
10376which is a bit specifying if the signed subtraction resulted in an
10377overflow.
10378
10379Examples:
10380"""""""""
10381
10382.. code-block:: llvm
10383
10384 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10385 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
10386 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
10387 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
10388
10389'``llvm.usub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
10390^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10391
10392Syntax:
10393"""""""
10394
10395This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.usub.with.overflow``
10396on any integer bit width.
10397
10398::
10399
10400 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
10401 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10402 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
10403
10404Overview:
10405"""""""""
10406
10407The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
10408an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
10409overflow occurred during the unsigned subtraction.
10410
10411Arguments:
10412""""""""""
10413
10414The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
10415may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
10416bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
10417``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
10418subtraction.
10419
10420Semantics:
10421""""""""""
10422
10423The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000010424an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010425the first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
10426which is a bit specifying if the unsigned subtraction resulted in an
10427overflow.
10428
10429Examples:
10430"""""""""
10431
10432.. code-block:: llvm
10433
10434 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10435 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
10436 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
10437 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
10438
10439'``llvm.smul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
10440^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10441
10442Syntax:
10443"""""""
10444
10445This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.smul.with.overflow``
10446on any integer bit width.
10447
10448::
10449
10450 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
10451 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10452 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
10453
10454Overview:
10455"""""""""
10456
10457The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
10458a signed multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
10459overflow occurred during the signed multiplication.
10460
10461Arguments:
10462""""""""""
10463
10464The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
10465may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
10466bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
10467``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
10468multiplication.
10469
10470Semantics:
10471""""""""""
10472
10473The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000010474a signed multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010475the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second element
10476of which is a bit specifying if the signed multiplication resulted in an
10477overflow.
10478
10479Examples:
10480"""""""""
10481
10482.. code-block:: llvm
10483
10484 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10485 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
10486 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
10487 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
10488
10489'``llvm.umul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
10490^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10491
10492Syntax:
10493"""""""
10494
10495This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.umul.with.overflow``
10496on any integer bit width.
10497
10498::
10499
10500 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
10501 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10502 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
10503
10504Overview:
10505"""""""""
10506
10507The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
10508a unsigned multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
10509overflow occurred during the unsigned multiplication.
10510
10511Arguments:
10512""""""""""
10513
10514The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
10515may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
10516bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
10517``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
10518multiplication.
10519
10520Semantics:
10521""""""""""
10522
10523The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000010524an unsigned multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
10525the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010526element of which is a bit specifying if the unsigned multiplication
10527resulted in an overflow.
10528
10529Examples:
10530"""""""""
10531
10532.. code-block:: llvm
10533
10534 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10535 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
10536 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
10537 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
10538
10539Specialised Arithmetic Intrinsics
10540---------------------------------
10541
10542'``llvm.fmuladd.*``' Intrinsic
10543^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10544
10545Syntax:
10546"""""""
10547
10548::
10549
10550 declare float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
10551 declare double @llvm.fmuladd.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
10552
10553Overview:
10554"""""""""
10555
10556The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsic functions represent multiply-add
Lang Hames045f4392013-01-17 00:00:49 +000010557expressions that can be fused if the code generator determines that (a) the
10558target instruction set has support for a fused operation, and (b) that the
10559fused operation is more efficient than the equivalent, separate pair of mul
10560and add instructions.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010561
10562Arguments:
10563""""""""""
10564
10565The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsics each take three arguments: two
10566multiplicands, a and b, and an addend c.
10567
10568Semantics:
10569""""""""""
10570
10571The expression:
10572
10573::
10574
10575 %0 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(%a, %b, %c)
10576
10577is equivalent to the expression a \* b + c, except that rounding will
10578not be performed between the multiplication and addition steps if the
10579code generator fuses the operations. Fusion is not guaranteed, even if
10580the target platform supports it. If a fused multiply-add is required the
Matt Arsenaultee364ee2014-01-31 00:09:00 +000010581corresponding llvm.fma.\* intrinsic function should be used
10582instead. This never sets errno, just as '``llvm.fma.*``'.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010583
10584Examples:
10585"""""""""
10586
10587.. code-block:: llvm
10588
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +000010589 %r2 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c) ; yields float:r2 = (a * b) + c
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010590
10591Half Precision Floating Point Intrinsics
10592----------------------------------------
10593
10594For most target platforms, half precision floating point is a
10595storage-only format. This means that it is a dense encoding (in memory)
10596but does not support computation in the format.
10597
10598This means that code must first load the half-precision floating point
10599value as an i16, then convert it to float with
10600:ref:`llvm.convert.from.fp16 <int_convert_from_fp16>`. Computation can
10601then be performed on the float value (including extending to double
10602etc). To store the value back to memory, it is first converted to float
10603if needed, then converted to i16 with
10604:ref:`llvm.convert.to.fp16 <int_convert_to_fp16>`, then storing as an
10605i16 value.
10606
10607.. _int_convert_to_fp16:
10608
10609'``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' Intrinsic
10610^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10611
10612Syntax:
10613"""""""
10614
10615::
10616
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000010617 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
10618 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f64(double %a)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010619
10620Overview:
10621"""""""""
10622
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000010623The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
10624conventional floating point type to half precision floating point format.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010625
10626Arguments:
10627""""""""""
10628
10629The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
10630converted.
10631
10632Semantics:
10633""""""""""
10634
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000010635The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
10636conventional floating point format to half precision floating point format. The
10637return value is an ``i16`` which contains the converted number.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010638
10639Examples:
10640"""""""""
10641
10642.. code-block:: llvm
10643
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000010644 %res = call i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010645 store i16 %res, i16* @x, align 2
10646
10647.. _int_convert_from_fp16:
10648
10649'``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' Intrinsic
10650^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10651
10652Syntax:
10653"""""""
10654
10655::
10656
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000010657 declare float @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f32(i16 %a)
10658 declare double @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f64(i16 %a)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010659
10660Overview:
10661"""""""""
10662
10663The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
10664conversion from half precision floating point format to single precision
10665floating point format.
10666
10667Arguments:
10668""""""""""
10669
10670The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
10671converted.
10672
10673Semantics:
10674""""""""""
10675
10676The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
10677conversion from half single precision floating point format to single
10678precision floating point format. The input half-float value is
10679represented by an ``i16`` value.
10680
10681Examples:
10682"""""""""
10683
10684.. code-block:: llvm
10685
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +000010686 %a = load i16, i16* @x, align 2
Matt Arsenault3e3ddda2014-07-10 03:22:16 +000010687 %res = call float @llvm.convert.from.fp16(i16 %a)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010688
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +000010689.. _dbg_intrinsics:
10690
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010691Debugger Intrinsics
10692-------------------
10693
10694The LLVM debugger intrinsics (which all start with ``llvm.dbg.``
10695prefix), are described in the `LLVM Source Level
10696Debugging <SourceLevelDebugging.html#format_common_intrinsics>`_
10697document.
10698
10699Exception Handling Intrinsics
10700-----------------------------
10701
10702The LLVM exception handling intrinsics (which all start with
10703``llvm.eh.`` prefix), are described in the `LLVM Exception
10704Handling <ExceptionHandling.html#format_common_intrinsics>`_ document.
10705
10706.. _int_trampoline:
10707
10708Trampoline Intrinsics
10709---------------------
10710
10711These intrinsics make it possible to excise one parameter, marked with
10712the :ref:`nest <nest>` attribute, from a function. The result is a
10713callable function pointer lacking the nest parameter - the caller does
10714not need to provide a value for it. Instead, the value to use is stored
10715in advance in a "trampoline", a block of memory usually allocated on the
10716stack, which also contains code to splice the nest value into the
10717argument list. This is used to implement the GCC nested function address
10718extension.
10719
10720For example, if the function is ``i32 f(i8* nest %c, i32 %x, i32 %y)``
10721then the resulting function pointer has signature ``i32 (i32, i32)*``.
10722It can be created as follows:
10723
10724.. code-block:: llvm
10725
10726 %tramp = alloca [10 x i8], align 4 ; size and alignment only correct for X86
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +000010727 %tramp1 = getelementptr [10 x i8], [10 x i8]* %tramp, i32 0, i32 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010728 call i8* @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* %tramp1, i8* bitcast (i32 (i8*, i32, i32)* @f to i8*), i8* %nval)
10729 %p = call i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* %tramp1)
10730 %fp = bitcast i8* %p to i32 (i32, i32)*
10731
10732The call ``%val = call i32 %fp(i32 %x, i32 %y)`` is then equivalent to
10733``%val = call i32 %f(i8* %nval, i32 %x, i32 %y)``.
10734
10735.. _int_it:
10736
10737'``llvm.init.trampoline``' Intrinsic
10738^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10739
10740Syntax:
10741"""""""
10742
10743::
10744
10745 declare void @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* <tramp>, i8* <func>, i8* <nval>)
10746
10747Overview:
10748"""""""""
10749
10750This fills the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` with executable code,
10751turning it into a trampoline.
10752
10753Arguments:
10754""""""""""
10755
10756The ``llvm.init.trampoline`` intrinsic takes three arguments, all
10757pointers. The ``tramp`` argument must point to a sufficiently large and
10758sufficiently aligned block of memory; this memory is written to by the
10759intrinsic. Note that the size and the alignment are target-specific -
10760LLVM currently provides no portable way of determining them, so a
10761front-end that generates this intrinsic needs to have some
10762target-specific knowledge. The ``func`` argument must hold a function
10763bitcast to an ``i8*``.
10764
10765Semantics:
10766""""""""""
10767
10768The block of memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is filled with target
10769dependent code, turning it into a function. Then ``tramp`` needs to be
10770passed to :ref:`llvm.adjust.trampoline <int_at>` to get a pointer which can
10771be :ref:`bitcast (to a new function) and called <int_trampoline>`. The new
10772function's signature is the same as that of ``func`` with any arguments
10773marked with the ``nest`` attribute removed. At most one such ``nest``
10774argument is allowed, and it must be of pointer type. Calling the new
10775function is equivalent to calling ``func`` with the same argument list,
10776but with ``nval`` used for the missing ``nest`` argument. If, after
10777calling ``llvm.init.trampoline``, the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is
10778modified, then the effect of any later call to the returned function
10779pointer is undefined.
10780
10781.. _int_at:
10782
10783'``llvm.adjust.trampoline``' Intrinsic
10784^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10785
10786Syntax:
10787"""""""
10788
10789::
10790
10791 declare i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* <tramp>)
10792
10793Overview:
10794"""""""""
10795
10796This performs any required machine-specific adjustment to the address of
10797a trampoline (passed as ``tramp``).
10798
10799Arguments:
10800""""""""""
10801
10802``tramp`` must point to a block of memory which already has trampoline
10803code filled in by a previous call to
10804:ref:`llvm.init.trampoline <int_it>`.
10805
10806Semantics:
10807""""""""""
10808
10809On some architectures the address of the code to be executed needs to be
Sanjay Patel69bf48e2014-07-04 19:40:43 +000010810different than the address where the trampoline is actually stored. This
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010811intrinsic returns the executable address corresponding to ``tramp``
10812after performing the required machine specific adjustments. The pointer
10813returned can then be :ref:`bitcast and executed <int_trampoline>`.
10814
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000010815.. _int_mload_mstore:
10816
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000010817Masked Vector Load and Store Intrinsics
10818---------------------------------------
10819
10820LLVM provides intrinsics for predicated vector load and store operations. The predicate is specified by a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits of the mask are on, the intrinsic is identical to a regular vector load or store. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
10821
10822.. _int_mload:
10823
10824'``llvm.masked.load.*``' Intrinsics
10825^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10826
10827Syntax:
10828"""""""
10829This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data is a vector of any integer or floating point data type.
10830
10831::
10832
10833 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32 (<16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
10834 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.load.v2f64 (<2 x double>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
10835
10836Overview:
10837"""""""""
10838
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000010839Reads a vector from memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000010840
10841
10842Arguments:
10843""""""""""
10844
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000010845The first operand is the base pointer for the load. The second operand is the alignment of the source location. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the base pointer and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000010846
10847
10848Semantics:
10849""""""""""
10850
10851The '``llvm.masked.load``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked loads and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar load operations.
10852The result of this operation is equivalent to a regular vector load instruction followed by a 'select' between the loaded and the passthru values, predicated on the same mask. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions on memory access to masked-off lanes.
10853
10854
10855::
10856
10857 %res = call <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32 (<16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1>%mask, <16 x float> %passthru)
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +000010858
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000010859 ;; The result of the two following instructions is identical aside from potential memory access exception
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +000010860 %loadlal = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
Elena Demikhovskye86c8c82014-12-29 09:47:51 +000010861 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %loadlal, <16 x float> %passthru
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000010862
10863.. _int_mstore:
10864
10865'``llvm.masked.store.*``' Intrinsics
10866^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10867
10868Syntax:
10869"""""""
10870This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer or floating point data type.
10871
10872::
10873
10874 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32> * <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
10875 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32(<16 x i32> <value>, <16 x i32>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
10876
10877Overview:
10878"""""""""
10879
10880Writes a vector to memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
10881
10882Arguments:
10883""""""""""
10884
10885The first operand is the vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is the base pointer for the store, it has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is the alignment of the destination location. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
10886
10887
10888Semantics:
10889""""""""""
10890
10891The '``llvm.masked.store``' intrinsics is designed for conditional writing of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked store and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
10892The result of this operation is equivalent to a load-modify-store sequence. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions and data races on memory access to masked-off lanes.
10893
10894::
10895
10896 call void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32(<16 x float> %value, <16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1> %mask)
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +000010897
Elena Demikhovskye86c8c82014-12-29 09:47:51 +000010898 ;; The result of the following instructions is identical aside from potential data races and memory access exceptions
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +000010899 %oldval = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000010900 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %value, <16 x float> %oldval
10901 store <16 x float> %res, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
10902
10903
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000010904Masked Vector Gather and Scatter Intrinsics
10905-------------------------------------------
10906
10907LLVM provides intrinsics for vector gather and scatter operations. They are similar to :ref:`Masked Vector Load and Store <int_mload_mstore>`, except they are designed for arbitrary memory accesses, rather than sequential memory accesses. Gather and scatter also employ a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
10908
10909.. _int_mgather:
10910
10911'``llvm.masked.gather.*``' Intrinsics
10912^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10913
10914Syntax:
10915"""""""
10916This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data are multiple scalar values of any integer or floating point data type gathered together into one vector.
10917
10918::
10919
10920 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.gather.v16f32 (<16 x float*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
10921 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v2f64 (<2 x double*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
10922
10923Overview:
10924"""""""""
10925
10926Reads scalar values from arbitrary memory locations and gathers them into one vector. The memory locations are provided in the vector of pointers '``ptrs``'. The memory is accessed according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
10927
10928
10929Arguments:
10930""""""""""
10931
10932The first operand is a vector of pointers which holds all memory addresses to read. The second operand is an alignment of the source addresses. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the vector of pointers and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
10933
10934
10935Semantics:
10936""""""""""
10937
10938The '``llvm.masked.gather``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of multiple scalar values from arbitrary memory locations in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked gathers and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of scalar load operations.
10939The semantics of this operation are equivalent to a sequence of conditional scalar loads with subsequent gathering all loaded values into a single vector. The mask restricts memory access to certain lanes and facilitates vectorization of predicated basic blocks.
10940
10941
10942::
10943
10944 %res = call <4 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v4f64 (<4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 8, <4 x i1>%mask, <4 x double> <true, true, true, true>)
10945
10946 ;; The gather with all-true mask is equivalent to the following instruction sequence
10947 %ptr0 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 0
10948 %ptr1 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 1
10949 %ptr2 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 2
10950 %ptr3 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 3
10951
10952 %val0 = load double, double* %ptr0, align 8
10953 %val1 = load double, double* %ptr1, align 8
10954 %val2 = load double, double* %ptr2, align 8
10955 %val3 = load double, double* %ptr3, align 8
10956
10957 %vec0 = insertelement <4 x double>undef, %val0, 0
10958 %vec01 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec0, %val1, 1
10959 %vec012 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec01, %val2, 2
10960 %vec0123 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec012, %val3, 3
10961
10962.. _int_mscatter:
10963
10964'``llvm.masked.scatter.*``' Intrinsics
10965^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10966
10967Syntax:
10968"""""""
10969This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer or floating point data type. Each vector element is stored in an arbitrary memory addresses. Scatter with overlapping addresses is guaranteed to be ordered from least-significant to most-significant element.
10970
10971::
10972
10973 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
10974 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v16f32(<16 x i32> <value>, <16 x i32*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
10975
10976Overview:
10977"""""""""
10978
10979Writes each element from the value vector to the corresponding memory address. The memory addresses are represented as a vector of pointers. Writing is done according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
10980
10981Arguments:
10982""""""""""
10983
10984The first operand is a vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is a vector of pointers, pointing to where the value elements should be stored. It has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is an alignment of the destination addresses. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
10985
10986
10987Semantics:
10988""""""""""
10989
10990The '``llvm.masked.scatter``' intrinsics is designed for writing selected vector elements to arbitrary memory addresses in a single IR operation. The operation may be conditional, when not all bits in the mask are switched on. It is useful for targets that support vector masked scatter and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergency. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
10991
10992::
10993
10994 ;; This instruction unconditionaly stores data vector in multiple addresses
10995 call @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32 (<8 x i32> %value, <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 4, <8 x i1> <true, true, .. true>)
10996
10997 ;; It is equivalent to a list of scalar stores
10998 %val0 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 0
10999 %val1 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 1
11000 ..
11001 %val7 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 7
11002 %ptr0 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 0
11003 %ptr1 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 1
11004 ..
11005 %ptr7 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 7
11006 ;; Note: the order of the following stores is important when they overlap:
11007 store i32 %val0, i32* %ptr0, align 4
11008 store i32 %val1, i32* %ptr1, align 4
11009 ..
11010 store i32 %val7, i32* %ptr7, align 4
11011
11012
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011013Memory Use Markers
11014------------------
11015
Sanjay Patel69bf48e2014-07-04 19:40:43 +000011016This class of intrinsics provides information about the lifetime of
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011017memory objects and ranges where variables are immutable.
11018
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +000011019.. _int_lifestart:
11020
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011021'``llvm.lifetime.start``' Intrinsic
11022^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11023
11024Syntax:
11025"""""""
11026
11027::
11028
11029 declare void @llvm.lifetime.start(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
11030
11031Overview:
11032"""""""""
11033
11034The '``llvm.lifetime.start``' intrinsic specifies the start of a memory
11035object's lifetime.
11036
11037Arguments:
11038""""""""""
11039
11040The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
11041object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
11042to the object.
11043
11044Semantics:
11045""""""""""
11046
11047This intrinsic indicates that before this point in the code, the value
11048of the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known
11049to never be used and has an undefined value. A load from the pointer
11050that precedes this intrinsic can be replaced with ``'undef'``.
11051
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +000011052.. _int_lifeend:
11053
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011054'``llvm.lifetime.end``' Intrinsic
11055^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11056
11057Syntax:
11058"""""""
11059
11060::
11061
11062 declare void @llvm.lifetime.end(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
11063
11064Overview:
11065"""""""""
11066
11067The '``llvm.lifetime.end``' intrinsic specifies the end of a memory
11068object's lifetime.
11069
11070Arguments:
11071""""""""""
11072
11073The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
11074object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
11075to the object.
11076
11077Semantics:
11078""""""""""
11079
11080This intrinsic indicates that after this point in the code, the value of
11081the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known to
11082never be used and has an undefined value. Any stores into the memory
11083object following this intrinsic may be removed as dead.
11084
11085'``llvm.invariant.start``' Intrinsic
11086^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11087
11088Syntax:
11089"""""""
11090
11091::
11092
11093 declare {}* @llvm.invariant.start(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
11094
11095Overview:
11096"""""""""
11097
11098The '``llvm.invariant.start``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of
11099a memory object will not change.
11100
11101Arguments:
11102""""""""""
11103
11104The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
11105object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
11106to the object.
11107
11108Semantics:
11109""""""""""
11110
11111This intrinsic indicates that until an ``llvm.invariant.end`` that uses
11112the return value, the referenced memory location is constant and
11113unchanging.
11114
11115'``llvm.invariant.end``' Intrinsic
11116^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11117
11118Syntax:
11119"""""""
11120
11121::
11122
11123 declare void @llvm.invariant.end({}* <start>, i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
11124
11125Overview:
11126"""""""""
11127
11128The '``llvm.invariant.end``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of a
11129memory object are mutable.
11130
11131Arguments:
11132""""""""""
11133
11134The first argument is the matching ``llvm.invariant.start`` intrinsic.
11135The second argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
11136object, or -1 if it is variable sized and the third argument is a
11137pointer to the object.
11138
11139Semantics:
11140""""""""""
11141
11142This intrinsic indicates that the memory is mutable again.
11143
11144General Intrinsics
11145------------------
11146
11147This class of intrinsics is designed to be generic and has no specific
11148purpose.
11149
11150'``llvm.var.annotation``' Intrinsic
11151^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11152
11153Syntax:
11154"""""""
11155
11156::
11157
11158 declare void @llvm.var.annotation(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11159
11160Overview:
11161"""""""""
11162
11163The '``llvm.var.annotation``' intrinsic.
11164
11165Arguments:
11166""""""""""
11167
11168The first argument is a pointer to a value, the second is a pointer to a
11169global string, the third is a pointer to a global string which is the
11170source file name, and the last argument is the line number.
11171
11172Semantics:
11173""""""""""
11174
11175This intrinsic allows annotation of local variables with arbitrary
11176strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want
11177to look for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are
11178ignored by code generation and optimization.
11179
Michael Gottesman88d18832013-03-26 00:34:27 +000011180'``llvm.ptr.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
11181^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11182
11183Syntax:
11184"""""""
11185
11186This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' on a
11187pointer to an integer of any width. *NOTE* you must specify an address space for
11188the pointer. The identifier for the default address space is the integer
11189'``0``'.
11190
11191::
11192
11193 declare i8* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i8(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11194 declare i16* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i16(i16* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11195 declare i32* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i32(i32* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11196 declare i64* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i64(i64* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11197 declare i256* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i256(i256* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11198
11199Overview:
11200"""""""""
11201
11202The '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' intrinsic.
11203
11204Arguments:
11205""""""""""
11206
11207The first argument is a pointer to an integer value of arbitrary bitwidth
11208(result of some expression), the second is a pointer to a global string, the
11209third is a pointer to a global string which is the source file name, and the
11210last argument is the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
11211
11212Semantics:
11213""""""""""
11214
11215This intrinsic allows annotation of a pointer to an integer with arbitrary
11216strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want to look
11217for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are ignored by code
11218generation and optimization.
11219
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011220'``llvm.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
11221^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11222
11223Syntax:
11224"""""""
11225
11226This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.annotation``' on
11227any integer bit width.
11228
11229::
11230
11231 declare i8 @llvm.annotation.i8(i8 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11232 declare i16 @llvm.annotation.i16(i16 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11233 declare i32 @llvm.annotation.i32(i32 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11234 declare i64 @llvm.annotation.i64(i64 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11235 declare i256 @llvm.annotation.i256(i256 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11236
11237Overview:
11238"""""""""
11239
11240The '``llvm.annotation``' intrinsic.
11241
11242Arguments:
11243""""""""""
11244
11245The first argument is an integer value (result of some expression), the
11246second is a pointer to a global string, the third is a pointer to a
11247global string which is the source file name, and the last argument is
11248the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
11249
11250Semantics:
11251""""""""""
11252
11253This intrinsic allows annotations to be put on arbitrary expressions
11254with arbitrary strings. This can be useful for special purpose
11255optimizations that want to look for these annotations. These have no
11256other defined use; they are ignored by code generation and optimization.
11257
11258'``llvm.trap``' Intrinsic
11259^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11260
11261Syntax:
11262"""""""
11263
11264::
11265
11266 declare void @llvm.trap() noreturn nounwind
11267
11268Overview:
11269"""""""""
11270
11271The '``llvm.trap``' intrinsic.
11272
11273Arguments:
11274""""""""""
11275
11276None.
11277
11278Semantics:
11279""""""""""
11280
11281This intrinsic is lowered to the target dependent trap instruction. If
11282the target does not have a trap instruction, this intrinsic will be
11283lowered to a call of the ``abort()`` function.
11284
11285'``llvm.debugtrap``' Intrinsic
11286^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11287
11288Syntax:
11289"""""""
11290
11291::
11292
11293 declare void @llvm.debugtrap() nounwind
11294
11295Overview:
11296"""""""""
11297
11298The '``llvm.debugtrap``' intrinsic.
11299
11300Arguments:
11301""""""""""
11302
11303None.
11304
11305Semantics:
11306""""""""""
11307
11308This intrinsic is lowered to code which is intended to cause an
11309execution trap with the intention of requesting the attention of a
11310debugger.
11311
11312'``llvm.stackprotector``' Intrinsic
11313^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11314
11315Syntax:
11316"""""""
11317
11318::
11319
11320 declare void @llvm.stackprotector(i8* <guard>, i8** <slot>)
11321
11322Overview:
11323"""""""""
11324
11325The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic takes the ``guard`` and stores it
11326onto the stack at ``slot``. The stack slot is adjusted to ensure that it
11327is placed on the stack before local variables.
11328
11329Arguments:
11330""""""""""
11331
11332The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic requires two pointer arguments.
11333The first argument is the value loaded from the stack guard
11334``@__stack_chk_guard``. The second variable is an ``alloca`` that has
11335enough space to hold the value of the guard.
11336
11337Semantics:
11338""""""""""
11339
Michael Gottesmandafc7d92013-08-12 18:35:32 +000011340This intrinsic causes the prologue/epilogue inserter to force the position of
11341the ``AllocaInst`` stack slot to be before local variables on the stack. This is
11342to ensure that if a local variable on the stack is overwritten, it will destroy
11343the value of the guard. When the function exits, the guard on the stack is
11344checked against the original guard by ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck``. If they are
11345different, then ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` causes the program to abort by
11346calling the ``__stack_chk_fail()`` function.
11347
11348'``llvm.stackprotectorcheck``' Intrinsic
Sean Silva9d1e1a32013-09-09 19:13:28 +000011349^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Michael Gottesmandafc7d92013-08-12 18:35:32 +000011350
11351Syntax:
11352"""""""
11353
11354::
11355
11356 declare void @llvm.stackprotectorcheck(i8** <guard>)
11357
11358Overview:
11359"""""""""
11360
11361The ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` intrinsic compares ``guard`` against an already
Michael Gottesman98850bd2013-08-12 19:44:09 +000011362created stack protector and if they are not equal calls the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011363``__stack_chk_fail()`` function.
11364
Michael Gottesmandafc7d92013-08-12 18:35:32 +000011365Arguments:
11366""""""""""
11367
11368The ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` intrinsic requires one pointer argument, the
11369the variable ``@__stack_chk_guard``.
11370
11371Semantics:
11372""""""""""
11373
11374This intrinsic is provided to perform the stack protector check by comparing
11375``guard`` with the stack slot created by ``llvm.stackprotector`` and if the
11376values do not match call the ``__stack_chk_fail()`` function.
11377
11378The reason to provide this as an IR level intrinsic instead of implementing it
11379via other IR operations is that in order to perform this operation at the IR
11380level without an intrinsic, one would need to create additional basic blocks to
11381handle the success/failure cases. This makes it difficult to stop the stack
11382protector check from disrupting sibling tail calls in Codegen. With this
11383intrinsic, we are able to generate the stack protector basic blocks late in
Benjamin Kramer3b32b2f2013-10-29 17:53:27 +000011384codegen after the tail call decision has occurred.
Michael Gottesmandafc7d92013-08-12 18:35:32 +000011385
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011386'``llvm.objectsize``' Intrinsic
11387^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11388
11389Syntax:
11390"""""""
11391
11392::
11393
11394 declare i32 @llvm.objectsize.i32(i8* <object>, i1 <min>)
11395 declare i64 @llvm.objectsize.i64(i8* <object>, i1 <min>)
11396
11397Overview:
11398"""""""""
11399
11400The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is designed to provide information to
11401the optimizers to determine at compile time whether a) an operation
11402(like memcpy) will overflow a buffer that corresponds to an object, or
11403b) that a runtime check for overflow isn't necessary. An object in this
11404context means an allocation of a specific class, structure, array, or
11405other object.
11406
11407Arguments:
11408""""""""""
11409
11410The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic takes two arguments. The first
11411argument is a pointer to or into the ``object``. The second argument is
11412a boolean and determines whether ``llvm.objectsize`` returns 0 (if true)
11413or -1 (if false) when the object size is unknown. The second argument
11414only accepts constants.
11415
11416Semantics:
11417""""""""""
11418
11419The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is lowered to a constant representing
11420the size of the object concerned. If the size cannot be determined at
11421compile time, ``llvm.objectsize`` returns ``i32/i64 -1 or 0`` (depending
11422on the ``min`` argument).
11423
11424'``llvm.expect``' Intrinsic
11425^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11426
11427Syntax:
11428"""""""
11429
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith1ff08e32014-02-02 22:43:55 +000011430This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.expect`` on any
11431integer bit width.
11432
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011433::
11434
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith1ff08e32014-02-02 22:43:55 +000011435 declare i1 @llvm.expect.i1(i1 <val>, i1 <expected_val>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011436 declare i32 @llvm.expect.i32(i32 <val>, i32 <expected_val>)
11437 declare i64 @llvm.expect.i64(i64 <val>, i64 <expected_val>)
11438
11439Overview:
11440"""""""""
11441
11442The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic provides information about expected (the
11443most probable) value of ``val``, which can be used by optimizers.
11444
11445Arguments:
11446""""""""""
11447
11448The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic takes two arguments. The first argument is
11449a value. The second argument is an expected value, this needs to be a
11450constant value, variables are not allowed.
11451
11452Semantics:
11453""""""""""
11454
11455This intrinsic is lowered to the ``val``.
11456
Philip Reamese0e90832015-04-26 22:23:12 +000011457.. _int_assume:
11458
Hal Finkel93046912014-07-25 21:13:35 +000011459'``llvm.assume``' Intrinsic
11460^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11461
11462Syntax:
11463"""""""
11464
11465::
11466
11467 declare void @llvm.assume(i1 %cond)
11468
11469Overview:
11470"""""""""
11471
11472The ``llvm.assume`` allows the optimizer to assume that the provided
11473condition is true. This information can then be used in simplifying other parts
11474of the code.
11475
11476Arguments:
11477""""""""""
11478
11479The condition which the optimizer may assume is always true.
11480
11481Semantics:
11482""""""""""
11483
11484The intrinsic allows the optimizer to assume that the provided condition is
11485always true whenever the control flow reaches the intrinsic call. No code is
11486generated for this intrinsic, and instructions that contribute only to the
11487provided condition are not used for code generation. If the condition is
11488violated during execution, the behavior is undefined.
11489
Sanjay Patel1ed2bb52015-01-14 16:03:58 +000011490Note that the optimizer might limit the transformations performed on values
Hal Finkel93046912014-07-25 21:13:35 +000011491used by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic in order to preserve the instructions
11492only used to form the intrinsic's input argument. This might prove undesirable
Sanjay Patel1ed2bb52015-01-14 16:03:58 +000011493if the extra information provided by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic does not cause
Hal Finkel93046912014-07-25 21:13:35 +000011494sufficient overall improvement in code quality. For this reason,
11495``llvm.assume`` should not be used to document basic mathematical invariants
11496that the optimizer can otherwise deduce or facts that are of little use to the
11497optimizer.
11498
Peter Collingbournee6909c82015-02-20 20:30:47 +000011499.. _bitset.test:
11500
11501'``llvm.bitset.test``' Intrinsic
11502^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11503
11504Syntax:
11505"""""""
11506
11507::
11508
11509 declare i1 @llvm.bitset.test(i8* %ptr, metadata %bitset) nounwind readnone
11510
11511
11512Arguments:
11513""""""""""
11514
11515The first argument is a pointer to be tested. The second argument is a
11516metadata string containing the name of a :doc:`bitset <BitSets>`.
11517
11518Overview:
11519"""""""""
11520
11521The ``llvm.bitset.test`` intrinsic tests whether the given pointer is a
11522member of the given bitset.
11523
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011524'``llvm.donothing``' Intrinsic
11525^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11526
11527Syntax:
11528"""""""
11529
11530::
11531
11532 declare void @llvm.donothing() nounwind readnone
11533
11534Overview:
11535"""""""""
11536
Juergen Ributzkac9161192014-10-23 22:36:13 +000011537The ``llvm.donothing`` intrinsic doesn't perform any operation. It's one of only
11538two intrinsics (besides ``llvm.experimental.patchpoint``) that can be called
11539with an invoke instruction.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011540
11541Arguments:
11542""""""""""
11543
11544None.
11545
11546Semantics:
11547""""""""""
11548
11549This intrinsic does nothing, and it's removed by optimizers and ignored
11550by codegen.
Andrew Trick5e029ce2013-12-24 02:57:25 +000011551
11552Stack Map Intrinsics
11553--------------------
11554
11555LLVM provides experimental intrinsics to support runtime patching
11556mechanisms commonly desired in dynamic language JITs. These intrinsics
11557are described in :doc:`StackMaps`.